FOR THE FINAL UPDATE TO THIS GUIDEBOOK on December 8, 2003 please click here.

You might be interested in:

http://lcweb2.loc.gov/ammem/today/today.html [Today in History]

http://www.tamu.edu/anthropology/news.html [Anthropology In The News} From Texas A&M University]

http://news.google.com/ [GOOGLE} News Information from all over!]

http://www.fourmilab.ch/cgi-bin/uncgi/Earth/action?opt=-p [Earth View!]

ANTHROPOLOGY 296 / 296H

Dr. Charles F. Urbanowicz / Professor of Anthropology

FALL 2003 GUIDEBOOK

California State University, Chico / Office: Butte 317

Proseminar in the History of Theory and Method in Anthropology [Tracs # 10214/15]

Office Hours} Mon & Wed} 8 -> 8:30am and 1 -> 3pm and by appointment.

Mon & Wed} 3 -> 4:15pm in Butte 305.

Office Phone: (530) 898-6220 / Dept: (530) 898-6192

e-mail: curbanowicz@csuchico.edu

http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/

© Copyright [All Rights Reserved] Charles F. Urbanowicz / August 25, 2003} This copyrighted Fall 2003 Anthropology 296 Guidebook and Selected Anthropology Essays by Urbanowicz, printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/syllabi/SYL_296-FA2003.html, is intended for use by students enrolled at California State University, Chico, in the FALL Semester of 2003 and unauthorized use / publication is definitely prohibited.

DESCRIPTION} ANTH 296: Prerequisites: ENGL 001 (or its equivalent) with a grade of C- or higher; ANTH 103. Investigation of the history of the development of and method in anthropological thought and practice from the nineteenth century to the present. Seminar format. This is a writing proficiency, WP course; a grade of C- or better certifies writing proficiency for majors. (The 2003-2005 University Catalog, page 194).

DESCRIPTION of ANTH 296H: Prerequisites ENGL 001 (or its equivalent) with a grade of C- or higher; ANTH 103, acceptance into the Honors Program. This investigation of the method and theory into anthropological thought of the last century is directed to individual research interests and problem development for the honors thesis Seminar format. This is a writing proficiency, WP course; a grade of C- or better certifies writing proficiency for majors. (The 2003-2005 University Catalog, page 194).

ANTH 296 / ANTH 296H is the designated WP (Writing Proficiency) class for the Anthropology Major and the Department of Anthropology graduation literacy certification requires that you pass this course at the "C-" level. A "Criteria of Writing Proficiency" appears at the end of this syllabus. The "World Wide Web" and the implications of this technology for Anthropology will also be discussed throughout the semester and various appropriate web sites will be introduced throughout the semester. In addition, the Anthropology 296 Guidebook and Selected Anthropology Essays by Urbanowicz required text on the web will be updated at various times throughout the semester. [Please click here for the clickable "Web Table of Contents." Please see below for some URLs that might be of value to you for this course (as well as other courses).]  

THREE REQUIRED TEXTS:
Meryl W. Davies & Piero (2002) Introducing Anthropology.
L.L. Langness (1987) The Study of Culture: Revised Edition.
C.F. Urbanowicz (2003) Fall 2003 Anthropology 296 Guidebook and Selected Anthropology Essays by Urbanowicz http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/syllabi/SYL_296-FA2003.html; complete Essay listing here.

THREE HIGHLY RECOMMENDED ITEMS:
Any
English Language Dictionary.
William A. Strunk, Jr. (2000) The Elements of Style (4th edition).
The World Almanac and Book of Facts 2003.

ASSESSMENT AND IMPORTANT DATES:

WRITING ASSIGNMENT #1
DUE on September 22 or September 24, 2003 (5%)
EXAM I (Monday)
October 6, 2003 (25%)
WRITING ASSIGNMENT #2 (Monday)
October 20, 2003 (5%)
EXAM II (Monday)
November 17, 2003 (25%)
THANKSGIVING BREAK!
November 24 -> November 28, 2003
PARTICIPATION / PAPER PRESENTATION
August 27, 2003 -> December 10, 2003 (15%).
WRITING ASSIGNMENT #3 (Term Paper)
DUE on MONDAY December 15, 2003 (25%)

NOTE: If you have a documented disability that may require reasonable accommodations, please contact Disability Support Services (DSS) for coordination of your acadmeic acocmodations. DSS is located in Building E. Building E is adjacent to Meriam Library and Bell Memorial Union (BMU). The DSS phone number is 898-5959 V/TTY or FAX 898-4411. Visit the DSS website at http://www.csuchico.edu/dss/.

THIRTY-NINE ITEMS ON TWENTY-FOUR HOUR RESERVE FOR READING SELECTIONS:
D. Bidney (1953), Theoretical Anthropology [GN/24/B492/1967]
D.J. Boorstin (1983),The Discoverers [CB/69/B66/1983]
J. Clifford & G. Marcus (1986), Writing Culture: The Poetics and Politics of Ethnography [GN/307.7/W75/1986]
E.L. Cerroni-Long (1999), Anthropological Theory in North America [GN/33/A444/1999]
E. Daniel & J. Peck (1996), Culture/Contexture: Explorations in Anthropology and Literary Studies [GN/307.7/C85/1996]
R. Darnell (1974), Readings in the History of Anthropology [GN/17/D35]
A. de Malefijt (1974), Images of Man [GN/17/D44/1974]
M. di Leonardo (1991), Gender At The Crossroads of Knowledge: Feminist Anthropology in the Postmodern Era [GN/33/G46/1991]
P. A. Erickson [with L. Murphy] (1998), A History of Anthropological Theory [GN/33/E74/1998]
R. Fox (1994), The Challenge of Anthropology: Old Encounters and New Excursions [GN/29/F69/1994]
R. Fox (1997),Conjectures & Confrontations: Science, Evolution, Social Concern [GN/468/F69]
U. Gacs et al. [Editors] (1988), Women Anthropologists: Selected Biographies [GN/20/W63/1988]
C. Geertz (1988), Works And Lives: The Anthropologist As Author [GN/307.7/G44/1988]
C. Geertz (1995), After The Fact: Two Countries, Four Decades, One Anthropologist [GN/21/G44/A3]
D. Hakken (1999), Cyborgs@Cyberspace? An Ethnographer Looks to the Future [QA/76.9/C66/H34/1999]
M. Harris (1968), The Rise of Anthropological Theory [GN/17/H3]
M. Harris (1999), Theories of Culture in Postmodern Times [GN/357/H39/1999]
Hayes & Hayes (1970), Claude Lévi-Strauss: The Anthropologist as Hero [GN/21/L4/H3]
H. R. Hays (1958), From Ape to Angel [GN/405/H34]
J. Helm (1966), Pioneers of American Anthropology
C. Herbert (1991), Culture And Anomie: Ethnographic Imagination In The Nineteenth Century [GN/357/H47/1991]
C. Hinsley (1981), Savages and Scientists: The Smithsonian.... [GN/17.3/U6/H56]
A. Kardiner & E. Preble (1961), They Studied Man [GN/405/K3]
A.L. Kroeber & C. Kluckhohn (1952),Culture: A Critical Review [GN/27/K7]
A. Kuper (1973), Anthropology and Anthropologists [GN/17/K26]
G. Marcus & M. Fischer (1986), Anthropology As Cultural Critique: An Experimental Moment In The Human Sciences, 2nd Edition [GN/345/M37/1999]
T.W. Luke (2002), Museum Politics: Power Plays At The Exhibition [AM/151/L85/2002].
G. Marcus (1998), Ethnography Through Thick And Thin [GN/345/M373/1998]
M. Mead & R. Bunzel (1960), The Golden Age of American Anthropology [E/77/M48]
A. Montagu (1974), Frontiers of Anthropology [GN/17/M/59/1974]
Naroll & Naroll (1973), Main Currents in Cultural Anthropology [GN/17/N37/1973]
T.K. Penniman (1936), A Hundred Years of Anthropology [GN/17/P4]
R.T. Pennock [Editor] 2001, Intelligent Design Creationism and Its Critics: Philosophical, Theological, and Scientific Perspectives [BS/652/P44/2001]
H. Powdermaker (1966), Stranger and Friend [HM/73/P67]
A.S. Ryan [Editor], (2002), A Guide To Careers in Physical Anthropology [GN/62/G85/2002]
S. Silverman (1981), Totems and Teachers: Perspectives on the History.....[GN/17/T69]
J.S. Slotkin (1965), Readings in Early Anthropology [GN/17/S46]
G.W. Stocking (1995), After Tylor: British Social Anthropology 1888-1951 [GN/308.3/G7/S74/1995]
F.W. Voget (1975), A History of Ethnology [GN/17/V63]

AND PLEASE CONSIDER THE FOLLOWING WORDS: "Read not to contradict and confute; nor to believe and take for granted; nor to find talk and discourse; but to weigh and consider. Some books are to be tasted, others to be swallowed, and some few to be chewed and digested; that is, some books are to be read only in parts; others to be read but not curiously; and some to be read wholly, and with diligence and attention." Francis Bacon (1561-1626), English essayist and philosopher.

ALSO, please think about the following for this class (and ALL of your classes):

"Your instructor, however knowledgeable and good at communicating, cannot talk about everything at once. He or she cannot tell you at the same time about specific ethnographic cases and different kinds of societies, or about epistemological assumptions about how we learn things at the same time as about ethnographic field work methods, or about heuristic theories at the same time as about specific understandings of particular cultural patterns. He or she cannot tell you about Darwin [1809-1882] and Mendel's [1822-1884] contribution to evolution at the same time he or she is discussing the details of Australopithecus robustus, much less the ecological context and why we think the population that this fossil represents adapted to life on the savanna. You eventually need to know all of these things and how they influence one another, but you cannot learn all of it at once. Be patient; you will catch on [stress added]." Philip Carl Salzman and Patricia C. Rice, 2004, Thinking Anthropologically: A Practical Guide For Students (NJ: Pearson/Prentice-Hall), page 2.

FOR A "ROUGH" MASTER CHART OF VARIOUS ANTHROPOLOGISTS (located towards the end of this web Guidebook - or "roughly" in the middle-of-the-printed-volume), please click here.

THE DEPARTMENT OF ANTHROPOLOGY: A HIGH QUALITY LEARNING ENVIRONMENT: "Supported by an extraordinarily dedicated faculty and professional staff, the Department of Anthropology maintains a number of programs, initiatives and professional activities that contribute to a high quality learning environment for undergraduate and graduate students. based on the principles of learning by doing and the value of extended and intensive faculty-student contact, the program provides educational and training opportunities in all of the disciplines sub-fields: archeology, physical and cultural anthropology, linguistics and museum studies. Student learning is enhanced through facilities such as the Physical Anthropology Human Identification Laboratory, the Archaeological Research Program, the Ethnographic Lab and the Museum of Anthropology. Anthropology also makes significant contributions to General Education. The result is a rigorous, challenging and intellectually exciting program of academic and experiential learning. The success of this program can be measured in competitions and in launching successful careers in heritage resource management, forensic investigation, local regional and national museums and allied professional fields." President Manuel A. Esteban, California State University, Chico, May 13, 2003 Memorandum to all Faculty and Staff.

ALL ANTHROPOLOGY MAJORS SHOULD KNOW ABOUT the International Encyclopedia of the Social Sciences (1968) [REF/H40/A2I/5] the International Encyclopedia of the Social & Behavioral Sciences (2001) [REF/H41/I58/2001] AS WELL AS the Annual Review of Anthropology [GN/1/B52] and Archaeological Method And Theory (edited by Schiefer) [CC/A242/Vol 1, 1989->], AND the Encyclopedia of Cultural Anthropology (Edited by D. Levinson and M. Ember) [ref/GN/307/E52/1996]), AS WELL AS the various miscellaneous publications and journals available in Butte 305 (Ethnographic Laboratory). (Incidentally, you might find information on the Annual Review of Anthropology at this URL: http://www.jstor.org/journals/00846570.html);  AND DON'T FORGET about:

"The eHRAF Collection of Ethnography, available on the web, is a small but growing collection of HRAF full text and graphical materials supplemented, in some cases, with additional research through approximately the 1980's. The eHRAF Collection of Ethnography includes approximately 48 cultures, and regular additions are planned." (See http://www.hti.umich.edu/e/ehraf/).

ARE YOU AWARE OF?: http://www.csuchico.edu/lins/chicorio/ [Chico Rio - Research Instruction On-Line]:

"ChicoRIO is a series of Web based, self-paced lessons designed to help you learn how to find information. The tutorials will help you sharpen your research, critical thinking, and term paper writing skills. ChicoRIO also links to campus computing resources and a tour of the Meriam Library. The sections of ChicoRIO can be completed in any order."

FINALLY, ON PLAGIARISM / MISREPRESENTATION:

Plagiarism, in the 2003-2005 University Catalogue (page 47), is defined as follows: "Copying homework answers from your text to hand in for a grade; failing to give credit for ideas, statement of facts, or conclusions derived from another source; submitting a paper downloaded from the Internet or submitting a friend's paper as your own; claiming credit for artistic work (such as a music composition, photo, painting, drawing, sculpture, or design) done by someone else." FROM http://www.csuchico.edu/art/contrapposto/contrapposto00/pages/appendix8.html please note the following: "B. Plagiarism will lead to grade reduction [for] the course and could lead to suspension from the University. (You are responsible to the standards appearing in the University's catalogue and the student handbook. Please read the University's pamphlet, Academic Honesty, an Ounce of Prevention.) Copies of this handbook are available at the Student Judicial Affairs Office in Kendall Hall [stress added]."

ALSO, please note the following from the 2003-2005 University Catalogue (page 47) on Misrepresentation: "Having another student take your exam, or do your computer program or lab experiment; lying to an instructor to increase your grade; submitting a paper that is substantially the same for credit in two different courses without prior approval of both instructors involved; altering a graded work after it has been returned and then submitting the work for regrading [stress added]."


Please Click on the Week To Get To The Exact Week In This Web Guidebook; click here to get to the listing of URLs listed in this Guidebook; and please click here for a brief "Disclaimer Essay" by Urbanowicz.

WEEK 1. August 25 & 27, 2003: Mon & Wed} Introduction & Overview to the course. The profession: 1967-2003+ Please glance at the required texts and any of the RESERVE items by Wednesday, September 3, 2003.

SPECIAL: Paying For College.

WEEK 2. NO CLASS September 1 and Wednesday, September 3, 2003} History of theory continued. Key concepts, as well as Pre/Post-Darwin individuals and information.

WEEK 3. September 8 & 10, 2003: Mon & Wed} Some 19th Century research in Europe and America (Cross-Cultural Research, Including HRAF): Pre-Boas, Darwin, Spencer, Morgan, Tyler, Frazer, Powell, Pitt-Rivers, Prichard, et al. and Darwin (1809-1882) in context.

WEEK 4. September 15 & 17, 2003: Mon & Wed} Darwin, Spencer, Morgan, Tylor, Frazer et al. continued, into the 20th Century. Preliminary discussion of your term paper topic interests. [TO BE ASSIGNED: 1/2 the class on2/17/2002 and 1/2 on 2/19/2003. WRITING ASSIGNMENT #1 [5%] DUE on your day in class.

NOTE: Writing Assignment #1 is a CRITIQUE of any chapter that you have read from the readings to date that are on reserve. Some points to consider in your critique are the following: (#1) what was the main idea of the chapter? (#2) what facts were used to support the main idea? (#3) any faulty reasoning, faulty logic, or obvious "bias" in the chapter ? (#4) what additional information could be added to the author's argument? and, finally, (#5) is there a "counter-argument" to the main idea of the chapter? These are a lot of points to consider so please take your time!

WEEK 5. September 22 & 24, 2003: Mon & Wed} DISCUSSION OF WRITING ASSIGNMENT #1 (5%) Approximately 1/2 class either Monday 9/22/2003 or Wednesday 9/24/2003.

WEEK 6. September 29 & October 1, 2003: Mon & Wed} 19th / 20th Century Reaction(s) & REVIEW on October 1, 2003 (including François Péron, Franz Boas, Alfred Louis Kroeber, and others!).

NOTE: A "sample" self-paced exam should be available at: http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ANTH296FA2003TESTOne.htm by Monday September 29, 2003, to assist you as a Review for EXAM I.

WEEK 7. October 6 & 8, 2003: Mon & Wed} EXAM I [25%] on Monday October 6, 2003 and then into 20th Century Reactions and more of Comte-->Durkheim-->Malinowski+ } Exam I based on selected readings in Davies & Piero (2002), Langness (pp. xi-73), selected assigned readings in Anthropology 296 Guidebook and Selected Anthropology Essays by Urbanowicz, lectures/discussions, and the quotations referred to in this Guidebook to date. NOTE: Specific Readings from Reserve WILL NOT be on the Exam.

WEEK 8. October 13 & 15, 2003: Mon & Wed} Comte-->Durkheim/Van Gennep-->Mauss-->Lévi-Strauss and British Social Anthropology, American Cultural Anthropology, as well as French anthropologie; and please remember: Preliminary Term Paper Topic DUE (WA#2) on Monday October 20, 2003.

WEEK 9. October 20 & 22, 2003: Mon & Wed} Neo-Evolution, Cultural Ecology, & Modernism; for NEXT WEEK: 1/2 the class to be assigned for Monday October 27, 2003 and 1/2 for Wednesday October 29, 2003, and DISCUSSION OF YOUR INDIVIDUAL RESEARCH TOPICS. [What day you are assigned to will be distributed on October 22, 2003.]

WEEK 10. October 27 & 29, 2003: Mon & Wed} DISCUSSION OF YOUR INDIVIDUAL TERM PAPER interests [approximately 1/2-the-class on each day).

WEEK 11. November 3 & 5, 2003: Mon & Wed} Symbolism, Modernism, Reflexivity, & Post-Modernism. Term Paper Presentation Order Distributed on November 5, 2003.

WEEK 12. November 10 & 12, 2003: Mon & Wed} Winding down and general discussions and review for EXAM II (25%) on Monday November 17, 2003. This will be based on selected readings in Davies & Piero (2002), Langness (pp. 74-217), selected assigned readings in Fall 2003 Anthropology 296 Guidebook and Selected Anthropology Essays by Urbanowicz, lectures/discussions, and the quotations referred to in this Guidebook to date. Specific Readings from Reserve WILL NOT BE on the Exam.

NOTE: A "sample" self-paced exam should be available at: http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ANTH296FA2003TESTTwo.htm by Monday November 10, 2003, to assist you as a Review for EXAM II.

WEEK 13. November 17 & 19, 2003: EXAM II [25%] on MONDAY November 17 and then into Term Paper Presentations beginning on Wednesday November 19, 2003. NOTE: the 2003 American Anthropological Association 102nd Annual Meeting will be held in Chicago, November 19-23, 2003.

WEEK 14: THANKSGIVING BREAK!

WEEK 15. December 1 & 3, 2003: Mon & Wed} Term Paper Presentations/Discussions Continue. [Please REMEMBER: Class participation, including Term paper presentation, represents 15% of your total grade.]

WEEK 16. December 8 & 10, 2003: Mon & Wed} Term Paper Presentations/Discussions Continue. [Please REMEMBER: Class participation, including Term paper presentation, represents 15% of your total grade.]

WEEK 17. December 15, 2003 (Monday] FINALS WEEK} Term Paper Discussions CONCLUDE (if needed) and FINAL MEETING SCHEDULED ON Monday December 15, 2003 from 6->7:50pm and your TERM PAPER is DUE (25%) on that date.


How to "use" the Guidebook. NOTE THE FOLLOWING:

"Guidebooks are $15 tools for $3,000 experiences. Many otherwise smart people base the trip of a lifetime on a borrowed copy of a three-year-old guidebook. The money they saved in the bookstore was wasted the first day of their trip, searching for hotels and restaurants long since closed. When I visit someplace as a rank beginner--a place like Belize or Sri Lanka--I equip myself with a good guidebook and expect myself to travel smart. I travel like an old pro, not because I'm a super traveler, but because I have good information and use it. I'm a connoisseur of guidebooks. My trip is my child. I love her. And I give her the best tutors money can buy. Too many people are penny-wise and pound-foolish when it comes to information. ... All you need is a good guidebook covering your destination. Before buying a book, study it. How old is the information? The cheapest books are often the oldest--no bragain. Who wrote it? What's the author's experience? Does the book work for you--or the tourist industry? Does it specialize in hard opinions--or superlatives? For whom is it written? Is it readable? It should have personality without chattiness and information without fluff. Don't believe everything you read. The power of the printed word is scary. Most books are peppered with information that is flat-out wrong. Incredibly enough, even this book may have an error" [stress added]." Rick Steves' Europe Through the Back Door 1999 (Santa Fe, NM: John Muir Publications), 1998, pages 8-9.

CONSIDER THE FOLLOWING:

"I cannot see that lectures can do so much as reading the books from which the lectures are taken."
Samuel Johnson [1709-1784]; as quoted in James Boswell [1740-1795], 1791, Life of Johnson.

and

Sir Richard Burton (1821-1890) stated the following: "The Arabs have a proverb: The lecture is one - The dispute (upon the subject of the lecture) is one thousand [stress added]." Sir Richard Burton (1821-1890), John Hayman, 1990, Sir Richard Burton's Travels in Arabia and Africa: Four Lectures from a Huntington Library Manuscript (San Marino, CA: Huntington Library), page 36.

AS WELL AS:

"To extract these small plums of information it was necessary to dig through a great pudding of cliché and jargon…." Robert Harris, 1998, Archangel (NY: Jove [2000] Berkley), page 62.

PLEASE TAKE TO HEART THE FOLLOWING:

"The emphasis in this course will be not [be so much] on reading or [too much] research, but on thought. Much of what we know, or think we know, is based on something we've heard or read. I think that's the trouble with modern scholarship and collegiate study all the way up to the doctorate. I'm going to ask you to think about the material we will be dealing with rather than memorizing what someone has said about it. So I'd rather you didn't take [too many] notes in this class. Listen and think about what I say or what any one of your classmates says. And don't be afraid of disagreeing with me. I'll appreciate the compliment of your thinking about it and arriving at another conclusion [stress added]." (The character Rabbi David Small, in Harry Kemelman, 1996 [1997], The Day the Rabbi Left Town (NY: Fawcett Crest), page 78.

AND ALSO REMEMBER WHAT I MENTION IN ALL OF MY COURSES:

"The palest ink is better than the best memory." (Chinese proverb) and

Said of Leonardo Da Vinci (1352-1519): "...he also learned to carry a notebook with him at all times and to use it, so that whatever went in through the eye came out through his hand [stress added]." Holland Cotter, 2002,Leonardo: The Eye, The Hand, The Mind." The New York Times, January 24, 2003, pages B35 + B37, page B37.

"You are what you know. ...Today we live according to the latest version of how the universe functions. This view affects our behaviour and thought, just as previous versions affected those who lived with them. ...At any time in the past, people have held a view of the way the universe works which was for them similarly definitive, whether it was based on myths or research. And at any time, that view they held was sooner or later altered by changes in the body of knowledge" [stress added]. James Burke, 1985, The Day The Universe Changed (Little Brown), page 9.

"My memory is woven out of small and great events in the fabric of time [stress added]." Franco Ferruci, 1996, The Life of God (as Told by Himself) (Chicago: University of Chicago Presss), page 214.

"The consequences of our actions are always so complicated, so diverse, that predicting the future is a very difficult business indeed." The character Albus Dumbledore to Harry Potter, in Harry Potter And the Prisoner of Azkaban, 1999, by Joanne K. Rowling, page 426.
"The most important word in the English language is attitude. Love and hate, work and play, hope and fear, our attitudinal response to all these situations, impresses me as being the guide." Harlen Adams (1904-1997)

A NOT SO BIG SECRET: #1} The information (or "meaning") that you will get out of this course will be in direct proportion to the energy that you expend on course assignments and requirements: readings, writings, examinations, and thinking assignments. #2} I will try to provide you with new information and ideas every class period!

AND PLEASE NOTE: the following Decree #26 does not apply to this class nor to your eventual presentation: "By Order of The High Inquisitor of Hogwarts: "Teachers are hereby banned from giving students any information that is not strictly related to the subjects they are paid to teach. The above is in accordance with Educational Decree Number Twenty-Six. Signed: Dolores Jane Umbridge / High Inquisitor [stress added]." J. K. Rowling, 2003, Harry Potter And the Order of The Phoenix (NY: Scholastic Press), page 551.
For that BRIEF DISCLAIMER ESSAY, please click here


READING ASSIGNMENT(s) should be completed by the day assigned since they will / can form the basis of discussion that day / week. There will be some lectures (and videos), but hopefully there will be more discussion than either lectures or videos! DURING WEEK 5, 1/2 the class will meet on September 22, 2003 and 1/2 the class will meet on September 24, 2003. This is done to create small discussion groups. PLEASE REMEMBER that WRITING ASSIGNMENT #1 (a critique) is DUE on the day you are assigned to attend class that week: we will discuss readings to date (as well as your individual critique) on the day you are assigned. LOOKING at dates, in addition to EXAM I on MONDAY October 6, 2003, (WEEK 7), your preliminary term paper topic (WRITING ASSIGNMENT #2) is DUE on Monday October 20, 2003 (WEEK 9). Based on your topic, specific days will be assigned for approximately 1/2 class-size discussions for Week 10 when 1/2 the class will meet on Monday October 27, 2003 and 1/2 the class will meet on Wednesday October 29, 2003 and WRITING ASSIGNMENT #2 and your TERM PAPER TOPICS will be discussed. EXAM II (25%) is on Monday November 17, 2003 (WEEK 13) and the Term Paper PRESENTATION ORDER will be distributed on Wednesday November 5, 2003. TERM PAPER PRESENTATIONS begin on Wednesday November 19, 2003 [WEEK 13] and then THANKSGIVING BREAK! Remember, in-class participation, including term paper presentation, contributes 15% towards your final grade. NOTE: if any dates have to be changed for any reason you will be notified well-in-advance: no sneaky surprises are planned!

PLEASE READ AND CONSIDER / THINK ABOUT the following:

"An analysis of almost any scientific problem leads automatically to a study of its history." Ernst Mayr (1904 ->)

Margaret Mead [1901-1978] wrote: "Anthropologists are highly individual and specialized people. Each of them [or us!] is marked by the kind of work he or she prefers and has done, which in time becomes an aspect of that individual's personality." ALSO CONSIDER the following statement made by the father of Ward Goodenough when the young Goodenough was considering his career: "Anthropology is a subject such that you can be interested in almost anything and its alright" (Anthropology Newsletter, October 1992, page 4); and, finally, consider these words of Clifford Geertz, born in 1926: "...and that this was the kind of freedom we could have in anthropology--to do anything and call it anthropology (which you still can do!)." Clifford Geertz, 1991, An Interview with Clifford Geertz. Current Anthropology, Vol. 32, No. 5, 1991, page 603.

"One who makes a close study of almost any branch of science soon discovers the great illusion of the monolith. When he [or she] stood outside as an uninformed layman, he [or she] got a vague impression of unanimity among the professionals. He [or she] tended to think of science as supporting the Establishment with fixed and approved views. All this dissolves as he [or she] works his [or her] way into the living concerns of practicing scientists. He [and she] finds lively personalities who indulge in disagreement, disorder, and disrespect. He [and she] must sort out conflicting opinions and make up his [and her] own mind as to what is correct and who is sound. This applies not only to provinces as vast as biology and to large fields such as evolutionary theory, but even to small and familiar corners such as the species problem. The closer one looks, the more diversity one finds [stress added]." Norman Macbeth, 1971, Darwin Retried: An Appeal To Reason (NY: Dell Publishing Co.), page 18.

"Cultural diversity [and intellectual or theoretical diversity is part of that] is a reservoir of creativity.... This creativity is not confined to the arts; it is also a source of potential solutions to social and environmental problems, solutions that would otherwise be ignored by politically dominant cultures precisely because dominance breeds complacency and stunts the capacity of self-criticism. In this sense, cultural diversity is an indispensable corrective or counter-balance [stress added]." David Harmon, 2002, In Light of Our Differences: How Diversity In Nature And Culture Makes Us Human (Smithsonian Institution Press), page 45.

"More book titles are being published these days, an estimated 114,487 in 2001, compared with 39,000 in 1975, and more people are buying them [stress added]." Dinitia Smith, 2002, In Book Publishing World, Some Reasons for Optimism. The New York Times, December 6, 2002, page C2.

"One of the world's leading medical journals has put itself and its competitors under the microscope with research showing that published studies are sometimes misleading and frequently fail to mention weaknesses. Some problems can be traced to biases and conflicts of interest among peer reviewers, who are outside scientists tapped by journal editors to help decide whether a research paper should be published.... problems are most likely to occur in research funded by drug companies, which have a vested interest in findings that make their products look good. ... One JAMA [Journal of the American Medical Association] report found that medical journal studies on new treatments often use only the most favorable statistic in reporting results.... [stress added]." Lindsey Tanner, 2002, Medical Journal Examines Itself: Magazine admits biases, conflicts of interest influence content. The San Francisco Chronicle, June 6, 2002, page A2.

"Anthropology provides a scientific basis for dealing with the crucial dilemma of the world today: how can peoples of different appearance, mutually unintelligible languages, and dissimilar ways of life get along peaceably together? Of course, no branch of knowledge constitutes a cure-all for all the ills of mankind. ... Students who had not gone beyond the horizon of their own society could not be expected to perceive custom which was the stuff of their own thinking. The scientist of human affairs needs to know as much about the eye that sees as the object seen. Anthropology holds up a great mirror to man[kind] and lets him [and her!] look at himself in his infinite variety. This, and not the satisfaction of idle curiosity nor romantic quest, is the meaning of the anthropologist's work.... [stress in original]" Clyde Kluckhohn, 1949, Mirror For Man: The Relation of Anthropology To Modern Life, page 1 and page 10.

"If there is one thing that anthropologists of the 20th Century have demonstrated it is the position that there is no one single culture which can serve as the sole model of analysis of other cultures. Perhaps the most important point of modern 20th century Anthropology has been the detailed and documented account of the tremendous range of variation of 'cultures of this planet' and this is a distinct move away from various 19th century, and apparently some 20th century views, which offer a monolithic interpretation of CULTURE against which 'lesser' cultures can be appropriately ranked! [stress added]." Charles F. Urbanowicz, 1978, Cultural Implications of Extraterrestrial Contact and the Colonzation of Space. The Industrialization of Space: Advances in the Astronautical Sciences, Edited by Richard A. Van Patten et al., (San Diego, CA: Published for the American Astronautical Society Publication by Univelt, Inc.), pages 785-797, page 793.

"Colleges will not, of course, disappear--but over time they will be dramatically altered in nature as students and professors adopt cyberspace as their primary window into the laboratory of life. The distinctions between academic and applied research will become blurred as academic and commercial researchers begin to tap into the same sources of information and exchange in cyberspace [stress added]." David B. Whittle, 1997, Cyberspace: The Human Dimension (NY: W.H. Freeman), page 217.

"The worst case of plagiarism on record at Chico State University was when someone copied and turned in an entire master's thesis. With plagiarism said to be on the rise here and nationwide, the university, along with representatives from the Associated Students government, has been meeting to discuss the matter of plagiarism on campus and what to do about it. ... When the CSU signed up with Turnitin.com on a trial basis last year, a search of 1,150 papers found 46 of them [4%] had 70 to 100 percent of their text matching papers in the site's database [stress added]." Devanie Angel, 2003, Cheaters are never beaters. The Chico News and Review, February 13, 2003, page 9.


Please think about / read the "THOUGHTS" at the end of this Guidebook: THEY play an important part in the discussions throughout the semester; also, please read the quotation statements associated with each week} they also play an important part in the discussions throughout the semester.

SEVEN GOALS OF THE DEPARTMENT OF ANTHROPOLOGY AT CSU, CHICO

1. An understanding of the phenomenon of culture as that which differentiates human life from other life forms; an understanding of the roles of human biology and cultural processes in human behavior and human evolution. 

2. A positive appreciation of the diversity of contemporary and past human cultures and an awareness of the value of anthropological perspectives and knowledge in contemporary society. 

3. A knowledge of the substantive data pertinent to the several sub disciplines of anthropology and familiarity with major issues relevant to each. 

4. Familiarity with the forms of anthropological literature and basic data sources and knowledge of how to access such information.  

5. Knowledge of the methodology appropriate to the sub-disciplines of anthropology and the capacity to apply appropriate methods when conducting anthropological research. 

6. The ability to present and communicate in anthropologically appropriate ways anthropological knowledge and the results of anthropological research. 

7. Knowledge of the history of anthropological thought. 

PLEASE REMEMBER: The ANTHROPOLOGY FORUM (ANTH 297-01} #10216) for One Unit every Thursday from 4->4:50pm in Ayres Hall 120. (Information on previous Anthropology Forum presentations by Urbanowicz may be viewed by clicking here: ESSAY #1 at the end of this printed Guidebook. ]


LECTURE / DISCUSSION TOPICS AND REQUIRED READINGS:

WEEK 1. August 25 & 27, 2003: Mon & Wed} Introduction & Overview to the course. The Profession: 1967-2003+ Please glance at the required texts and read any SINGLE chapter, NOT THE ENTIRE BOOK, of any of the Reserve reading items assigned for Week #1 / Week #2 by Wednesday, September 3, 2003. PLEASE take notes in this GUIDEBOOK: IT WILL NOT be re-purchased by the Bookstore for Spring 2004. Urbanowicz on "Teaching" might be of interest and may be found by clicking here: ESSAY #2 at the end of this printed Guidebook; information about fieldwork by Urbanowicz in the Polynesian Tonga might also be of interest and may also be be found by clicking here: ESSAY #3 & ESSAY #4.

PLEASE NOTE} SOME OF THE TRANSPARENCIES USED ON DAY 1 OF CLASS (August 25, 2003) ARE AVAILABLE AT: http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/PowerPoint/ANTH296FA2003

PLEASE NOTE} Do come to class EVERY-SINGLE-DAY with a "quotation" or a phrase that struck YOU in some way: either from this Guidebook or Langness or Davies & Piero; and remember:

"Harry sorted through his presents and found one with Hermione's handwriting on it. She had given him too a book that resembled a diary, except that it said things like 'Do it today or later you'll pay!' every time he opened a page." J. K. Rowling, 2003, Harry Potter And the Order of The Phoenix (NY: Scholastic Press), page 501; as well as:

"Youth cannot know how age thinks and feels. But old men are guilty if they forget what it was to be young." (Albus Dumbledore, in} J. K. Rowling, 2003, Harry Potter And the Order of The Phoenix (NY: Scholastic Press), page 826.

IT SHOULD BE OBVIOUS that the discipline of Anthropology is a "changing" one (as are all disciplines in the 21st century), and please think about the following (dated July 11, 2003):

AnthroSource -- Enriching Scholarship and Building Global Communities

"A portal for anthropological research, AnthroSource will provide electronic access to all AAA periodicals, past, present, and future in a single searchable, linked database. Go to the AAA Web site [http://www.aaanet.org/anthrosource) to access the AnthroSource Working Group's report on the progress in AAA's transition to electronic publishing.  Read about the services AnthroSource plans to offer AAA members; AAA leadership and staff's efforts to develop the portal; how this project will transform AAA's present publications program; and the principles guiding the development process.  AnthroSource is anticipated to be implemented in the beginning of 2004, and is designed to be financially sustainable in four years [stress added]." [July 11, 2003]

SO, FOR THE PRESENT COURSE OF ANTH 296 / 296H, PLEASE read any one of the following items from the selections on RESERVE by Wednesday September 3, 2003.

Boorstin: pp. 626-635.
Darnell Selection #5 (pp. 61-77) or pp. 289-321.
Kardiner and Preble: pp. 11-32.
Mead & Bunzel: pp. 1-12.
Montagu: pp. 91-97, 49-145, and 157-162.
Naroll & Naroll: Ch 2 (pp. 25-56).
Penniman: part of Ch. 4 (pp. 73-110).
Stocking (1991): pp. 8-45.

PLEASE Begin reading Merryl Wyn Davies and Piero, 2002, Introducing Anthropology, pp. 1-19.

CONSIDER THE IMPLICATIONS OF THE FOLLOWING WORDS:

"It is our choices that show what we truly are, far more than our abilities." The character Albus Dumbledore to Harry Potter, IN Harry Potter And the Chamber of Secrets, 1998, by Joanne K. Rowling, page 333.

"First impressions at all times very much depend on one's previously-acquired ideas." Charles R. Darwin [1809-1882], 1839, The Voyage of the Beagle (Chapter 18: "Tahiti And New Zealand"), 1972 Bantam paperback edition (with "Introduction" by Walter Sullivan), page 357.

NOTE: "What C.S. Lewis [1898-1963] called the 'snobbery of chronology' encourages us to presume that just because we happen to have lived after our ancestors and can read books which give us some account of what happened to them, we must also know better than them. We certainly have more facts at our disposal. We have more wealth, both personal and national, better technology, and infinitely more skilful ways of preserving and extending our lives. But whether we today display more wisdom or common humanity is an open question, and as we look back to discover how people coped with the daily difficulties of existence a thousand [or less!] years ago, we might also consider whether, in all our sophistication, we could meet the challenges of their world with the same fortitude, good humour, and philosophy" [stress added]." Robert Lacey & Danny Danziger, 1999, The Year 1000: What Life Was Like At The Turn of the First Millennium - An Englishman's World, page 201.

"He had a term for people like this: temporal provincials--people who were ignorant of the past, and proud of it. Temporal provincials were convinced that the present was the only time that mattered, and that anything that had occured earlier could be safely ignored. The modern world was compelling and new, and the past had no bearing on it." Michael Crichton, 1999, Timeline (NY: Ballantine Books), page 84.

"By 'event' I mean the development, appearance, or publication of a scientific paper, or an influential scientific address, or a specific discovery, or a letter, or a photograph made during the use of laboratory equipment, or a page of a laboratory notebook, and so forth. Each of these has a physical residue that can be studied and that lends itself to the eventual formation of a consensus among competent observers who come to a historic case from different directions. It is in this case analogous to what an elementary particle physicist calls an event, for example, a trace of sparks in a spark chamber. The task of historians of science [or Anthropology!], then, is to use these events as the underlying factual base and to proceed inductively from that base [stress added]." Gerald Holton, 1986, The Advancement of Science, And Its Burdens (Cambridge University Press), page ix.

"In his perceptive little book Technopoly, Neil Postman argues that all disciplines ought to be taught as if they were history. That way, students 'can begin to understand, as they now do not, that knowledge is not a fixed thing but a stage in human development, with a past and a future.' I wish I'd said that first. If all knowledge has a past--and computer technology is surely a special kind of knowledge--then all knowledge is contingent [stress added]." Paul de Palma, 1999, http://www.when_is_enough_enough?.com. The American Scholar, Winter, reprinted in David Quammen [Editor], 2000, The Best American Science And Nature Writing 2000, pages 34-47 (Boston: Houghton Mifflin Co.), page 36.

"In 1543, Nicolaus Copernicus [1473-1543] published his epoch-making work, On the Revolution of Celestial Orbs, the first modern, mathematical demonstration of the heliocentric theory. In the same year a remarkable oung Belgian physician, Andreas Vesalius [1514-1564] , published an anatomical text that was to have equaly profound repurcussions on Western man's understanding of himself. Called On the Fabric of the Human Body (De humani corporis fabrica), it contained a series of magnificent illustrations, unsurpassed to this day, of the skeletal, muscular, vascular and neural structure of the body as a whole. Never before had the human body been represented with such accuracy, exactly as it appears to the eye of the anatomist. For the first time, the body was seen--as it is still seen today--as a natural mechanism [stress added]." Jacob Needleman, 1975, A Sense of the Cosmos: The Encounter of Modern Science and Ancient Truth (NY: Doubleday & Co., Inc.), page 37.

"Darwin's work, in particular, radically unnerved thousands who held a biblical view of humankind's historical story; and to this day the implications of his thinking for biology (and even psychology and sociology) have been profound. He himself became an agnostic and saw no great overall moral or philosophical meaning in the long chronology of our being, which he regarded, rather, as a story of acidents and incidents, of chance and circumstance as they all came to bear on 'natural selection.' Although Copernicus [1473-1543] and Galileo [1564-1642] and Newton [1642-1727] have been absorbed, so to speak, by traditional Christianity, by no means has Darwin's view of our origin and destiny been universally integrated into the teachings, the theology, of many religions that rely upon the Bible for their instpiration, their sense of who we are, where we came from, how our purpose here ought to be described. It was one thing for scientists to probe the planets, declare that this place we inhabit is only one spot in a seemingly endless number of places in an ever expanding universe, or to examine closely our body's cells, or othse of other creatures; it was quite another matter to suggest that we ourselves are merely an aspect of an ever changing nature, that our 'origin' was not 'divine' but a consequence of a biological saga of sorts [stress added]." Robert Coles, 1999, The Secular Mind (Princeton University Press), pages 50-51.

"He [Charles Darwin] believed that the natural world was the result of constantly repeated small and accumulative actions, a lesson he had first learned when reading Lyell's Principles of Geology on board the Beagle and had put to work ever since. ... No one, not even Lyell himself, or any of Darwin's closest friends and supporters, accepted as ardently as Darwin that the book of nature was about the accumulative powers of the small [stress added]." Janet Browne, 2002, Charles Darwin: The Power of Place - Volume II of a Biography (NY: Alfred A. Knopf), page 490.

"...I do believe something very magical can happen when you read a good book" [stress added]." (Joanne K. Rowling, 1999, Harry Potter Author Reveals The Secret.... In USA Weekend, November 12-14, 1999, page 4.)

"As the Spanish proverb says, 'He [or she], who would bring home the wealth of the Indies, must carry the wealth of the Indies with him.' So it is in travelling; a man must carry the wealth of the Indies with him, if he would bring home knowledge.' BOSWELL. 'The proverb, I suppose, Sir, means he must carry a large stock with him to trade with.' JOHNSON. 'Yes Sir.'" James Boswell [1740-1795], 1791, The Life of Samuel Johnson (NY: [1968] Signet Classic), page 467.

"The barbarous heathen are nothing more strange to us than we are to them.... Human reason is a tincture in like weight and measure infused into all our opinions and customs, what form soever they be, infinite in matter, infinite in diversity [stress added]." Michel Eyquem de Montaigne [1533-1592], Essays, page 53 [1959 paperback publication of a translation from 1603]. 

"Lord Voldemort's gift for spreading discord and enmity is very great. We can fight it only by showing an equally strong bond of fiendship and trust. Differences of habit and language are nothing at all if our aims are identical and our hearts open" [stress added]." Albus Dumbledore, In Harry Potter And The Goblet of Fire, 2000, by Joanne K. Rowling, page 723.

"....descriptions vary with the conceptual or theoretical framework within which they are couched. To evaluate a description properly one must know something about the theoretical framework that brought it into being." D. Kaplan and R. Manners, Culture Theory, 1972: 22.

"Lisa, get away from that jazzman! Nothing personal. I just fear the unfamiliar [stress added]." Marge Simpson, February 11, 1990, Moaning Lisa. Matt Groening et al., 1997, The Simpsons: A Complete Guide To Our Favorite Family (NY: HarperCollins), page 22.

"Much of the eighteenth century is often referred to as the Enlightenment or the Age of Enlightenment. Frequent reiteration does not make these terms any easier to define. ... The Enlightenment could be described as a tendency, rather than a movement, a tendency towards critical enquiry and the application of reason [stress added]." Jeremy Black, 1999, History of Europe: Eighteenth Century Europe, Second Edition (NY: St. Martin's Press), page 246.

"Anthropology is the product of three great historical movements: the Age of Exploration, the Enlightenment, and Evolutionism." Philip K. Bock, 1990, Rethinking Psychological Anthropology: Continuity and Change in the Study of Human Action, page 5.

"...the Scientific Revolution took place in Europe, not in the Muslim lands, India or China. There were two chief reasons for this, one internal to Europe and one not. During the twelfth and thirteenth centuries, Europe spawned the autonomous university.... which had a corporate legal existence that marked it off as a community where scholars were usually free to dispute as they saw fit. ... [#1] The survival of universities gave European scientists a supportive community not quite paralleled elsewhere in the world. ...[#2] Into this archipelago of intellectual liberty after 1450 came information from all over the world [stress added]." J.R. McNeill & William H. McNeill, 2003, The Human Web: A Bird's-Eye View of World History (NY: W.W. Norton & Co.), page 187.

"Travel teaches seven important lessons [according to Arthur Frommer, age 76, author of travel books].... 1. Travelers learn that all people in the world are basically alike. ... 2. Travelers discover that eberyone regards himself or herself as wiser and better than other people in the world. ... 3. Travel makes us care about strangers. ... 4. Travel teaches that not everyone shares your beliefs. ... 5. Travelers learn that there is more than one solution to a problem. ... 6. Travel teaches you to be a minority. ... 7. Travel teaches humility." Larry Bleiberg, 2003, Among Travel's Seven Important Lessons is Humility. The Sacramento Bee, February 2, 2003, page M3.

"The fundamental fact that shapes the future of anthropology is that it deals in knowledge of others. Such knowledge has always implied ethical and political responsibilities, and today the 'others' whom anthropologists have studied make those responsibilities explicit and unavoidable. One must consider the consequences for those among whom one works of simply being there, of learning about them, and of what becomes of what is learned [stress added]." Dell Hymes, 1972, The use of Anthropology: Critical, Political, Personal, IN Dell Hymes [Editor],1972, Reinventing Anthropology, pages 3-79, page 48,

NOTE SOME INFORMATION and STATISTICS:

"Roughly 45,000 new Ph.D.s [in all fields] will be graduating this year [2003], double the number from 35 years ago. Almost all believe they will turn their long, underpaid pursuit of truth into professorships - the tenured kind in which they can't be fired and can research what they spent five or more years studying. But universities, despite dangling tenured professorships like carrots to their graduate students, haven't double their tenure-track hiring. ... The Modern Language Association [for example] counted only 431 tenure-track English jobs landed in 2001, compared with 977 English Ph.D.s granted. One 1999 study found that ony 53% of students who received their English doctorate between 1983 and 1985 were tenured professors by 1995. A mere 8% were tenured professors at 'Carnegie Research I institutuions' - univrsities with their own major doctoral programs. All fine - if everyone knows the odds. But 51% of these English Ph.D.s took nine or more years to finish their degrees, and 95% took more than five. Would they have invested that kind of time if they had understood they had only an 8% chance of landing jobs like their professors held? One survey found only 35% of students received realistic job-placement information from their departments [stress added]." Laura Canderkam, 2003, System wastes Ph.D. brainpower. USA Today, May 20, 2003, page 13A.

Urbanowicz adds that a 1991 report noted that for Anthropology, the median time from the B.A. to the Ph.D. was 12.4 years; for comparison purposes, for Psychology it was 10.1 years and for Economics 9.1 years from B.A. to Ph.D. (R. L. Peters, 1992, Getting What You Came For: The Smart Student's Guide To Earning A Master's Or A Ph.D. (Farrar, Strauss and Giroux), page 12.) [And see: Urbanowicz 1993, http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Darwin116.html, or Essay #8, CHARLES R. DARWIN: HAPPY 116TH ANNIVERSARY below.]

For the 2001-2002 Academic Year, a total of 588 individuals received the Ph.D. in Anthropology: there were 331 females [56.3%] and 257 males [43.7%]; note, this includes degrees from Australia (13), Canada (39), Hong Kong (2), Mexico (7), Norway (6), and the United Kingdom (35). Source: The 2002-2003 American Anthropological Association Guide, page 606.

For the 2000-2001 Academic Year, a total of 603 individuals received the Ph.D. in Anthropology: there were 360 females [59.7%] and 243 males [40.3%]; note, this includes degrees from Australia (7), Canada (31), Ireland (1), Mexico (3), Norway (4), South Africa (1), and the United Kingdom (82). Source: The 2000-2001 American Anthropological Association Guide, page 582.

For the 1999-2000 Academic Year, a total of 641 individuals received the Ph.D. in Anthropology: no gender-specific information was provided. Note: this included degrees from Australia (11), Canada (39), China (1), Mexico (4), New Zealand (1), and the United Kingdom (30). Source: The 1999-2000 American Anthropological Association Guide, page 699.

For the 1998-1999 Academic Year, a total of 616 individuals received the Ph.D. in Anthropology: there were 349 females [57%] and 267 males [43%]. Source: The 1999-2000 American Anthropological Association Guide, page 553.

NOTE: "Doctoral research in anthropology [over the years 1891 to 1930] was mainly a young man's pursuit: more than 85 percent [of the total of 124 doctorates over this time period] were men, and more than 81 percent were under 35 at graduation, with half under 30 [stress added]." Jay H. Bernstein, 2002, First Recipients of Anthropological Doctorates in the United States, 1891-1930. The American Anthropologist, Vol. 104, No. 2, June, pages 551-565, page 557.

NOTE THE STATISTICS on "Anthropology Meetings" over the years: In New Orleans, November 2002, a total of 3,362 papers and 5,461 individuals registered for the meetings [including several CSU, Chico students!) (Anthropology News, February 2003, page 13). In 1967 at the national meetings there were 309 papers which increased to 2,274 papers in 1992 (with 5,161 registrations).

NOTE: the 2003 American Anthropological Association 102nd Annual Meeting will be held in Chicago, November 19-23; the 2004 American Anthropological Association 103rd Annual Meeting will be held in San Francisco, November 17-21. (And see http://www.aaanet.org/ = The American Anthropological Association]

"The single most important discovery for women explorers may be the freedom that lies at the heart of the very act of exploration." Reeve Lindberg, 2000, Introduction. Living With Cannibals And Other Women's Adventures, by Michele Slung (Washington, D.C., National Geographic Society), pages 1-7, page 2.

Biruté Galdikas} "Born [in 1946] to Lithuanian parents who emigrated to Canada in 1948, Biruté Galdikas traces her lifelong fascination with the natural sciences to the collection of wriggling tadpoles and salamanders she scooped up in a Toronto park not far from her house." Biruté Galdikas. Living With Cannibals And Other Women's Adventures, by Michele Slung (Washington, D.C., National Geographic Society), pages 126-137, page 128.

"The anthropologist is a human instrument studying other human beings and their societies. Although he [and she!] has developed techniques that give him [and her] considerable objectivity, it is an illusion for him to think he can remove his [or her] personality from his work and become a faceless robot or a machinelike recorder of human events [stress added]." Hortense Powdermaker [1896-1970], 1966, Stranger And Friend: The Way Of An Anthropologist, page 19.)

"But while I think that different social anthropologists who studied the same people would record much the same facts in their notebooks, I believe they would write different kinds of books. Within the limits imposed by their discipline and the culture under investigation anthropologists are guided in choice of theme, in selection and arrangement of facts to illustrate them, and in judgement of what is and what is not significant, by their different interests, reflecting differences of personality, of education, of social status, of political views, of religious convictions, and so forth. One can only interpret what one sees in terms of what one is, and anthropologists, while they have a body of knowledge in common, differ in other respects as widely as other people in their backgrounds of experience and in themselves. The personality of an anthropologist cannot be eliminated from his [or her!] work any more than the personality of an historian can be eliminated from his. Fundamentally, in his account of a primitive people the anthropologist is not only describing their social life as accurately as he can but is expressing himself also. In this sense his account must express moral judgement, especially where it touches matters on which he feels strongly; and what comes out of a study will to this extent at least depend on what the individual brings to it [stress added]." Sir Edward Evans-Pritchard [1902-1973], Fieldwork and the empirical tradition. Social Anthropology and Other Essays (1962), pages 64-85, pages 83-84.

"WHY STUDY THEORY? Theory is critical because, although anthropologists collect data through fieldwork, data in and of themselves are meaningless. Whether stated explicitly or assumed, theories are the tools anthropologists use to give meaning to their data. Anthropologists' understanding of the artifacts they collect or the events they record in the field is derived from their theoretical perspective." R.J. McGee & R.L. Warms, 2004, Anthropological Theory: An Introductory History, page 1.

"Why study the history of anthropological theory? Many students ask this question, and the answer is straightforward: anthropology is a product of its past, so to understand anthropology with sophistication, students [and all anthropologists!] need to know how it developed. ... There is, of course, no one history of anthropological theory. History depends on the historian, who is selective in presenting theories and who is influenced, consciously or unconsciously, by personal background, education, or 'agenda.' For this reason, no one textbook in the history of anthropological theory can ever be definitive, including the textbook written by the current editors, A History of Anthropological Theory (1998). ... There is also no one reader in the history of anthropological theory [stress added]." Paul A Erickson and Liam D. Murphy, 2002, Readings For A History of Anthropological Theory (Ontario, Canada: Broadview Press), page ix.

"It is useful to think of theory as containing four basic elements: (1) questions, (2) assumptions, (3) methods, and (4) evidence. The most important questions, to my mind, are 'What are we trying to find out?', and 'Why is this knowledge useful?' Anthropological knowledge could be useful, for example, either in trying to understand one's own society, or in trying to understand the nature of the human species [stress added]." Alan Barnard, 2000, History and Theory in Anthropology (Cambridge University Press), page 5.

"What is the past? Some might argue that, in a strict sense, it doesn't exist. The past is only the memory or residue of things that now exist in the present moment, a mental construction that--cleaned up or embellished--often serves the need of the current moment instead of corresponding to any historic 'truth' [stress added]." Alexander Stille, 2002, The Future of the Past (NY: Farrar, Strauss and Giroux), page 311.

"After dedicating their careers to studying exotic cultures in faraway lands, a few anthropologists are coming home. They're taking research techniques they once used in African shantytowns and Himalayan villages to Knights of Columbus halls, corporate office buildings and suburban shopping centers.... [The Anthropologists] study American families the way they would Polynesian cargo cults or Mongolian nomads--by inserting themselves into the daily lives of their subjects" [stress added]." Matt Crenson, 2000, Anthropologists Among Us. The Modesto Bee, July 17, 2000, pages D1 and D2.

"Feminist anthropology has been a forerunner in debates about power differentials between those observing and those being observed. This article explores how theoretical interventions made by third-wave feminists have led to revisions of the canon, particularly in the understandings of methodology (fieldwork), subject matter (culture), and ethnographic writing." Ravina Aggarwal, 2000, Traversing Lines of Control: Feminst Anthropology Today. The Annals of The American Academy of Political and Social Science, Vol. 571 (September 2000), pages 14-29, page 14.

"All across America, the landscape suffers from amnesia, not about everything, but about many crucial events and issues of our past. ... If we cannot face our history honestly, we cannot learn from the past [stress added]." James W. Loewen, 1999, What Our Historic Sites get Wrong: Lies Across America (NY: The New Press), pages 18 and 22).

"I love quotations. Maybe it's a symptom of a short-attention-span, instant-gratification age, but I'm a sucker for a well-stated tidbit of brevity and wit. For me, quotes do with precision what reading does in general: they confirm the astuteness of my perceptions, they open the way to ideas, and they console me with the knowledge that I'm not alone [stress added]." John Winkonur, 1990 [editor], W.O.W. Writers on Writing (Philadelphia: Running Press), page 1.

"A home without a library lacks diversity of voices, opinions and world views. When you read a book, you enter another person's perspective. And because a reader can put the book down and think about what the author has said, a good reader enters a dialogue with the author or the characters created by the author. One can reread passages and linger over thoughts or ideas or savor the deliciousness of the language. Television, even at its best, lacks diversity and the ability of a viewer to carry on an inner dialogue with the speakers or the authors of the program. Books encourage thinking. A reader must create images from the words the author has supplied, must imagine the events described, must track the plot or the logic of the writer and must visualize the main characters in the mind's eye. The book is in your hands. You can return to passages if there is something you don't understand. You can argue with the author in your head; you can nod in agreement. You learn, unconsciously, the way words can fit together--sometimes so well that they seem inevitable and irresistible [stress added]." Charles Levendosky, Read a banned book, give one to your children. The Sacramento Bee, October 2, 1999, page B7)

PLEASE NOTE THE FOLLOWING from USAToday of May 10, 2002: Kids get 'abysmal' grade in history: High school seniors don't know basics. "On the test: 57% of seniors could not perform even at the basic level. 32% performed at the basic level. 10% performed grade-level work, and 1% were advanced or superior. ... The federally mandated test was administered to 29,000 fourth-, eighth- and 12th-graders at 1,100 public and private schools. Fourth-and eighth-grade students did better than seniors, but not by much. ... [Sample Question]: When the United States entered the Second World War, one of its allies was: A) Germany. B) Japan. C) The Soviet Union. D) Italy. 52% failed to pick the correct answer, C. ... [stress added]." Tamara Henry, USAToday, May 10, 2002, page 1. (And see the web site: http://www.nces.ed.gov/nationsreportcard} National Center for Education Statistics.)

"Beliefs are like cow paths. The more often you walk down a path, the more it looks the right way." Richard Brodie, 1996, Virus Of The Mind: The New Science of the Meme [Seattle, WN: Integral Press], page 207.

"Don't fall in love with the theory of the case."
The character "Butch" Karp. Robert Tanenbaum, 1996, False Accused (NY: Signet Books), page 316.

"...all the time, the sure sense that something was just so, when it wasn't. Something that felt so good that it had to be.
You could build a great logical case out of pure bullshit, and it happened too frequently [stress added]."
Thoughts of the character Lucas Davenport. John Sanford, 2002, Mortal Prey (NY: G.P. Putnam's Sons), page 305.

Consider the words of Hermione Granger: "It's all in Hogwarts, A History. Though, of course, that book's not entirely reliable. A Revised History of Hogwarts would be a more accurate title. Or A Highly Biased and Selective History of Hogwarts Which Glosses Over the Nastier Aspects of the School." In Harry Potter And The Goblet of Fire, 2000, by Joanne K. Rowling, page 238.

"The unit of survival [or adaptation] is organism plus environment. We are learning by bitter experience that the organism which destroys its environment destroys itself. If, now, we correct the Darwinian unit of survival to include the environment and the interaction between organism and environment, a very strange and surprising identity emerges: the unit of survival turns out to be identical with the unit of mind" [italics in original; stress added]." Gregory Bateson [1904-1980], 1972, Steps To An Ecology of Mind (NY: Ballantine Books), page 483.

"Critiques of anthropology from within the discipline and from without have been a major feature of our intellectual life since the late 1960s. The theoretical and empirical bases of cultural and social anthropology have been under attack since the Marxist and New Left critiques of the 1960s to those coming more recently from poststructuralism, postmodernism and literate theory, and postcolonial and cultural studies. As a result, several academic generations have been educated by reading the attacks on the field but rarely dealing with the actual theoretical works and ethnographies of earlier anthropologists. This article deals with several of the most common charges leveled at anthropology, notably that it has regularly and necessarily exoticized 'Others,' has been ahistorical, and has treated each culture as if it were an isolate, unconnected to any other. It demonstrates how inaccurate and easily falsifiable such claims are and recommends a critical reevaluation of these unexamined and destructive cliches [stress added]." Herbert Lewis, 1998, The Misrepresentation of Anthropology and Its Consequences. American Anthropologist, Vol. 100, No. 3, pages 716-731, page 716.

"Finally, I wish to emphasize once more that what has been said here in a somewhat categorical form does not claim to mean more than the personal opinion of a man, which is founded on nothing but his own personal experience, which he has gathered as a student and as a teacher [stress added]." Albert Einstein [1879-1955]

Urbanowicz adds again: "I quote others only the better to express myself." (Michel Eyquem de Montaigne [1533-1592] French philosopher/essayist); or, in another translation: "I only quote others to make myself more explicit." (Essays, translated by J.M. Cohen, 1958, page 52).

Interesting (And Somewhat Appropriate General) Web Sites Are:

"Google has turned into a global sensation and is now widely regarded as the pre-eminent search engine [stress added]." Ben Elgin & Ronald Griver, 2003,Yahoo! Act Two. Business Week, June 2, 2003, pages 70 -76, pages 72-73.

http://www.tamu.edu/anthropology/news.html [Anthropology in The News]
http://www.oakland.edu/~dow/anthap.htm [The ANTHAP - Applied Anthropology Computer Network]
http://www.aaanet.org/ [American Anthropological Association]
http://www.unipv.it/webbio/dfantrop.htm [A Massive Anthropology site!]
http://www.csuchico.edu/lbib/anthropology/anthropology.html [Check out CSU Chico]
http://www.indiana.edu/~wanthro/theory.htm [Anthropology Theory from Indiana University]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/index.shtml [CHECK Out Anthropology Biographies from Minnesota State University, Mankato and their EMuseum]
http://people.bu.edu/pwood/Timelines.htm [A Timeline for Anthropologists by Peter W. Wood]
http://projects.prm.ox.ac.uk/kent/misc/histcov.html [History of Anthropology]
http://www.csuchico.edu/lins/chicorio/ [ChicoRio - Research Instruction On-Line]

ONCE AGAIN, FOR A "ROUGH" MASTER CHART OF SOME INDIVIDUALS (located towards the end of this Guidebook - or "roughly" in the middle-of-the-printed-volume), please click here. In addition to the Department of Anthropology "Home Page" at CSU, Chico (http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/), some Interesting (and specific CSU, Chico) web sites can be found by clicking here (located towards the end of this Guidebook - or "roughly" in the middle-of-the-printed-volume).


WHY MAN CREATES / The Edifice: A series of explorations, episodes, & comments on creativity:

Mumble, mumble, roar!
The lever.
Harry, do you realize you just invented the wheel?
I know, I know.

Bronze, Iron.
Halt.
All was in chaos 'til Euclid arose and made order.

What is the good life?
And how do you lead it?
Who shall rule the state?
The philosopher king.
The aristocrat.
The people.
You mean all the people? 

What is the nature of the good?
What is the nature of justice?
What is happiness? 

Hail Caesar!
Roman law is now in session.

Allah be praised, I've invented the zero.
What?
Nothing, nothing.

What is the shape of the earth?
Flat.
What happens when you get to the edge?
You fall off.
Does the earth move?
Never!

The earth moves.
The earth is round.
The blood circulates.
There are worlds smaller than ours.
There are worlds larger than ours. 

Hey, whatya doing?
I'ma paintin' the ceiling.
Whatya doing?
I'ma paintin' the floor.

Darwin says man is an animal.
Rot. Man is not an animal.
Animal.
Man.
Is.
Isn't. 

Hmmm. Shall we start from the beginning?

I'm a bug, I'm a germ.
Louie Pasteur!
I'm not a bug, I'm not a germ. 

Think it will work Alfred?
Let's give it a try.
Whatya think?
It worked.

All men are created equal....
Life, Liberty, and the pursuit....
Workers of the world....
Government of the people by the people....
The world must be made safe....
The war to end all wars....
A league of nations....
I see one third of a nation ill-housed....
One world....

Help!

# # #


PAYING FOR COLLEGE:

See: "The ABCs of College Loans: Between low rates and rebates you can cut your interest costs to as low as 2%" by Ann Tergesen in Business Week of May 12, 2003 (pages 104-106).

See: "The cost of attending four-year campuses jumped by more than a third in the last decade, far outpacing increases in parents' average income, says the College Board in New York." Loretta Kalb, 2003, Paying for college: It's a Money Hunt, The Sacramento Bee, May 18, 2003, page D1 and D3, page D1. The article also had the following web information about "saving and paying" for college:

http://www.wiredscholar.com [Resource for Applications]
http://www.petersons.com [ Peterson's Education Portal]
http://www.calpirgstudents.org [California's Student Environmental & Service Group]
http://www.salliemae.com [Information on Government-backed loans]
http://www.collegeboard.com [ College Board]
http://www.scholarshare.com [Golden State ScholarShare College Savings Trust]


WEEK 2. NO CLASS September 1 and Wednesday, September 3, 2003} History of theory continued. Key concepts, as well as Pre/Post-Darwin individuals and information.

Required Reading in: Langness: pp. xi-12, Chapter 1 (pp. 13-49) and glance at Langness Chapter 7 (pp. 188-217); please glance at the Kroeber & Kluckhohn 1952 publication Culture; please glance at Slotkin, pp. v-243. Please see Urbanowicz on "Four Fields" which may be found by clicking here: ESSAY #5 at the end of the printed volume.

"I cannot see that lectures can do so much as reading the books from which the lectures are taken."
Samuel Johnson [1709-1784]; as quoted in James Boswell [1740-1795], 1791, Life of Johnson.

YOU should have read any one of the following items, listed in WEEK 1, from the selections on RESERVE by Wednesday February 5, 2003:

Boorstin: pp. 626-635.
Darnell Selection #5 (pp. 61-77) or pp. 289-321.
Kardiner and Preble: pp. 11-32.
Mead & Bunzel: pp. 1-12.
Montagu: pp. 91-97, 49-145, and 157-162.
Naroll & Naroll: Ch 2 (pp. 25-56).
Penniman: part of Ch. 4 (pp. 73-110).
Stocking (1991): pp. 8-45.

PLEASE Continue reading Merryl Wyn Davies and Piero, 2002, Introducing Anthropology, pp. 1-19.

PLEASE NOTE} Do come to class EVERY-SINGLE-DAY with a "quotation" or a phrase that struck YOU in some way: either from this Guidebook or Langness or Davies & Piero.

CONSIDER THE IMPLICATIONS OF THE FOLLOWING WORDS:

"Culture, consisting as it does of mental constructs, is not directly observable. It cannot, therefore, constitute the empirical data of any discipline [stress added]." Walter W. Taylor, 1948 [1913-1997], A Study of Archaeology (Southern Illinois University press), page 108.

"Culture, or Civilization, taken in its wide ethnographic sense, is that complex whole which includes knowledge, belief, art, morals, law, custom, and any other capabilities and habits acquired by man as a member of society." Edward Burnett Tylor [1832-1917], 1871, Primitive Culture.

CULTURE: "...it denotes an historically transmitted pattern of meanings embodied in symbols, a system of inherited conceptions expressed in symbols, a system of inherited conceptions expressed in symbolic forms by means of which men [and women!] communicate, perpetuate, and develop their knowledge and attitudes towards life [stress added]." Clifford Geertz [born 1926], 1973, The Interpretation of Cultures (NY: Basic Books), page 89.

"Anthropology is the product of three great historical movements: the Age of Exploration, the Enlightenment, and evolutionism [stress added]." Philip K. Bock, 1980, Rethinking Psychological Anthropology: Continuity and Change in the Study of Human Action (NY: [1998] W.H. Freeman and Co.), page 5.

"The Enlightenment is commonly defined as a period that has emphasized the exercise of enlightened reason. It was not so much a doctrine of ideas as a method of pursuing ideas. Rigorous intellect without attachment to superstition or bias was its hallmark [stress added]." Jack Watson & Grant McKernie, 1993, A Cultural History of Theatre, page 244.

"The European Enlightenment of the eighteenth century occurred during that epoch in the history of man when he realised that he could both understand and control his environment. By his environment is meant society, political, social and economic arrangements, as well as the natural world, his health, the climate, the fabric of the earth itself. ... The Enlightenment was the period that in science saw the rise to considerable influence and acceptance of the experimental method of Isaac Newton [1642-1727] and the extension of that method to the study of society itself [stress added]." Anand C. Chitnis, 1976, The Scottish Enlightenment: A Social History (London: Croom Helm), page 4.

"The Scottish Enlightenment was an intellectual movement that complemented the Whig regime in the city [of Edinburgh]. It celebrated progressive ideas and witnessed significant contributions in fields as diverse as geology, minerology, chemistry, medicine, political economy, history, philosophy, architecture, poetry, and portrature. If there was a unifying theme of philosophy, it was that the 'improvement' of the natural world--by means of understanding and controlling it--was fundamentally good and proper. Related to this was the idea that Newton-inspired natural laws could and should be applied to many phenomena, such as human nature and human history. Immanuel Kant's [1724-1804] characterization for the Englightenment on the Continent also described the Scottish version: 'Dare to know' [sapere aude] [stress added]." Jack Repcheck, 2003, The Man Who Found Time: James Hutton And the Discovery of the Earth's Antiquity (Cambridge, MA: Perseus Books), pages 127-128.

ON certain individuals: "...of intelligence [who] notice more things and view them more carefully, but they comment on them; and to establish and substantiate their interpretation, they cannot refrain from altering the facts a little. They present things just as they are but twist and disguise them to conform to the point of view from which they have seen them; and to grain credence for their opinion and make it attractive, they do not mind adding something of their own, or extending and amplifying." Michel Eyquem de Montaigne [1533-1592] French philosopher/essayist), Essays, translated by J.M. Cohen, 1958, page 108.

REMEMBER: "Read not to contradict and confute; nor to believe and take for granted; nor to find talk and discourse; but to weigh and consider. Some books are to be tasted, others to be swallowed, and some few to be chewed and digested; that is, some books are to be read only in parts; others to be read but not curiously; and some to be read wholly, and with diligence and attention." Francis Bacon [1561-1626], English essayist and philosopher.

ON THE IMPORTANCE OF READING THE ORIGINALS, please note the following: "The abridgement of Les Misérables [originally published in French in 1862 by Victor Hugo, 1802-1885, is inevitably different from the complete novel. What is chiefly lost is the novel of ideas, the novel which treats a number of the central problems and interests of nineteenth-century France [stress added!]." James K. Robinson, "Introduction" to Les Misérables, 1961 (NY: Fawcett Premier), page 9.

"The Persian Letters [published in 1721 by Montesquieu [1686-1755], is among the earliest major works by students of man and society to apply what has been called the double optic of cultural relativism. It was this that enabled Montesquieu to regard his own society as a subject for investigation at least as problematical as any other." Melvin Richter, 1977, The Political Theory of Montesquieu, page 31.

"Who invented the telephone? Microsoft Corp's Encarta multimedia encyclopedia on CD-ROM has an answer to that simple question. Rather, two answers. Consult the U.S., U.K., or German editions of Encarta and you find the expected one: Alexander Graham Bell. But look at the Italian version and the story is strikingly different. Credit goes to Antonio Meucci, an impoverished Italian-American candlemaker who, as the Italian-language Encarta tells it, beat Bell to the punch by five years. Who's right? Depends on where you live. ... [stress added]." Kevin J. Delaney, 1999, Microsoft's Encarta Has Different Facts For Different Folks. The Wall Street Journal, June 25, 1999, page 1 & A11.

Carolus Linnaeus (1707-1778): "Latinized form of Carl von Linné. Swedish naturalist and physician. His botanical work Systema Naturae 1735 contained his system for classfiying plants into groups depending on shared characteristics (such as the number of stamens in flowers), providing a much-needed framework for identification. He also devised the concise and precise system for naming plants and animals, using one Latin (or Latinized) word to represent the genus and a second to distinguish the species." Sarah Jenkins Jones (Editor), 1996, Random House Webster's Dictionary of Scientists, page 299.

"Borrowing from contemporary scientific models, thinkers in the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries such as the Marquise de Condorcet [1745-1794] and August Comte [1798-1857] believed that human history was bound by laws. If these could be understood and the fruits of this research judiciously applied, time would bring progress. Instead of the Christian emphasis on the salvation of the individual, thinkers prophesized that all humankind could partake of this new prosperity and knowledge. This shift in historical imagination can also be traced to the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries, when the agricultural and industrial revolutions made prosperity possible for the multitude instead of the select few. Applied technology revolutionized old economic traditions wherein an elite minority thrived on the labor of serfs and slaves. The nineteenth-century industrial revolution proved the success of the happy union of science and applied technology that further fortified European optimism. Nature could be tamed, mastered, and minipulated to provide a harmonious and knowable world, and technology could be used to create wealth and exploit resources at an unprecedented rate. In this new age of optimism, a secular version of history highlighted the steady march of select nations toward progress, reason, and scientific knowledge. It replaced the Christian view old history, which traced humankind's sorrowful exile from the garden of Eden [stress added]." Choi Chatterjee et al., 2002, The 20th Century: A Retrospective (Cambridge, MA: Westview/Perseus Books), pages 3-4.

"The Marquis de Condorcet (1743-94), who contributed on mathematical subjects to the Encyclopédie, became perpetual secretary of the Académie des Sciences and supported Turgot's reforms and freedom of trade. He advanced probability theory (applying it outside the mechanical sciences) and wrote for a popular audience. In his General Picture of Science, which has for its Object the Application of Arithmetic to the Moral and Political Sciences (1783) Condorcet argued that a knowledge of probability, 'social arithmetic', allowed people to make rational decisions, instead of relying on instinct and passion. Condorcet was a great believer in the possibility of indefinite progress through human action, seeing the key in education. He believed that acquired characteristics could be inherited and thus that education could have a cumulative effect [stress added]." Jeremy Black, 1999, History of Europe: Eighteenth Century Europe, Second Edition (NY: St. Martin's Press), page 320.

Georges Cuvier (1769-1832): "Cuvier's greatest claim to fame is that he founded the science of fossils, paleontology--at least for the vertebrata, that of the invertebreta having already been adumbrated by Lamarck. ... By concentrated study of the scattered bonex excavated from the gypsum quarries on the hills of Montmartre, he succeeded in reconstructing the complete skeletons of Paleothorium and Anoplotherium; he was guided in doing so by the principle of 'correlation of forms,' according to which all parts of an organic being a correlated and combine to produce a common action. ... One of Cuvier's most important discoveries was that every geological stratum contains fossils peculiar to it [stress added]." Jean Rostand, 1963, The Development of Biology. The Nineteenth Century World: Readings From The History of Mankind (edited by Guy S. Métraux and Françoise Crouzet; New York: New American Library), pages 177-192, page 185.

"Naturalists like Lamarck [1744-1829] and Erasmus Darwin [1731-1802] were intrigued by the eighteenth-century idea that unlimited progress and organic change were possible, but the fears generated by the excesses and terrors of the French Revolution did much to eclipse the hope of progress. Stability in society and nature seemed more desirable than limitless, unpredictable change. Indeed, evolutionary theories and their advocates were rejected and ridiculed by one of France's most eminent scientists, Georges Leopold Chrétien Frédéric Dagobert, Baron Cuvier (1769-1832). Georges Cuvier, preeminent comparative anatomist and founder of paleontology, was an implacable opponent of Lamarckian ideas in general and evolutionary ideas in particular [stress added]." Lois N. Magner, 2002, A Hisory of the Life Sciences (NY: Marcel Dekker, Inc.), pages 313-314.

"A colorful eccentric [William] Buckland [1784-1856], approached geology with a chaotic enthusiasm. Bones, skins, skulls, stones, all lay scatered about his rooms. They even spilled over onto his breakfast table, where it was said that toast and trilobites fought for space. To add to the effect, he combined this love of chaos with an adventurous--some would say bizarre--culinary taste. Delicacies such as hedgehog, crocodile or bear were served to unway visitors, while those in the know made their excuses. ... Buckland soon found evidence that persuaded him that Cuvier [1769-1832] was right, and that Europe had recently been submerged beneath a tremendous flood. ... On the strength of this evidence, Buckland believed he had confirmed the events of genesis. ...However, not everyone was convinced. Several geologists thought Buckland had twisted the evidence to fit the Bible..... Chief among this group was Lyell [1797-1875] [stress added]." Martin Gorst, 2001, Measuring Eternity: The Search for the Beginning of Time (NY: Broadway Books), pages 141-143.

"During the winter of 1750-1751, Adam Smith [1723-1790] in Edinburgh and Baron Turgot [1727-1781] at the Sorbonne each gave lectures attempting a more general or scientific formulation of the idea of progress in cvilization. While Smith's did not as such survive, Turgot's clearly reflect the stimulus of Montesquieu [ 1686-1755], with one profound difference: Turgot's comparison is structured by time. An early passage provides a clear statement of what was later to be called the 'comparative method' of sociocultural evolutionism: 'thus the present state of the world...spreads out at one and the same time all the gradations from barabarism to refinement, thereby reveealing to us at a single glance...all the steps taken by the human mind, a reflection of all the stages through which it has passed' [stress added]." George W. Stocking, Jr., 1987, Victorian Anthropology (NY: The Free Press), page 14.

"During the nineteenth century most fields of social inquiry were clearly dominated by evolutionary or developmental orientations. The discovery of distant lands, exotic people, and extraordinary new animal species all had greatly widened the intellectual purview of European scholars and enormously expanded the time scale within which man had formerly been considered. The fixed and static catgegories of medieval thought were gradually discarded (not without a soul-searching wrench, of course), to be replaced by notions of change and evolution, in the developing biological sciences as well as the inchoate social disciplines. In anthropology, pioneers like Edward B. Tylor [1832-1917] (Primitive Culture, 1871), Lewis Henry Morgan [1818-1881] (Ancient Society, 1877), and Sir Henry Maine [1822-1888] (Ancient Law, 1861) were exponents of the evolutionary position. Even in sociology, which had not yet become sharply distinguished from anthroppology, such outstanding figures as Herbert Spencer [1820-1903] (Principles of Sociology, 1876) and Emile Durkheim [1858-1917] (Division of Labor in Society, 1893) either argued for the evolutionary point of view with passion (Spencer) or accepted and operated within its basic assumption (Durkheim. ... It is true, of course, that Darwin's writing lent great impetus to the interest in cultural evolutionism, but the nineteenth-century evolutionists owe more to the French Enlightenment writers such as Condorcet [1743-1794], David Hume [1711-1777], and Adam Smith [1723-1790] than they do to Charles Darwin [1809-1882]. Clearly, development and evolution were in the air [stress added]." David Kaplan and Robert A. Manners, 1972, Culture Theory (New Jersecy: Prentice-Hall), page 36.

"The refusal to acknowledge human nature is like the Victorians' embarrasment about sex, only worse: it distorts our science and scholarship, our public discourse, and our day-to-day lives. Logicians tell us that a single contradiction can corrupt a set of statements and allow falsehoods to proliferate through it. The dogma that human nature does not exist, in the face of evidence from science and common sense that it does, is just such a corrupting influence [stress added]." Steven Pinker, 2002, The Blank Slate: The Modern Denial of Human Behavior (NY: Viking/Penguin), page ix.

"Anthropology has been for some time now undergoing a critique led largely by ethnographers, who must face most squarely the moral ambiguities of their surveillance and its public uses. Most of the historical examination of the field has been directed at the nineteenth century's climax of bad faith; the mutual aid offered each other by academic anthropology and the imperial state has by now been amply documented and lamented [stress added]." [The author's footnote #53 refers to her footnote #18 and numerous references, including: Edward Said, 1979, Orientalism; Clifford & Marcus, 1986, Writing Culture; G.W. Stocking, 1983, Observers Observed; G.W. Stocking, 1987, Victorian Anthropology, as well as many more references.] Mary Baine Campbell, 1999, Wonder & Science: Imagining Worlds in Early Modern Europe (Cornell University Press), page 66.

"This is a fantastic job. In my wildest dreams in graduate school, I couldn't have imagined a job this great." (John Sherry, anthropologist who studies computer use in extreme environments for Intel) AND "Over the year, [Bonnie] Nardi ["long-time design anthropologist who has worked at Hewlett-Packard and Apple and now does research at AT&T Labs West in Menlo Park, Calif."] has seen the idea of anthropology as a useful addition to industry becoming more commonplace. Today, both the University of California, Irvine, and Georgia Tech include ethnographic training as part of their computer science degree programs. 'They're attracting not just supergeeks, but people who want to work on the border of people and technology,' she says [stress added]." Elizabeth Weise, 1999, Companies Learn Value of Grass Roots: Anthropologists Help Adapt Products to World's Cultures. USA Today, May 26, 1999, page 4D. 

"Writing about a career teaching physical anthropology at a university is rather akin to writing about what it is like to undergo a colonoscopy or to visit Seattle. It is simply impossible to do justice to the experience with oral or written descriptions. One must truly experience it to appreciate everything that it is, in all of its marvelous nuances [stress added]." Curtis W. Eienker,2002, Teaching Physical Anthropology in a University: The Traditional Career. In A Guide to Careers in Physical Anthropology, Alan S. Ryan [Editor] (Westport, Conn: Bergin & Garvey), pages 21-41, page 21.

"Whatever name you ascribe to this style of working--flexibility, open-mindedness, divergent thinking--staying loose in the early stages of a project greatly improves the chances for a more creative result. But why? One reason is that a loose, uncensored approach increases the amount of material you have to work with. Volume alone produces options; options permit the exercise of opinion and taste [stress added]." Denise Shekerjian, 1990, Uncommon Genius: How Great Ideas Are Born (NY: Viking Penguin), page 40.

"Knowledge is power--all Scottish philosopherss recognized this--and the route to knowledge is through experience [stress added]." Arthur Herman, 2001, How the Scots Invented The Modern World: The True Story of How Western Europe's Poorest Nation Created Our World & Everything in It (NY: Crown Publishers), page 222.

Interesting (And Somewhat Appropriate) Web Sites Are:

http://www.uncwil.edu/stuaff/career/anthropology.htm [Anthropology careers]
http://home.worldnet.fr/clist/Anthro/Texts/ [Anthropology Resources on the Internet]
http://www.csuchico.edu/lref/guides/rbs/anthro.htm [Anthropology Resources beginning with CSU, Chico]
http://www.hti.umich.edu/e/ehraf/ [Electronic HRAF! - begin from CSU, Chico]
http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/cccpwebsite/ [Chico Campus Culture Project]
http://www.sjsu.edu/depts/anthropology/svcp/ [The Silicon Valley Cultures Project]
http://www.boston.com/dailyglobe2/067/science/Science_fits_nicely_between_art_reality+.shtml [Science Fits Nicely Between Art+Reality]
http://cepa.newschool.edu/het/profiles/ferguson.htm [Adam Ferguson} 1723-1815]
http://www.aaanet.org/gad/history/021hoebel.pdf [E.A. Hoebel, 1960} William Robertson: An 18th Century Anthropologist-Historian]


VIDEO NOTES ON: KOESTLER ON CREATIVITY = "Noted author Arthur Koestler [1905-1983] discusses his theories concerning the conscious and unconscious processes underlying creativity, emphasizing scientific discovery but considering artistic originality as well." The video is based on Koestler's 1964 book: The Act Of Creation: A Study of the Conscious and Unconscious in Science And Art . A chart in the book indicates "that we can arrange neighboring provinces of science and art in a series which show a continuous gradient from 'objective' to 'subjective,' from 'verifiable truth' to 'aesthetic experience' ... The point...is to show that regardless of what scale of values you choose to apply, you will move across a continuum without sharp breaks: there are no frontiers where the realm of science ends and that of art begins [stress added]." (1964: 28).

Verifiable

OBJECTIVE

Emotional

SUBJECTIVE

Chem
Biochem
Biology
Medicine
Psych
ANTH
History
Biograph
Novel
Epic
Lyric

VIDEO: Koestler points out that the "combinatorial act" is the key: "Science as the marriage of ideas which were previously strangers to each other or even thought incompatible."

NOTE: "Arthur Koestler [1905-1983] was a journalist of genius and an outstanding chronicler of his times. He wrote half a dozen novels, one a classic and several more of enduring value, two superb volumes of autobiography and dozens of eloquently phrased, stimulating and frequently memorable essays on a host of subjects. One cannot stand in awe of his corpus of work, or the intellectual energy and sheer effort that went into it. Yet today he is not as well known as he should be and the time has surely come for a re-evaluation of this remarkable man and his extraordinary career." David Cesarani, 1998, Arthur Koestler: The Homeless Mind (NY: The Free Press), page 1.)

NOTE: Koestler's approach is similar to that of Jacob Bronowski [1908-1974] who wrote that "No scientific theory is a collection of facts. ... The act of fusion is the creative act. All science is the search for unity in hidden likenesses. The search may be on a grand scale, as in the modern theories which try to link the fields of gravitation and electromagnetism. ... The scientist looks for order in the appearance of nature by exploring such likenesses. For order does not display itself of itself; if it can be said to be there at all, it is not there for the mere looking. There is no way of pointing a finger or a camera at it; order must be discovered and, in a deep sense, it must be created. What we see, and as we see it, is mere disorder. ... Science finds order and meaningness in our experience, and sets about this in a quite different way. ... The discoveries of science, the works of art are explorations--more, explosions of a hidden likeness. The discovery or the artist presents in them two aspects of nature and fuses them into one. This is the act of creation, in which an original thought is born, and it is the same act in original science and original art.... [stress added] Jacob Bronowski, 1956, Science And Human Values, pp. 12-19.

"It is obvious, says Jacques Hadamard, that invention or discovery, be it in mathematics or anywhere else, takes place by combining ideas. ... The latin verb cogito for 'to think' etymologically means 'to shake together.' St. Augustine [354-430 A.D.] had already noticed that and also observed that intelligo means 'to select among'" (1964: 120). As Koestler points out: "Some writers identify the creative act in its entirety with the unearthing of hidden analogies. 'The discoveries of science, the works of art are explorations--more, are explosions of a hidden likeness', Bronowski wrote.... [analogies are] created by the imagination; and once an analogy has been created, it is of course there for all to see--just as the poetic metaphor, once created, soon fades into a cliche. ... Thus the real achievement in discovery is that unlikely marriage of cabbages and kings--of previously unrelated frames of reference or universes of discourse--whose union will solve the previously unsoluble problem. The search for the improbable partner involves long and arduous thinking--but the ultimate matchmaker is the unconscious [stress added]." Arthur Koestler, The Act Of Creation: A Study of the Conscious and Unconscious in Science And Art ,1964: 200-201.

"My view is that knowledge is a rearrangement of experience, in which we put together those experiences that seem to us to belong together, and put them apart from those that do not [stress added]." Jacob Bronowski [1908-1984], The Identity of Man, 1966: 26.

"When you ferret out something for yourself, piecing the clues together unaided, it remains for the rest of your life in some way truer than facts you are merely taught, and freer from onslaughts of doubt." Colin Fletcher, 1968, The Man Who Walked Through Time, p. 109.

"In the end, the common themes linking these creative people separated and floated to the surface like cream. Some of what I discovered I expected: they were all driven, remarkably resilient, adapt at creating an environment that suited their needs, skilled at honoring their own peculiar talents instead of lusting after an illusion of self, capable of knowing when to follow their instincts, and above all, magnificent risk-takers, unafraid to run ahead of the great popular tide [stress added]." Denise Shekerjian, 1990, Uncommon Genius: How Great Ideas Are Born (NY: Viking Penguin), page xxii.

"Every innovation is a combination of ideas. The only bonds between its part in a cultural setting are mental connections; they are instituted with the first individual mind to envisage them, and they dissolve with the last individual mind to retain a recollction of them. The mental content is socially defined; its substance is, in major part, dictated by tradition. But the manner of treating this content, of grasping it, altering it, and rendering it, is inevitably dictated by the potentialities and the liabilities of the machine which does the manipulating: namely the individual mind. ... Every individual is basically innovative for two reasons. No two stimuli to which he [or she] reacts are ever identical. ... The second reason for diversified reactions is that no one ever or minutely duplicates his responses to what he regards as the same stimulus [stress added]." H.G. Barnett [1906-1985], 1953, Innovation: The Basis of Cultural Change (NY: McGraw-Hill), pages 16-20.

Science: "A search for the principles of law and order in the universe, and as such an essentially religious endeavor." Arthur Koestler [1905-1983].

"One day in 1921, an English bacteriologist happened to have a cold, so he added a bit of his own nasal mucus to a petri dish just to see what might be cultured out of it. A few weeks later, he noticed that the bacteria growing in the dish--a harmless type of coccus--had failed to grow in the area near the mucus. Something in the mucus was dissolving and killing the bacteria. The bacteriologist called that something 'lysozyme,' and over the ensuing years of intensive investigation of the substance, he found it in tears; sweat; saliva; the mucus linings of the cheeks; fingernail parings; hair; sperm; mother's milk; the leukocytes and phagocytes of blood; the fibrin that forms scabs over wounds; the slime of earthworms; the leaves and stalks of numerous plants including buttercups, peonies, nettles, tulips, and turnips; and in very high concentration in egg whites. He had stumbled upon the first natural anti-infective, an enzyme later given the chemical name 'mucopeptide glucohydrolase.' This scientist would, eight years later, accidentally find something else in one of his petri dishes, a substance that would change the life of almost everyone on the planet. The bacteriolgist's name was Alexander Fleming [1881-1955], and he would name this new discoverf 'penicillin' [and shares the Nobel Prize in Medicine in 1945]. Of course, the discovery pf penicillin and the many other antibiotics (more than a hundred are in use today) was not the end of the story. Microbes did not succumb so easlity to human ingenuity. ... Germs reproduce quickly, creating many generations within hours. With such rapid reproduction comes ample opportunity for genetic mutation. And one of the ways germs fight back is by producing genetic mutations that give them resistance to the antibiotics we use to try to eradicate them. Every time we take an antibiotic, we are killing the weakest germs and allowing the strongest--the resistant ones--to reproduce. Eventually, only resistant germs survive, and the antibiotic that was once effective against them becomes less effective or even useless. This phenomenon was noticed very early on in the development of antibiotics. In 1945, it took a total of about 40,000 units of penicillin to cure a case of pneumococcal pneumonia. Today [2003], because the germ is now resistant to low doses, as many as 24 million units of penicillin a day are given to effect a cure in severe cases. Some diseases for which penicillin was once effective are now completely resistant to it, even in large doses [stress added]." Nicholas Bakalar, 2003, Where the Germs Are: A Scientific Safari (New Jersey: John Wiley & Sons, Inc.), pages 5-6.

"Scientific inquiry is problem solving, and our knowledge grows as we propose theories to explain what we do not understand, and then criticize them in an attempt to eliminate their errors. Our understanding of ourselves and of the world we live in, like life itself, is constantly changing [stress added]." Mark Notturno, 2003, On Popper [1902-1994] (Thomson/Wadsworth), page 70.

In the first decades of the 20th century, nature held sway over nurture in most fields. In the wake of World War I [1914-1918], however, three men recaptured the social sciences for nurture: John B. Watson [1878-1958], who set out to show how the conditioned reflex, discovered by Ivan Pavlov [1849-1936], could explain human learning; Sigmund Freud [1856-1939], who sought to explain the influence of parents and early experiences on young minds,; and Franz Boas [1858-1942], who argued that the origin of ethnic differences lay with history, experiences and circumstance, not physiology and psychology [stress added]." Matt Ridley, 2003, What Makes You Who You Are. Time, June 2, 2003, pages 54-63, pages 58-59.

"The three dominant themes on behavior for a good part of the [20th] century were Freudianism, which said aberrant behavior was produced by the childhood environment; Boasism, which said behavior was produced by the cultural environment; and behaviorism, which said behavior resulted from environmental conditioning and learning. All were united in enthroning the environment as the determinant of human behavior and in relegating biological inheritance to insignificance. This three-pronged environmentalism was the accepted wisdom that was taught in all universities and that informed serious writing on human behavior--social problems, psychological problems, mental illness--or normal child development. Professor [Henry] Higgins may have run amok, but he had also taken over--and remained in control until only recently [stress added]." William Wright, 1998, Born That Way: Genes, Behavior, Personality (NY: Knopf), page 170.

"There was a time--from about 1915 to 1935--when the dominant methological stance in American anthropology was 'historical.' Its leading figure, Franz Boas [1858-1942], was responsible for the training of such major anthropologists as Alfred Kroeber [1876-1960], Robert Lowie [1883-1957], Edward Sapir [1884-1939], Paul Radin [1883-1959], Ruth Benedict [1887-1948], Alexander Goldenweiser [1880-1940], and others. Boas and his students reacted strongly against the speculative formulations of the nineteenth-century evolutionists, and in so doing gave to American anthropology and anti-evolutionary bias that tended to dominate the discipline until the end of World War II [stress added]." David Kaplan and Robert A. Manners, 1972, Culture Theory (New Jersecy: Prentice-Hall), pages 70-71.

"Malinowski's [1884-1942] position in British anthropology is analogous to that of Boas [1858-1942] in American Anthropology.... Like Boas, Malinowski was a Central European natural scientists brought by peculiar circumstances to anthropology and to the English-speaking world. Like Boas, he objected to armchair evolutionism and invented a fieldwork tradition based on the use of native language in 'participant observation'. Furthermore, both Boas and Malinowski were pompous but liberal intellectuals who built up very strong followings through their postgraduate teaching [stress added]." Alan Barnard, 2000, History and Theory in Anthropology (Cambridge University Press), pages 65-66.


"Web Surfing Is Fast Way To Go Job Hopping." The Wall Street Journal, May 27, 1999, page B12 [some sources]:
http://www.monster.com
http://www.hotjobs.com
http://www.dice.com
http://www.net-temps.com/
http://www.careerpath.com
http://www.jobs.net

"Our winning strategy for finding your perfect job comes from Samantha H. in Jamaica, N.Y. 'First thing, let's not call it a job but your life's career. Job sounds so humdrum, put upon and boring. My mother gave me the best advice: 'Look for the thing that has been with you all of your life. It has brought you through good and bad times. Once you find it, then that is what you should be doing [stress added].'" Bob Rosner, 2001, Working Wounded. The San Francisco Chronicle, December 2, 2001, page J2.

Career Planning & Placement Office
http://www.csuchico.edu/plc/welcome2.html

Office of Experiential Education
http://ids.csuchico.edu/

"CSU, Chico's Experiential Education program links the University to business, industry, and government by giving students an opportunity to combine classroom study with career related work experience. The program helps students define their educational goals and prepare for their careers by exploring the realities of the working world."


CALIFORNIA / CHICO WORDS: A "Story" about Chico in the year 2027 may be viewed by clicking here: ESSAY #6 at the end of this printed Guidebook; you may also wish to read ESSAY #7 concerning "Cancer" in the State of California.]

"If you want to inform yourself about the single most important factor influencing California's present and future, enter www.dof.ca.gov in your Internet browser and look at the state's newest compilation of popultation data. ... July [2002], California's population stood at 35.3 million, a yearly gain of 603,000 or 1.74 percent..... The 2001-02 growth consisted of 528,151 births--just over one a minute--offset by 232,790 deaths, but augmented by 307,640 immigrants.... California's population growth, about 1,650 people each day [~13.75/minute], is not occuring evenly in the state.... [stress added]." Dan Walters, 2003, State's Past, Present and Future Found in Population Figures. The Sacramento Bee, February 2, 2003, page A3.

THE POPULATION of the Chico area is 99,375. There are 66,800 individuals within the City Limits of Chico. (January 1, 2002 estimates by the California Department of Finance.) Anon. 2002,The Chico Enterprise-Record, June 29, 2002 Special Section, Discover: Your Complete Guide, page 10.

"We're still growing: Chico breaches 100,000 population" by Laura Urseny (Business Editor), The Chico Enterprise-Record (May 8, 2003), page 1: On January 1, 2002, the estimated "Chico urban area" population was 99,375 and on January 1, 2003 it was 100,500 (page 2).

FROM "The Official City of Chico Web Site" at http://www.chico.ca.us/ "The City of Chico was founded in 1860 by General John Bidwell, and became incorporated in 1872 with a population of approximately 1000 persons in an area of 6.6 square miles. By 2001, the City of Chico had grown to include a population of 64,581 persons in an area of 22 square miles [stress added]."

NOTE: According to The World Almanac and Book of Facts 2003 (page 366), the estimated population for California in 2001 was 34,501,130. It has been estimated that the population for California in the following years will be: 39,957,616 (in the year 2010), 45,448,627 (2020), and 58,731,006 (2040). (Chico Enterprise-Record, December 18, 1998, page 4A); "By 2040, the state [of California] will have 58.7 million residents, a 75 percent increase, according to Department of Finance projections. The population in some counties could more than triple [stress added]." (Chico Enterprise-Record, May 2, 1999, page 1B)

"I knew there was something special about Chico the minute I laid eyes on it, and not just because it is a standout among Central Valley cities. In city planner terms, Chico has 'a strong sense of place.' To me, it's enough to say that Chico has a 'there.' When you arrive here, you immediately sense that you have reached a desirable place. You want to get out of the car and walk around. And after doing that, you want to find a job, buy a house and live here the rest of your life. You can't say that about most California cities [stress added]." Steve Brown, 2001, But This Is Chico. Enterprise-Record, January 1, 2001, page 2A.

"In 1950, the population of Chico was 12,722. The population more than doubled by 1980, to 26,601. During the past two decades, those numbers have increased to 64,581 in the City limits, and approximately 95,000 in the Chico Urban Area. Projections provided by the Butte County Association of Governments (BCAG) lists the population [of the city of Chico] at 75,879 in the year 2010, 85,364 in 2015, 90,035 in 2020, and 108,039 in the year 2025 [stress added]." Anon., 2002, Celebrate the Building Industry! Special Section ("Industrial Barbecue 2002") of The Chico Enterprise-Record, June 18, 2002, page 3.

"California's population continues to grow by more than 500,000 people a year. Such growth brings a host of challenges--how to provide enough affordable housing, adequate transportation, schools and jobs. In order to address these challenges, local cities and governments should be encouraged to work together and create regional growth management policies [stress added]." Elizabeth Klementowski, 2002, Flawed solution to an imaginary problem. The San francisco Chronicle, June 18, 2002, page A19.

"...California is not done growing. Over the next 20 years, another 15 million people will be born in, or move to, the Golden State [which had an estimated March 2001 population of 33,871,648 residents] [stress added]." Robert W. Poole, 2001, The Wall Street Journal, August 29, 2001, page A14.

"Saying California grows by one new person every minute, a major land developer is recommending significant state governments reforms to prevent California from becoming unlivable withing 20 to 40 years. Amid projections of 58 million residents by 2040.... [stress added]." The Sacramento Bee, October 5, 2002. Jim Wasserman, Rapid Growth Called a Threat; AND FROM The San Francisco Chronicle (October 6, 2002): "...predicts there will be 48 million people in California by the year 2025, up from about 34 million in 2000. By 2040, the number could rise to 58 million [stress added]." And check out http://www.census.gov/cgi-bin/popclock to see what it is now: it was printed in your Guidebook that on August 1, 2003, the population of the USA was 291,663,907. What is it when you read this page now?

On Changes in California: "Almost 70,000 acres of California's open space was devoured by a growing population lured to the state by its booming economy from 1996 to 1998, according to a state report released Wednesday [October 11, 2000]. The urban sprawl is driven by California's influx of roughly 700,000 people a year [stress added]." Open space continues vanish act in state. (Associated Press) The Sacramento Bee, October 12, 2000, page A3.

On Sunday, June 24, 2001, an article appeared in The Sacramento Bee (Alvin D. Sokolow, How Much State Farmland Is Disappearing? pages L1 and L6) based on research from University of California, Davis, now provides the figure of "only" 49,700 acres of California farmland disappearing each year! Incidentally, the CSU, Chico campus (excluding the University farm, is approximately 119 acres (so approximately 417 Chico State campuses disappear every year in California!).

"For millions of Californians, housing is the cross they must bear for living here. There simply isn't enough of it. For nearly 20 years, California's home-building industry has lagged behind the state's population growth." Jim Wasserman, 2001, Experts Warn Housing Shortage Even Worse In Future. The San Francisco Chronicle, July 29, 2001, page A19.

CHICO: "The city's general plan targets an urban-area population of approximately 134,000 by the year 2012 [stress added]." Dan Nguyen-Tan, 2002, Growth: Land is our most valuable and limited resource. The Chico Enterprise-Record, February 26, 2002, Section AA, page 3AA. [NOTE: Urbanowicz would also add that time can also be considered to be the most valuable and limited resource.]

"Fortune continues to smile on this city at the dawn of the 23rd Century, Chico Grande, at 500,000 people, is the unofficial capital of Upper California [stress added!]" Steve Brown, 2001, In the year 2202, fortune continues to smile on this city. The Chico Enterprise-Record, December 31, 2001, page 3A.

QUESTIONS TO CONSIDER: What will the population of the USA or California or Chico be by 2042? Or 2022? or next year?! What is the "carrying capacity" of any given environment? What changes have to be made in any given environment? What will be the impact of an increasingly older American population on this country? On you?

NOTE: There are more than 6 billion people on the planet and population is increasing by approximately 78,000,000 people per year; given that 1 year = 365.25 days = 8,766 hours = 525,960 minutes, therefore 78,000,000/525,960 = means that the population of the planet is increasing by approximately 148 people a minute. For this 75 minute class, please note that this means that the world will have had a NET INCREASE (births-minus-deaths) of ~11,100 individuals (roughly speaking).

NOTE: "If we could shrink the Earth's population to a village of precisely 100 people, with all existing ratios [on the planet] remaining the same, it would look like this: 51 females, 49 males; 70 non-white, 30 white; 57 Asians, 21 Europeans, 14 from the Western Hemisphere, and 8 Africans; 70 non-Christians, 30 Christians. 50 percent of the wealth would be in the hands of six people. All six of those people would be from the United States. 80 would live in substandard housing. 70 would be illiterate. 50 would suffer from malnutrition. 1 would be near death, 1 near birth. 1 would be college educated. No one would own a computer." (Chico Enterprise-Record, June 19, 1999, page 3B.)

PLEASE NOTE: According to the U.S. Bureau of the Census, the resident population of the United States, projected to August 1, 2003, at 9:40:38am [Pacific Standard Time] was 291,663,907 [http://www.census.gov/cgi-bin/popclock]. This means there is one birth every 8 seconds, one death every 13 seconds, one international migrant (net) every 22 seconds, for a net gain of one person every 10 seconds.

AND INCIDENTALLY, a fascinating (and useful site) is http://www.xist.org/index.php [GeoHive: Global Statistics]. Have a look!

Thomas Robrt Malthus (1766-1834): "English economist [and cleric!]. His Essay on the Principle of Population 1798 (revised 1803) argued for population control, since populations increase in geometric ratio and food supply only in arithmetic ratio, and influenced Charles Darwin's thinking on natural selection as the driving force of evolution. Malthus saw war, famine, and disease as necessary checks on population growth" [stress added]." Sarah Jenkins Jones (Editor), 1996, Random House Webster's Dictionary of Scientists, page 317.


WEEK 3. September 8 & 10, 2003: Mon & Wed} Some 19th Century research in Europe and America (Cross-Cultural Research, Including HRAF): Pre-Boas, Darwin, Spencer, Morgan, Tyler, Frazer, Powell, Pitt-Rivers, Prichard, et al. and Darwin (1809-1882) in context.

Required Reading in: glance at Chapter 2 in Langness (pp. 50-73), glance at Slotkin, pp. 244-460, and glance at D. Hakken (1999). PLEASE read about Darwin's "116th Anniversary" by clicking here: ESSAY #8 at the end of this printed Guidebook. Incidentally, considering that your Writing Assignment is due in two weeks, you might wish to glance at Urbanowicz ESSAY #9 & ESSAY #10 at the end of this printed Guidebook. AND, just for the fun of it, want to try?: http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/DarwinTestOne.htm (Darwin 2000-2001 [Self]Test One) or http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/DarwinTestTwo.htm (Darwin 2001 Self-Test Two).

PLEASE NOTE} Do come to class EVERY-SINGLE-DAY with a "quotation" or a phrase that struck YOU in some way: either from this Guidebook or Langness or Davies & Piero.

PLEASE read any one of the following items from the selections on RESERVE:

Bidney: Ch 7 (pp. 183-214).
Boorstin: pp. 636-652.
Hays pp. vii-xv and Ch 1-5 (pp. 1-49).
Harris (1968): Ch 5 (pp. 108-141).
Herbert: pp. 1-28.
Hinsley: pp. 7-63 or pp. 129-189.
Kardiner & Preble: pp. 33-94.
Malefijt Ch 7 (116-137) or Ch. 8 (138-159) or Ch. 11 (215-255).
Mead & Bunzel: pp. 58-81; or pp. 129-138; or pp. 203-245; or pp. 305-318
Moore: pp. 15-68.
Naroll & Naroll: Ch 3 (pp. 57-121).
Penniman: part of Ch. 4 (pp.110-146).
Ryan: "Introduction" (pp. vii-xiii) plus any chapter from A Guide To Careers in Physical Anthropology
Silverman: Ch. 1 (pp. 1-33).
Stocking (1991): pp. 144-185.
Stocking: pp. 1-14 and Ch. 3 (pp. 84-123).
Stocking: Ch. 5 (pp. 179-232).

PLEASE Continue reading Merryl Wyn Davies and Piero, 2002, Introducing Anthropology, pp. 1-19 and begin reading pp. 20-33.

CONSIDER THE IMPLICATIONS OF THE FOLLOWING WORDS:

"Before there was science, there was the Bible. For thousands of years, it supplied reassuring answers to those profound questions that humans have always asked, Who are we? Where are we in relation to everything else in the universe? And how and when did we get here, this place we call Earth? ... it was largely the work of just four men who shattered the biblically rooted picture of Earth and separated science from theology. The first was Nicolaus Copernicus [1473-1543]. ... Because of a cryptic introduction and the technical nature of the work [De Revolutionibus Orbium Coelestium published in 1543], Copernicus's book did not have a profound impact immediately. It took Galileo [1564-1642], the first celebrity scientist, to publicize the true meaning of what Copernicus had written [published in 1632: Dialogue Concerning the Two Chief World Systems]. As troubling to the devout of Galileo's endorsement of Copernicus's sun-centered universe was, it was not as bad as what would come next. ... all English-speaking Christians knew that God had created the earth on October 23, 4004 B.C. James Hutton [1726-1797], a Scottich natural philosopher, boldly confronted this centuries-old wisdom. Writing in 1788, he formally presented proof that the earth was significantly older than 6,000 years. In fact, its age was incalculable.... Charles Darwin [1809-1882], writing seventy years after Hutton [1726-1797], took the concept of the divine away from man altogether [stress added]." Jack Repcheck, 2003, The Man Who Found Time: James Hutton And the Discovery of the Earth's Antiquity (Cambridge, MA: Perseus Books), pages 2-5.

"Three key features mark James Hutton's [1726-1797] later scientific work: his application of Newtonian natural laws to the study of the earth, his innovative use of chemistry, and his recognition of the dynamics of erosion [stress added]." Jack Repcheck, 2003, The Man Who Found Time: James Hutton And the Discovery of the Earth's Antiquity (Cambridge, MA: Perseus Books), page 65.

"The great value of Darwinism, it seems to me, was that it jolted modern men into questioning various sentimental beliefs about nature and man's place in it. In this, Darwin's influence closely parallels that of Galileo [1564-1642]. Just as the first modern astronomers and physicists destroyed a naive geocentrism, so Darwin and his successorsoverwhelmingly displaced what may be called homocentrism, the belief that nature exists for the sake of man [stress added]." Jacob Needleman, 1975, A Sense of the Cosmos: The Encounter of Modern Science and Ancient Truth (NY: Doubleday & Co., Inc.), page 72.

"The destruction of the literal interpretation of the Bible was accomplished by twin European intellectual movements, in science and history. The scientific movement was started by Sir Charles Lyell [1797-1895] and other geologists who were puzzled to explain the existence of the strata of the earth if it had been created in seven days: the tragic suicide in 1856 of the great amateur geologist and Free Church journalist Hugh Miller [1802-1856] has been supposed to be connected with his inability to reconcile his scientific knowledge with his belief in Genesis. Although it was Charles Darwin's [1809-1882] theory of biological evolution which most famously eroded a fundamentalist reading of the Bible and caught the popular imagination in the following decades, the subjection of the Bible to higher criticism on historical grounds which began in Germany in the middle of the century was no less damaging to the old simplicities. The first scholars influenced by the German school began to hold positions of power in Scottish theological colleges from the 1860s. .. William Robertson Smith [1846-1894], was expelled from his chair in the Free Church College at Aberdeen [Scotland] for suggesting that the Pentateuch might have been written by different hands: he withdrew to Cambridge Universty and pursued his interests in Oriental languages and relative cultures, to become, in due course, one of the founding fathers of modern anthropology [stress added]." T.C. Smout, 1986, A Century of the Scottish People: 1830-1950 (New Haven: Yale University Press), pages 193-194.

"In the winter of 1807, thirteen like-minded souls in london got together at the Freemasons Tavern at Long Acre, in Covent garden, to form a dining club to be called the Geological Society. The idea was to meet once a month to swap geological notions over a glass or two of Madiera and a convivial dinner. The price of the meal was set at a deliberately hefty fifteen shillings to discourage those who qualification were merely cerebral. ... In barely a decade membership grew to four hundred--still all gentlement, of course--and the Geological was threatening to eclipse the Royal as the premier scientific society in the country. ... By 1830, there were 745 of them, and the world would never see the like again. It is hard to imagine now, but geology excited the nineteenth century--positively gripped it in a way that no science ever had before or would again. ...when, in 1841, the great Charles Lyell [1797-1895] traveled to America to give a series of lectures in Boston, sellout audiences of three thosand at a time packed into the Lowell Institute to hear him tranquilizing descriptions of marine zeolites and seismic perturbations in Campania [stress added]."Bill Bryson, 2003, A Short History of Nearly Everything (NY: Broadway Books), page 67

"Natural history and geology in particular were also part of the intellectual interests of the Scottish Enlightenment that were facilitatied by earlier improvements, and made evident in the universities by the provision of chairs and courses. Scotland's awareness of natural history and geology was another example of her contact with Continental thought and interests. Geology had been in vogue not least for the utilitarian needs of the mining industry but also because of an intellectual interest in science that had been evident from the seventeenth century. Four approaches were evident before the Scottish Enlightenment and which contributes to an apprciation of eighteenth century Scottish work in natural history and geology. First, the systematic analysis of strate and minerals in localaties all over Europe was undertaken. Secondly, precedents were set for discarding the biblical authority for the Flood as a force determining the earth's surface, notably by Italian geologists. Thirdly, travelling to further the cause of geology and mineralogical cartography became more popular and common. Finally, there was the writing of George-Louis Leclerc de Buffon [1707-1788] whose multi-volume Natural History began to appear by the middle eighteenth century and was both a stimulus and an indication of contemporary interest. ... Buffon's Epochs of Nature (1778) proposed successive and ceaseless revolutions in the history of the earth, a theory later to be taken up by the Scotish literatus, James Hutton [1726-1797] [stress added]. Anand C. Chitnis, 1976, The Scottish Enlightenment: A Social History (London: Croom Helm), pages 167-168.

"How sad that so many people seem to think that science and religion are mutually exclusive [stress added]." Jane Goodall [with Phillip Berman], 1999, Reason For Hope: A Spiritual Journey (NY: Warner Books), page 174.

"Must one choose between evolution and belief in God? The answer to this question depends, of course, on the details of evolution and on one's conception of God. An ironic feature of the creation/evolution controversy is that creationists and strong atheists agree in answering this question in the affirmative, while most theologians answer it in the negative. Pope John Paul II recently reiterated the established position of the Catholic Church that there is no conflict between evolution and Christian faith [stress added]." Robert T. Pennock [Editor] 2001, Intelligent Design Creationism and Its Critics: Philosophical, Theological, and Scientific Perspectives (MIT Press), page 431.

"The word "anthropology" first appeared in the English language in 1593 (the first of the "ologies," incidentally, to do so). The word "ethnology" made its first appearance in an 1830 letter by AndréMarie Ampère (1775-1836) and appeared in print for the first time in 1832. The short-lived Sociétés observateurs de l'homme was founded in Paris in 1799 by Louis Francois Jauffret (1770-1850) and this was eventually followed by the 1839 formation of Sociétéethnologique de Paris, by William F. Edwards (1777-1842). This latter organization lasted until 1848 but no one seems to have a good impression of the term "ethnology" as used by Edwards...." Charles F. Urbanowicz, 1992, Four-Field Commentary. Newsletter of the American Anthropological Association, 1992, Volume 33, Number 9, page 3. [And see: http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Pub_Papers/4field.html]

"The field of Anthropology, however, was formally inauguarated by the French physician Paul Broca (1824-1880), with the establishment of the Societé d'Anthropologie de Paris in 1859--ironically the same year that Charles Darwin produced the full development of his idea that the myriad forms of the biological world had all arisen and been shaped by the continuing action of the everydaY forces still in operation: evolution by means of natural selection (Darwin, 1859 [Origin]). Broca's Societé served as the model for the creation of comparable organizations subsequently in both England (1863)...and Germany (1869 and 1870).... [stress added]." C. Loring Brace, 2000, Evolution in an Anthropological View (Walnut Creek: Altamira Press), page 15.

"Paul Broca [1824-1880] was a surgeon, a neurologist and an anthropologist, a major figure in the development of both medicine and anthropology in the mid-nineteenth century. ... He loved, as one biographer said, mainly serenity and tolerance. In 1848 he founded a society of 'free-thinkers.' Almost alone among French savants of the time, he was sympathetic to Charles Darwin's idea of evolution by natural selection [stress added]." Carl Sagan, 1979, Broca's Brain: Reflections on the Romance of Science, page 7.

"Formal anthropology in the first half of the nineteenth century was defined by the research project of Prichardian 'ethnology' (the tracing of prehistoric origins of peoples), and in its next major phase would be preoccupied with theories of the evolutionary development of civilization. Not until the twentieth century would it discover its vocation of closely scrutinizing particular societies from the point of view of the idea of culture in the 'wide ethnographic sense'; nor would it institute until then the professional fieldwork procedures supposed to warrant the scientific authority of the reconstitute discipline [stress added]." Christopher Herbert, 1991, Culture And Anomie: Ethnographic Imagination In The Nineteenth Century, page 150.

"No one has championed the aesthetic, formal aspect of science better than the founder of modern biology, Georges-Louis Leclerc, Comte de Buffon (1707-1788). Buffon's histoire naturelle was to biology what Diderot's [1713-1784] Encyclopédie was to the general knowledge of the time. Indeed, Buffon wrote several articles for the Encyclopédie and, as patron and protector, was a charactger witness when Diderot was threatened with imprisonment for impiety. ... the subject of his inaugural speech at the Royal Academy was not science, but style: Bien écrire, c'est tout à la fois bien pensé, bien sentir et bien rendre. C'est avoir en même temps de'esprit, de lâme et du gout. [To write well is at once to think, feel and express oneself well; simultaneously to possess wit, soul and taste.] With disdain for fanciful systems based on 'natural law,' he noted that:Ilest plus aisé d'imager un système que de donner une thêorie. [It is easier to dream up a system than to work out a theory.]

Buffon had three younger associated at the Jardin de Plantes: Geoffrey Sainte-Hilaire, Georges Cuvier [1769-1832], and the chevalier Lamarck [1744-1829]. These were the men who hammered out the French version of evolutionary theory; their politics were as pointedly secular and Whiggish as those of the Darwins on the other side of the channel.. When Lamarck assured his readers in 1809 that Dans tout a que la nature opére, elle ne fait rien brusquement [Everywhere nature is at work, she does nothing abruptly] his compass was not limited to zoology. After Marat and the terror, cataclysms had little appeal. In like vein, my own interest in the two cultures favors the gradual over the sudden, sure change over blanket upheaval. That position, in accord with Enlightenment teaching, can best be described as Whig, a term that has the convenience, as Lord Russell put it, of expressing in one syllable what Conservative Liberal expresses in seven [stress added]." Gerald Weissmann, 1998, Darwin's Audubon: Science and the Liberal Imagination (NY: Plenum Trade), pages 3-4.

"Charles Darwin (1809-1882) is credited as the 'father of evolutionary thought.' However, he developed his theory of evolution based on the ideas of earlier scholars. In fact, Darwin's model was not the first evolutionary theory. It was, however, the one that has withstood the test of time. ... The contributions of Cuvier [1769-1832], Lyell [1797-1875], and Lamarck [1744-1829] set the stage for the ideas developed by Charles Darwin. Combining information from different fields, such as biology, geology, and economics, Darwin revolutionized our understanding of the living world by his theory of evolution by natural selection [stress added]." Alan S. Ryan, 2002, The meaning of Physical Anthropology. In A Guide to Careers in Physical Anthropology, Alan S. Ryan [Editor] (Westport, Conn: Bergin & Garvey), pages 1-20, page 1.

"The [1937] Hungarian Nobel Prize winner [in Physiology/Medicine], [Albert] Szent-Györgyi [von Nagyrapolt] [1893-1986], once said that a scientist should see what everybody else has seen and then think what nobody has thought. Nobody did this better than Charles Darwin, who first realized that the evolution of life took place by Natural Selection. Darwin taught us all to see more clearly what everyone had seen, and Darwin also taught us to think, along with him, what no one else had thought. No branch of science is more dominated by a single theory, by a single great idea, than is the whole of biology by the idea of evolution by Natural Selection [stress added]." J. Livingston and L. Sinclair, 1967, Darwin and the Galapagos, no page number.

"He [Charles Darwin] was an Englishman who went on a five-year voyage when he was young and then retired to a house in the country, not far from London. He wrote an account of his voyage, and then he wrote a book setting down his theory of evolution, based on a process he called natural selection, a theory that provided the foundation for modern biology. He was often ill and never left England again [stress added]." John P. Wiley, Jr., 1998, Expressions: The Visible Link. Smithsonian, June, pages 22-24, page 22.

WORDS ON CHARLES R. DARWIN: "As a writer, too, he discovered unplumbed depths. His voice was in turn dazzling, persuasive, friendly, humble, and dark. Hardly daring to hope he might initiate a transformation in scientific thought, he nevertheless rose magnificently to the occasion. Being stuck in Down house was the best thing that could have happened to him. Pleasingly localised as his book was in manner, it reached out across national and chronological boundaries. His imagination soared beyond the confines of his house and garden, beyond his debilitating illnesses and the fragile health of his children. At his most determined, he questioned everything his contemporaries believed about living nature, calling forth a picture of origins completely shorn of the garden of Eden. He abandoned the image of a heavenly clockmaker patiently constructing living being to occupy the earth below. He dismissed what John Herschel [1792-1871] devoutly called the 'mystery of mysteries.' Darwin's book implicitly laid claim to Adam and Eve, as time and again he showed how nature was cruel and full of blunders. The natural world has no moral validity or purpose, he argued. Animals and plants are not the product of special design or special creation. 'I am fully convinced that species are not immutable,' he stated in the opening pages. No one could afterwards regard organic beings and their natural setting with anything like the same eyes as before. Nor could anyone fail to notice the way that Darwin's biology mirrored the British way of life in all its competetive, entrepreneurial, facroty spirit, or that his appeal to natural law unmistakebly contributed to the general push towards secularisation and supported the claims of science to understand the world in its own terms. As well as rewriting the story of life, he was telling the tale of the rise of science in Victorian Britain [stress added]." Janet Browne, 2002, Charles Darwin: The Power Of Place (Volume II of a Biography) (NY: Alfred A. Knopf), page 55:

CONSIDER the words of the Pulitzer Prize Winner (1940) and Nobel Prize Winner (1962) John Steinbeck (1902-1968) on Charles R. Darwin: "In a way, ours is the older method, somewhat like that of Darwin on the Beagle. He was called a 'naturalist'. He wanted to see everything, rocks and flora and fauna; marine and terrestrial. We came to envy this Darwin on his sailing ship. He had so much room and so much time. ... This is the proper pace for a naturalist. Faced with all things he [or she] cannot hurry. We must have time to think and to look and to consider [stress added]." John Steinbeck, 1951, The Log From The Sea of Cortez [1967 printing: Pan Books: London], page 123.

"But what then is evolution? Although it may sound unconventional to say so, Charles Darwin's theory of evolution is above all else a theory of history. While initially offered as an encompassing theory about the origin of new species by means of NATURAL SELECTION, Darwin's insights into the causes of biological evolution and persistence soon proved to be so powerful that many have sought to apply Darwinian theory to human affairs--to use Darwin's ways of thinking about history and evolution to explain not only our own oigins as a remarkably clever kind of animal (see BIOLOGICAL CONSTRAINTS), but also our human ways and the history of human institutions and social practices (major elements of what many anthropologists and others call CULTURE) [stress added]." John Terrell and John Hart, 2002, Darwin and Archaeology: A Handbook of Key Concepts (Westport, Connecticut: Bergin & Garvey), page 2.

"...by the nineteenth century, the biological philosophers, like the engineers and tradesmen, were soaked with the nonsense of quantitative science. Then in 1859, with the publication of Darwin's On the Origin of Species, they were given that theory of biological evolution that precisely matched the philosophy of the industrial revolution. It fell into place atop the Cartesian split between mind and matter, neatly fitting into a philosophy of secular reason which had been developing since the Reformation. Inquiry into mental processes was then rigidly excluded--tabooed--in biological circles [stress added]." Gregory Bateson, 1987, Angels Fear: Towards an Epistemology of the Sacred (Gregory Bateson and Mary Catherine Bateson) [1988 Bantam Paperback edition], page 61.

"In the complex history of modern biology, only Darwin's theory of evolution has so shocked the mind as to raise serious questions about man's place in the universe. Darwin forced men to consider that they are animals, and that the designs of creation are played out on a much wider stage than was imagined. From the point of view of the theory of evolution, mankind is only one species among thousands which have their place within the field of organic life on earth. The fact that people took the theory of evolution as an enemy of religion only shows how rigidly they understood the idea of God [stress added]." Jacob Needleman, 1975, A Sense of the Cosmos: The Encounter of Modern Science and Ancient Truth (NY: Doubleday & Co., Inc.), page 64.

"Although Darwin's Origin of Species, published in November 1859, had deliberately avoided speculation about humankind, the question of anthropogenesis was inevitably implicated in the emerging evolutionary debate, and during the next decade a number of influential texts were published on the issue of human origins and antiquity, most notably Thomas Henry Huxley's [1825-1895] Man's Place in Nature (1863), Lyell's [1797-1875] The Antiquity of Man (1863), and John Lubbock's [1834-1913] Pre-historic Times (1865), which covered the matter from the viewpoints of comparative anatomy (and paleontology), geology, and archaeology respectively.... [stress added]." Frank Spencer, 1988, Prologue to a Scientific Forgery. In} Bones, Bodies, Behavior [Edited by George W. Stocking, Jr.] (University of Wisconsin Press), pages 84-116, page 88.

"Though Darwin 1809-1882] died more than a century before the advent of the World Wide Web, his unforgiving survival theory applied as much to outdoors-oriented sites as to the species. The fittest are still with us...." Michael Shapiro, 2002, Returning to nature easier after trekking through Net. San Francisco Chronicle, June 2, 2002, Section C8, page 8.

"Cyber-life obeys Darwinian theory: Computer simulation lets digital organisms evolve" By Robert Roy Britt = "RESEARCHERS PRODDED and annoyed lifelike digital entities over more than 15,000 generations to learn that evolution among simple creatures is in fact based on the Darwinian notion of survival of the fittest, and that the progress is plodding. 'The little things, they definitely count,' says Richard Lenski, a Michigan State University evolutionary biologist who worked with a team of scientists from diverse backgrounds in creating and fostering artificial life inside a computer [stress added]" From: http://www.msnbc.com/news/910521.asp?0si=-&cp1=1 [and the story continues] May 7, 2003

"Two ideas dominated the life of Herbert Spencer [1820-1903]: that of evolution, for which he invented them term 'survival of the fittest,' and that of personal freedom. ... More important for the anthropologist, Spencer retained the model of the biological organism as the basis for understanding the social realm. ... Spencer also used the term superorganic, which has its own place in anthropological theory as developed in the writings of such authors as Edward Sapir [1884-1939] and Alfred Louis Kroeber [1876-1960] [stress added]." Paul Bohannan & Mark Glazer, Editors (1988) High Points in Anthropology (NY: A.A. Knopf) pages 3-5.

"...as the culmination of this most creative and crucial phase of his work, Spencer [1820-1903] took his evolutionism to its ultimate point in a celebrated essay of 1857--'Progress: its Law and Cause'. In this he advanced the thesis that the idea of evolution was of universal applicability; that it was the key to the understanding of phenomena of all kinds, whether inorganic, organic or 'superorganic', that is to say, social. The most general laws of all the separate science, Spencer argued, could, in principle, be subsumed, and thus unified, under the one supreme law of 'evolution and dissolution' [stress added]." John H. Goldthorpe, 1969, Herbert Spencer, pages 76-84, The Founding Fathers of Social Science (edited by Timothy Raison) [England: Penguin Books], page 78.

"No theme in biology and perhaps in all the sciences so seized the Victorian imagination as did the evolutionary hypothesis. Evolution, the development of one form from an antecedent form or series of forms, acquired obvious relevance for an understanding of the past and present condition of animal and plant species [stress added]."Victorian Science: A Self-Portrait From The Presidential Addresses to the British Association for the Advancement of Science, 1970, edited by George Basalla, William Coleman, and Robert H. Kargon, page 300.

"The Characteristics of any past age are revealed not simply by political and social developments, but by the manner in which contemporaries tried to explain their situation in time and place by the language and concepts in which such explanations were formulated and discussed. In the case of mid- and late Victorian Britain the ambiguous and slippery notion of 'evolution' generated perhaps the most striking cluster of concepts around which the governing ideas of the time were put together and assessed. … The key mid- and late nineteenth century figures in this new comparative endeavour--the lawyer Sir Henry Maine [1822-1888], the anthropologist General Pitt-Rivers [1827-1900], J.F. McLennan [1827-1881] and E.B. Tylor [1832-1917], the philosopher and sage Herbert Spencer [1820-1903]…. Cutting across much of this, but also drawing considerable inspiration from Lyell's geological researches, was the work of Charles Darwin….[stress added]." (K. Theodore Hoppen,1998, The Mid-Victorian Generation 1846-1886, NY: Clarendon Press) pages 472-473.

"The nineteenth century was probably the most revolutionary in all history, not because of its numerous political upheavals, but because of the rise of industrialism. ...There was an accompanying revolution in the physical, natural and political sciences. The new order called for new inquiries into man's relation to his natural and social environment. Two explosive theories, Marxism and Darwinism, revolutionized the thinking of mankind, as the machine had revolutionized his mode of life. (Freudianism was to play its part, too, but that came later.) [stress added]." Elmer Rice (1892-1967), 1963, Minority Report: An Autobiography (NY: Simon & Schuster), pages 142-143.

"The birth of anthropology, its origin, its foundation, is in evolution. Anthropology, it can justly be said, is a child of evolution. It was evolution, in three senses of the term, that inspired the birth of anthropology in the nineteenth century: the technological revolution in Europe; the Enlightenment; and the idea of Progress [stress added]." Philip Carl Salzman, 2001, Understanding Culture: An Introduction to Anthropological Theory (Prospect Heights, Illinois: Waveland Press, Inc.), page 87.

"Whatever the controversies that surround him, Charles Darwin was certainly the most important natural scientist of the past century; he may become the most important social scientist of the next. His great insight--that humans are animals and that their behavior, like that of all animals, is shaped by evolution--is now making its way into social theory. In economics, linguistics, anthropology and psychology, scholars are attempting to see how our evolved nature, interacting with particular environments, generates the ways we trade and speak, live with others and with ourselves [stress added]." Anon., The Wall Street Journal, May 27, 1999, page A24.

"Wherever the European has trod, death seems to pursue the aboriginal. We may look to the wide extent of the Americas, Polynesia, the Cape of Good Hope, and Australia, and we find the same result. Nor is it the white man alone that acts as the destroyer; the Polynesian of Malay extraction has in parts of the East Indian archipelago, thus driven before him the dark-coloured native. The varieties of man seem to act on each other in the same way as different species of animals--the stronger always extirpating the weaker [stress added]." Charles R. Darwin [1809-1882], 1839, The Voyage of the Beagle (Chapter 19: "Australia"), 1972 Bantam paperback edition (with "Introduction" by Walter Sullivan), page 376.

"...Darwin remained mystified by what might cause evolution. He considered and rejected dozens of ideas. Natural selection, the engine of evolution, did not become clear to him for another year and a half. The spark that let Darwin fit the pieces together was struck by Thomas Malthus's grim essay about what we now call population pressure. Malthus [1766-1834] was writing about human populations, but Darwin relaized that every species produces far more offspring than can survive. He was the first to see that nature does not thin the ranks of a species at random. ... Natural selection is the sieve, and population pressure is the force pushing each generation through it [stress added]." Robert E. Adler, 2002, Science Firsts: From The Creation of Science to the Science of Creation (New Jersey: John Wiley & Sons, Inc.), page 89.

ON Alfred Russel Wallace (1823-1913): "Who was this strong-willed philosophical naturalist? Although Wallace's best-known claim to fame is as co-discoverer, along with Charles Darwn, of the theory of evolution by natural selection, Wallace's interests ranged so broadly that it is difficult to apply a single label, even that of a naturalist, to him. Describing him as as a natural scientist would do for the early part of his life, but so would geographer and travel writer; one would have to add social critic, spiritualist, and intellectual for the second half. His status within the scientific community is uqually hard to pin down. Historians have called him an outsider, a loner, or the 'other' man who discovered evolution, but these terms reflect the slant of historians more than they describe Wallace. Part of the reason he is difficult to categorize is that his concerns were so encompassing and wide ranging. Wallace wrote for the lay person as well as the specialist, and he wrote about biology, evolution, education, religion, morality, spiritualism, vaccination, eugenics, social values, and political systems [stress added]." Janes R. Camerini, 2002, The Alfred Russel Wallace Reader: A Selection of Writings from the Field (Baltimore: The Johns Hopkins University Press), page 2.

"Wallace parted company from Darwin by claiming that the human mind could not be explained by evolution and must have been designed by a superior intelligence. He certainly did believe that the mind of man could escape 'the blind control of a deterministic world.' Wallace became a spiritualist and spent the later years of his career searching for a way to communicate with the souls of the dead [stress added]." Steven Pinker, 2002, The Blank Slate: The Modern Denial of Human Behavior (NY: Viking/Penguin), page 28.

"All the theory of natural selection says is the following. If within a species there is variation among individuals in their hereditary traits, and some traits are more conducive to survival and reproduction than others, than those traits will (obviously) become more widespread within the population. The result (obviously) is that the species' aggregate pool of hereditary traits changes. And there you have it [stress added]." Robert Wright, 1994, The Moral Animal (NY: Pantheon Books), page 23.

"In 1865, John Lubbock [1834-1913]-- Darwin's next-door neighbor in Kent, England--published his influential Pre-historic Times, as Illustrated By Ancient Remains, And The Manners And Customs Of Modern Savages. Widely read throughout Europe and America, it became Archaeology's primary textbook [stress added]." David Hurst Thomas, 2000, Skull Wars: Kennewick Man, Archaeology, And The Battle For Native American Identity (NY: Basic Books), page 50.

"Long after I became involved in fossil hunting, but while my father and I were still cleaning antlers, I came across a manuscript of a lecture he had given, in California, I think. One sentence arrested my attention: 'The past is the key to our future.' I felt as if I were reading something I had written; it expressed my own conviction completely [stress added]." Richard Leakey & Roger Lewin, 1992, Origins Reconsidered: In Search Of What Makes Us Human, page xv.

CLARENCE DARROW [1857-1938]: "If today you can take a thing like evolution and make it a crime to teach it in the public school, tomorrow you can make it a crime to teach it in the private schools, and the next year you can make it a crime to teach it to the hustings or in the church. At the next session you may ban books and the newspapers. Soon you may set Catholic against Protestant and Protestant against Protestant, and try to foist your own religion upon the minds of men. If you can do one you can do the other. Ignorance and fanaticism is ever busy and needs feeding. Always it is feeding and gloating for more. Today it is the public school teachers, tomorrow the preachers and the lecturers, the magazines, the books, the newspapers. After while, your honor, it is the setting of man against man and creed against creed until with flying banners and beating drums we are marching backward to the glorious ages of the sixteenth century when bigots lighted fagots to burn the men who dared to bring any intelligence and enlightenment and culture to the human mind [stress added]. The World's Most Famous Court Trial: Tennessee Evolution Case (1925) (1990 Reprint Edition published by Bryan College, Dayton, Tennessee), page 87.

"An agnostic is a doubter. The word is generally applied to those who doubt the verity of accepted religious creeds or faiths. Everyone is an agnostic as to the beliefs or creeds they do not accept. Catholics are agnostic to the Protestant creeds, and the Protestants are agnostic to the Catholic creed. Anyne who thinks is an agnostic about something, otherwise he [or she!] must believe that he is possessed of all knowledge. And the proper place for such a person is in the madhouse or the home for the feeble-minded. In a popular way, in the Western world, an agnostic is one who doubts or disbelieves the main tenets of the Christian faith [stress added]." Clarence Darrow [1857-1938], 1994, Why I Am an Agnostic and Other Essays (NY: Prometheus Books), page 11.

"False facts are highly injurious to the progress of science, for they often endure long; but false views, if supported by some evidence, do little harm, for every one takes a salutary pleasure in proving their falseness: and when this is done, one path towards error is closed and the road to truth is often at the same time opened." Charles R. Darwin [1809-1882], The Descent of Man And Selection in Relation to Sex, 1871 [1981 Princeton University Press edition, with Introduction by John T. Bonner and Robert M. May], Chapter 21, page 385.

"The Galapagos Island finches once studied by Charles Darwin respond quickly to changes in food supply by evolving new beaks and body sizes, according to researchers who studied the birds for almost 30 years. Starting in 1973, husband-and-wife researchers Peter and Rosemary grant of Princeton University have followed the evolutionary changes in two types of birds, the ground finch and the cactus finch, on Daphne Major, one of the Galapagos islands. In a study appearing today in the Journal Science, the Grants report that climate and weather have a dramatic effect on the evolutionary path the finches follow. Ground finches most eat small seeds, and their beaks have adapted to that purpose. When the weather turned dry in 1977, most of the plants that produce small seeds on Daphne Major were killed, leaving little food for finches with modest beaks. Most died off, but some ground finches with bigger, stronger beaks survived [stress added]." Anon., 2002, Finches Shown To Be Able to Change. The Chico Enterprise-Record, April 26, 2002, page 11A.

"Louis Agasiz [1807-1873], leading naturalist of the United States, founder of the Museum of Comparative Zoology at Harvard University, world authority on ichthyology, and ardent opponent of Darwin's [1809-1882] theories regarding evolution, visited the Galápagos for nine days in June of 1872, almost a half century after Darwin. For those who naively believe that a visit to the Galápagos Archipelago will automatically convert them to a belief in evolution, Douglas [David Douglas, 1799-1835} noted botanist who was in the Galápagos in 1825] and Agassiz proved otherwise. In fairness, however, Agassiz visited the Galápagos only one year before his death at the age of sixty-six. Unlike Darwin, who was young and vigorous, and whose mind was still highly maleable when he explored the islands, Agassiz was frail, and his beliefs were more than a little firmly entrenched. He had very little to say in print concerning his impressions of the islands, though he did suggest in one weakly argued letter to a friend that his views concerning the truth of creationism were not shaken by seeing the Galápagos flora and fauna [stress added]." John Kricher, 2002, Galápagos (Smithsonian Institution Press), pages 12-13.

"Myths are part of our culture, and Darwin certainly has become part of a commonly promulgated myth. Some college textbooks, naive nature films, and popular writings about biology tend to present a picture of Darin on the Galápagos not unlike the stroy of Isaac Newton [1642-1727] and the famous apple tree. ... in Darwin's case, the myth would have us believe, [Darwin] spent a few days on a remote volcanic archipelago abouninding in odd birds and reptiles, experienced a sudden and dramatic intellectual metamorphosis, and realized that these creatures must have evolved and not been separately created. ... Darwin did not become an evolutionist while on the Galápagos, nor even during the Beagle voyage. It was not until he was safely back in England and began the serious work of compiling and interpreting his numerous specimens that he became an evolutionist. ... It was not until he had returned to his native England and consulted with a prominent ornithologist named John Gould [1804-1881] that he fully embraced the truth of evolution [stress added]." John Kricher, 2002, Galápagos (Smithsonian Institution Press), pages 41-42.

"Important as the struggle for existence has been and even still is, yet as far as the highest part of man's nature is concerned there are other agencies more important. For the moral qualities are advanced, either directly or indirectly, much more through the effects of habit, the reasoning powers, instruction, religion, &c., than through natural selection; though to this latter agency may be safely attributed the social instincts, which afforded the basis for the development of the moral sense, may be safely attributed. The main conclusion arrived at in this work, namely that man is descended from some lowly-organised form, will, I regret to think, be highly distasteful to many. But.... [stress added]."Charles R. Darwin (1809-1882), The Descent of Man And Selection in Relation to Sex, 1871 [1981 Princeton University Press edition, with Introduction by John T. Bonner and Robert M. May], Part II, Chapter XXI, pages 403-404.

"Biology also became historical after the publication in 1859 of Charles Darwin's [1809-1882] theory of evolution by natural selection. He argued that all species were descended from earlier ones, and that all creatures were locked in a struggle for existence which selected for the traits most advantageous for surival at a given time and place. Darwin's ideas were the most revolutionary and powerful scientific propositions of modern times, and posed a direct challenge to religious accounts of the origins of life and humankind. For this reason his views attracted vigorous opposition, especially from those who took the Bible as the literal word of God. ... gradually Darwin's views became--with modifications--universally accepted among the world's scientifically educated [stress added]." J.R. McNeill & William H. McNeill, 2003, The Human Web: A Bird's-Eye View of World History (NY: W.W. Norton & Co.), page 176.

"Tylor [1832-1917] was the first serious student of culture to embrace the entire field of man [and women!] and his environment. For him, the scope of anthropology should include man's body, his physical and cultural environment, and his soul [stress added]." A. Kardiner & E. Preble (1961), They Studied Man (NY: Mentor Books), pages 54-55.

"Several aspects of Tylor's work should be noted: his definition of culture, his ideas of cognitive evolution, and his attempts to use statistical analysis in comparative studies [stress added]." Paul Bohannan & Mark Glazer, Editors (1988) High Points in Anthropology (NY: A.A. Knopf), page 63.

"In 1861 Tylor [1832-1917] published Anahuac, an account of the Mexican expedition with Christy. His Researches in the Early History of Mankind was published in 1865, and it immediately established him as a major figure in anthropology. His professional maturity came at a time when several lines of inquiry and speculation were converging toward a point which would radically alter man's conception of himself and his place in nature. In geology, Charles Lyell [1797-1875] ... In archaeology the confirmation in 1858 of Boucher de Perthes' [1788-1866] discoveries of fashioned implements of great antiquity.... In biology Darwin's work established the evolutionary view of nature as a key to the general problem of origin and development [stress added]." A. Kardiner & E. Preble (1961), They Studied Man (NY: Mentor Books), pages 52-53.

On August 15, 1865, Charles Darwin wrote to the American Botanist Asa Gray (1810-1888) the following: "My women [Emma, Henrietta, and Elizabeth] read much aloud to me, & I have lately heard three Books, worth your attention--Lubbock [1834-1913] Prehistoric Man [1865], Tylor [1832-1917] early History of Civilization [1865, Researches in the Early History of Mankind], which is admirable....[stress added]." Frederick Burkhardt et al. [Editors], The Correspondence of Charles Darwin Volume 13 1865 Supplement to the Correspondence 1822-1864 (Cambridge University Press), page 223.

CROSS-CULTURAL RESEARCH IS IMPORTANT, AND PLEASE THINK ABOUT THE FOLLOWING CONCERNING HRAF (Human Relations Area Files):

"The OCM [Outline of Cultural Materials] was originally developed as a tool for the Cross-Cultural Survey, an organization established in 1937 by the Institute for Human Relations at Yale University....under the direction of George P. Murdock [1897-1985]. After the entry of the United States into World War II, the Cross-Cultural Survey concentrated its efforts largely on areas of probably combat operations, especially in the Pacific. ... The usefulness of the material in the Cross-Cultural Survey Files on the then Japanese-held islands of the Pacific led the United States Navy Department, in 1943, to contract with Yale University for the continuation of the work on an expanded scale [stress added]." George P. Murdock et al., 2000, Outline of Cultural Materials (5th Edition) (New Haven: Yale University), page xvi-xvii.

"Meanwhile, a quite different but equally multilinear and ecological approach was being developed by George Peter Murdock [1897-1985], first at Yale and later at Pittsburgh. Murdock founded the Cross-Cultural Survey, later the Human Relations Area Files [HRAF], through which he tried to assemble cultural facts from all the cultures of the world. His purpose was to enable scholars to correlate the distribution of culture traits and work out historical trajectories both in general and for particular culture areas or similar culture types. His best know work was the somewhat mis-titles monograph Social Structure (1949), which employed a sample of 250 representative societies for such a purpose [stress added]." Alan Barnard, 2000, History and Theory in Anthropology (Cambridge University Press), page 41.

ALSO CONSIDER THE FOLLOWING: "Faithful to its title, the 1968 Man the Hunter volume (Lee and DeVore 1968) rather dogmatically portrayed hunting as the exclusive role of males. In this vision of cultural evolution, men were characterized as 'cooperative hunters of big game, ranging freely and widely across the landscape' (Washburn and Lancaster 1968 [in Man The Hunter, pages 293-303]). The exclusively male hunter model was constructed, in part, by a questionable manipulation of the original codings for subsistence variables in Murdock's 'Ethnographic Atlas' (1967) [George P. Murdock: 1897-1985] and by ignoring contradictory evidence presented in the original synposium proceedings by several ethnographers. In essence, by narrowing and redefining the scope of 'hunting,' the symposium participants obscured women's very real participation in a behaviorally and culturally complex enterprise. Dahlberg's edited volume Women the Gatherer (1981) served as something of a rejoinder, but it did this by highlighting the role of women as gatherers of plant foods, which often contributed more than half of some foraging people's subsistence. ... Unfortunately, such extreme views, rendered as mutually exclusive 'man the hunter' versus 'women the gatherer' models, have come to sum up the way many archaeologists interpret the economic roles of men and women [stress added]." Hetty Jo Brumbach and Robert Jarvenpa, 1997, Women the Hunter: Ethnoarchaeological Lessons from Chipewyan Life-Cycle Dynamics, IN Women in Prehistory: North America and Mesoamerica, edited by Cheryl Claassen and Rosemary A. Joyce (University of Pennsylvania Press), pages 17-32, page 17.

WORDS FROM David McCollugh: "I guess I want very much for others to experience the enlargement of one's own life that comes with knowing about the lives and experiences and accomplishments and failings and voices of others who went before us. To understand that one need not be provincial in time any more than one would be provincial in space [stress added]." Diane Osen, 2002, The Book That Changed My Life: Interviews With National Book Award Winners And Finalists (NY: Modern Library), page 106.

"Time, which destroys us, reduces what is not genius to rubbish [stress added]." Harold Bloom, 2002, Genius: A Mosaic of One Hundred Exemplary Creative Minds (NY: Warner Books), page 814.

Interesting (And Somewhat Appropriate) Web Sites Are:

http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/klmno/lyell_charles.html [Sir Charles Lyell} 1795-1875]
http://www.gkbenterprises.fsnet.co.uk/wrs.htm [William Robertson Smith} 1846-1893]
http://kroeber.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/bio/tylor.htm [Edward Burnett Tylor]
http://www.indiana.edu/~wanthro/theory.htm [Anthropology Theory from Indiana University]
http://archaeology.about.com/cs/biographies/ [Biographies of Archaeologists]
http://www.utexas.edu/courses/wilson/ant304/biography/arybios98/stephensbio.html [Augustus Lane Fox Pitt-River]
http://www.shef.ac.uk/~psysc/darwin/dar.html [On Darwin]
http://www.ucmp.berkeley.edu/history/agassiz.html [Louis Agasiz} 1807-1873]
http://perso.club-internet.fr/vincent.athias/botanist_douglas.htm [David Douglas} 1799-1835]
http://www.over-land.com/david_douglas.html [David Douglas]
http://www.uib.no/zoo/classics/new_species.txt [Alfred Russell Wallace 1855 paper]
http://www.uib.no/zoo/classics/varieties.html [Alfred Russell Wallace 1858 paper]
http://www.ucmp.berkeley.edu/history/thuxley.html [Thomas Henry Huxley: 1824-1895]
http://www.human-nature.com/darwin/huxley/contents.html [Thomas Henry Huxley: 1824-1895]
http://www.literature.org/authors/darwin-charles/the-origin-of-the-species/ [C. Darwin} Origin of Species]
http://www.dimensional.com/~randl/scopes.htm [The Scopes "Monkey Trial," or "A 1925 Media Circus"]
http://courses.smsu.edu/waw105f/Murdock.htm [George Peter Murdock} 1897-1985]
http://www.encyclopedia.com/html/M/Murdock.asp [George Peter Murdock} 1897-1985]


WEEK 4.September 15 & 17, 2003: Mon & Wed} Darwin, Spencer, Morgan, Tylor, Frazer et al. continued, into the 20th Century. Preliminary discussion of your term paper topic interests. [TO BE ASSIGNED: 1/2 the class on 9/22/2003 and 1/2 on 9/24/2003. WRITING ASSIGNMENT #1 [5%] DUE on your day in class.

PLEASE NOTE} Do come to class EVERY-SINGLE-DAY with a "quotation" or a phrase that struck YOU in some way: either from this Guidebook or Langness or Davies & Piero.

NOTE: Writing Assignment #1 is a CRITIQUE of any chapter that you have read from the readings to date that are on reserve. Some points to consider in your critique are the following: (#1) what was the main idea of the chapter? (#2) what facts were used to support the main idea? (#3) any faulty reasoning, faulty logic, or obvious "bias" in the chapter ? (#4) what additional information could be added to the author's argument? and, finally, (#5) is there a "counter-argument" to the main idea of the chapter? These are a lot of points to consider so please take your time!

"To know how to write well is to know how to think well." Blaise Pascal (1623-1662)

Required Reading in: Langness: Chapter 2 (pp. 50-73) and please read Urbanowicz on "Mother Nature, Father Culture" which may be viewed by clicking here: ESSAY #11 at the end of this printed Guidebook. Again, considering that your Writing Assignment is due next week, you might wish to read Urbanowicz ESSAY #9 & ESSAY #10 at the end of this printed Guidebook (which may be viewed by clicking here).

HAVE a look at a "different" article from the following items on RESERVE [note that this is the same listing of articles assigned for Week 3]:

Bidney: Ch 7 (pp. 183-214).
Boorstin: pp. 636-652.
Hays pp. vii-xv and Ch 1-5 (pp. 1-49).
Harris (1968): Ch 5 (pp. 108-141).
Herbert: pp. 1-28.
Hinsley: pp. 7-63 or pp. 129-189.
Kardiner & Preble: pp. 33-94.
Luke: "Introduction" (pp. xiii-xxvi) plus any chapter from Museum Politics: Power Plays At The Exhibition
Malefijt Ch 7 (116-137) or Ch. 8 (138-159) or Ch. 11 (215-255).
Mead & Bunzel: pp. 58-81; or pp. 129-138; or pp. 203-245; or pp. 305-318.
Moore: pp. 15-68.
Naroll & Naroll: Ch 3 (pp. 57-121).
Penniman: part of Ch. 4 (pp.110-146).
Pennock: "Preface" (pp. ix-xiv) plus pages 431-469.
Silverman: Ch. 1 (pp. 1-33).
Stocking (1991): pp. 144-185.
Stocking: pp. 1-14 and Ch. 3 (pp. 84-123).
Stocking: Ch. 5 (pp. 179-232).

PLEASE Continue reading Merryl Wyn Davies and Piero, 2002, Introducing Anthropology, pp. 1-19, pp. 20-33, and begin reading pp. 34-59.

CONSIDER THE IMPLICATIONS OF THE FOLLOWING WORDS:

"The first fossils recognized as Neandertals were found in August 1856. Two quarrymen were shoveling debris from a limestone cave near Dusseldorf, Germany.... The quarrymen were digging in a cave in the Neander Valley. (In the nineteenth century, the German word for valley was thal, but the spelling was changed to tal at the beginning of the twentieth century, since German does not have a th sound.) The valley was named after a seventeenth-century composer and poet named Joachim Neumann (Newman in English), who signed his compositions with the Greek version of his name, Neander. Thus the irony of Neandertal man's literal translation: 'man of the valley of the new man.' The timing of the discovery could not have been better. Three years later Charles Darwin [1809-1882], in his book On the Origin of Species by Means of Natural Selection, broached the unthinkable [stress added]." Steve Olson, 2002, Mapping Human History: Discovering the Past Through Our Genes (Boston: Houghton Mifflin Company), pages 76-77.

"A version of Darwinism more closely allied to the ideas of Herbert Spencer [1820-1903] than those of Charles Darwin [1809-1882] reached China by the end of the nineteenth century. By the 1880s, Christian missionaries were providing translations of the works of Charles Lyell [1797-1875], Charles Darwin, and other scientists, but so-called Darwinian concepts were more forcefully introduced to China by British diplomats and businessmen. As champions of colonialism, such individuals generally assumed that the British had discovered and demonstrated the truth of the natural and moral laws that governed individuals, nations, and races, and invariably led to the triumph of the strong over the week. After 1895, the year of China's defeat in the Sino-Japanese War, Spencer's slogan 'the survival of the fittest' entered Chinese and Japanese writings as 'the superior win, the inferior lose.' Concerned with evolutionary theory in terms of the survival of China, rather than the origin of species, Chinese intellectuals saw the issue as a complex problem involving the evolution of institutions, ideas, and attitudes. Indeed, they concluded that the secret source of Western power and the rise of Japan was their mutual belief in modern science and the theory of evolutionary progress. Many adaptations of Darwinism evolved in China, including varieties that might be called Taoist Darwinism, Confucian Darwinism, Legalist Darwinism, and Buddhist Darwinism. Eventually, China absorbed, transformed, and was transformed by the intermixture of ideas, including those of Charles Darwin, Thomas Henry Huxley [1825-1895], Karl Marx [1818-1883], and Mao Zedong [1893-1976] [stress added]." Lois N. Magner, 2002, A History of the Life Sciences: Third Edition, Revised And Expanded (NY: Marcel Dekker, Inc.), page 348.

"The term 'eugenics,' which derives from the Greek stem meaning 'good in birth,' was coined by Francis Galton [1822-1911], a cousin of Charles Darwin's [1809-1882]. After reading the Origin of Species [1859] Galton concluded that it might be possible to improve mankind by selective breeding. ... Although Galton's name is linked inextricably to eugenics, he was a man of diverse interests and many achievements. To those who study the history of Africa, he is a nineteenth-century explorer and geographer. He was also a well-known travel writer. To meteorologists he is remembered as the discoverer of the anticyclone. Those who plumb the history of statistics will find Galton's name asociated with regression, correlation, and the founding of biometrics. Psychologists, especially those interested in mental imagery, claim him as one of their own, Forensic experts recognize Galton as playing a central role in putting fingerprints as evodence on a firm scientific footing. And last, but certainly not least, Galton's name will always be linked with the founding of human genetics, the analysis of pedigrees, and twin studies. ... The diversity of Galton's interests was not atypical for a Victorian scientists. His grandfather, Erasmus Darwin [1731-1802], was a highly successful physician, a serious student of botany and zoology, an inventor, and a talented poet [stress added]." Nicholas Wright Gillham, 2001, A Life of Sir Francis Galton: From African Exploration to the Birth of Eugenics (Oxford University Press), pages 1-3.

"More than two thousand Albertans [of Canada] were sterilized between 1928 and 1972 under the Albertan Sterllization Act.. All were victims of the success of the North American eugenics movementsearly in the twentieth century [stress added]." John Beckwith, 2002, Making Genes, Making Waves (Harvard University Press), page 99.

"Museums often are ignored .... The material on display in museums no longer is simply a cache of curiosities for the intellectual edification of autonomous rational subjects [stress added]." Timothy W. Luke (2002), Museum Politics: Power Plays At The Exhibition (Minneapolis: University of Minnesota Press0, pages ix + 228.

"The word museum was originally a Greek term meaning 'Place of the Muses.' At the beginning of the Iliad and the Odyssey, Homer invokes the Muse of epic poetry to lend some of her inspiration to his literary portrayals. Obviously, I'm not comparing myself to Homer, but I will take any help I can get in order to tell my story. So in additon to Calliope (the chief muse), I'd like to invoke Clio (Muse of history) and Thalia (Muse of comedy) to help tell this story. Invoking Muses is very fitting, because natural history museums are not just places of information, but also places of inspiration. ... In the late nineteenth and early twentieth centuries American and European museums primarily concerned themselves with educating the public about the theory of evolution, explaining the principles and displaying the evidence [stress added]." Stephen T. Asma, 2001, Stuffed Animals and Pickled Heads: The Culture and Evolution of Natural History Museums (Oxford), page xii and page 154.

"Museums deliberately forge memories in physical form to prevent the natural erosion of memory, both personal and collective: this is the task of preservation, of creating new form for knowledge whose purely mental existence is well known to be ephemeral....[stress added]." Susan A. Crane, 2000, Introduction: Of Museums And Memory. Museums and Memory, edited by Susan A. Crane (Stanford University Press), pages 1-13, page 9.

"Before [Sir Richard] Owen [1804-1892], museums were dsigned primarily for the use and edification of the elite, and even then it was difficult to gain access. In the early days of the British Museum, prospective visitors had to make a written application and undergo a brief interview to determine if they were fit to be admitted at all. They then had to return s second time to pick up a ticket--that is assuming they had passed the interview--and finally come back a third time to view the museum's treasures. Even then they were whisked through in groups and not allowed to linger. Owen's plan was to welcome everyone, even to the point of encouragingworkingmen to vist in the evening, and to devote most of the museum's space to public displays. He even proposed, very radically, to put informative labels on each display so that people could appreciate what they were viewing. In this, somewhat unexpectedly, he was opposed by T.H. Huxley [1825-1895], who believed that museums should be primarily research institutes. By making the natural history Museum an institution for everyone, Owen transformed our expectations of what museums are for [stress added]." Bill Bryson, 2003, A Short History of Nearly Everything (NY: Broadway Books), pag 91

"It is not enough to say that the Louvre [Paris, France] is the richest of museums, a vast treasury of all arts and all civilizations, magnificently housed. It has a deeper meaning. The Louvre is a living idea. In the succession of monarchs who built, tore down and rebuilt, in the tremendous expenditures of money, in the acquisition of gifts of private citizens, we see the forces which shaped its growth. ... The Louvre was not the first public museum, for it was preceeded by the Asmolean at Oxford, the Vatican Museum, the British Museum, and, in America, by the Charleston Museum, which was organized in 1773, twenty years before the opening of the Louvre as a public institution. ... The earliest known structure on the present site was a fortress, begun about 1190 by Philip Augustus, one of the great parisian kings. It is likely, however, that during Clovis' siege of paris at the end of the fifth century, a Frankish tower or fortified camp existed here. If that is so, the name 'Louvre' may derive from the Saxon word lower: a fortified chateau; but it may also have come from louveterie (Low Latin lupara): the headquarters of the wolf-hunt, or, as some believe, from the name of a leper colony [stress added]."Milton S. Fox, 1951, The Louvre, pages 9-16, pages 9-10. Rene Huyghe, 1951, Art Treasures of the Louvre (NY: Harry N. Abrams).

"Joseph François Lafitau (1670-1746) spent six years among the Iroquois in a Canadian mission at Sault Saint Louis (outside of Montreal) in the early eighteenth century and who knows how many more years reading 'the old relations' for data about the earlier, contact-period lifeways of the Iroquois and other American peoples. His big illustrated book is considered by many to constitute the first work of ethnology proper (especially in its articulation of a classificatory system to describe Iroquois kinship). Though little read in the century and more intervening between its appearance and Lewis Henry Morgan's League of the Iroquois (1851), it has earned the respect of many anthropologists and is still in use as a reliable source for the folkways it set out, in part, to represent and interpret" [stress added]." Mary Baine Campbell, 1999, Wonder & Science: Imagining Worlds in Early Modern Europe (Cornell University Press), page 289.

"The recognition of Boucher de Perthes' [1783-1868] thesis marked a new era because it implies that culture dates back to the Pleistocene: the flints were not only made by man, they were obviously more than random freaks and worked in conformity with a social tradition." Robert H. Lowie [1883-1957], 1937, The History of Ethnological Theory (page 7).

"Archaeology is a comparative science: to know one site is to know nothing; to know a thousand is to see some factors unifying all [stress added]." Paul MacKendrick, 1983, The Mute Stones Speak: The Story of Archaeology in Italy, second edition (NY: W.W. Norton & Co.), page 4.

"...I will argue that the most important single factor that has shaped the long-term development of American archaeology has been the traditional Euro-American stereotype which portrayed America's native people as being inherently unprogressive. I will attempt to demonstrate [Trigger continues] how the influence of this stereotype has caused American archaeology to develop in a fundamentally different manner from European archaeology, which from its beginning was preoccupied with affirming that continuous cultural progress characterized that continent in prehistoric as well as historic times [stress added]." Bruce G. Trigger, 2003, Artifacts & Ideas: Essays in Archaeology (Transaction Publishers), page 45.

"Thomas Jefferson [1743-1826] is very often cited as the 'father' of American archaeology, and he certainly attempted one of the first archaeological explanations of the question ["Who Got here First?"] when he wrote in his famous 'Notes on Virginia' (1787) about an Indian mound that he had excavated many years before. However, his strongest evidence to support his belief in an Asian origin (via the Bering Strait) of the Native Americans was from his study of Indian languages. He cited the diversity of these languages as proof that they had been here a long time." Stephen William, 1992, "Who Got To America First?" reprinted in Anthropology Explored: The Best Of Smithsonian Anthro Notes, 1998, edited by Ruth O. Selig and Marilyn R. London, pages 141-149, page 144.

"The importance of Jefferson's experience and his report of it [in 'Notes on Virginia' (1787)] cannot be overstressed, for he correctly used stratigraphy to make inferences about the past--a century before the principle became a basic part of the methodology of all archaeology, regardless of where it is undertaken. The principle is the method for providing a calendar for establishing the age of remains. As the criterion of scientific excavation, it is the principle in which every student of the science is to be trained. As C.W. Ceram, the noted author in archaeology commented, Jefferson 'not only indicated the basic features of the stratigraphic method buit also virtually named it, although a hundred years were to pass before the term became established in archaeological jargon....' [stress added]." Silvio A. Bedini, 2002, Jefferson And Science (Monticello: Thomas Jefferson Foundation), pages 53-55.

"Among those who came to Grave Creek [West Virginia] to examine the tablet was Henry Rowe Schoolcraft (1793-1864), one of the great early figures in American anthropology. Trained as a geologist, Schoolcraft had become interested in Indians while exploring the country west of the Alleghenies; he had become an expert on Indian languages and folklore, and had even married a half-Indian girl. When he headed for Grave Creek in 1842, he was considered one of the nation's leading authorities on the native peoples of America [stress added]." Robert Silverberg, 1970, The Mound Builders [1975, NY: Ballantine Books], page 51.

"The eagerness and energy of the [19th century] amateurs gradually won a place for their subject as an independent science. A museum of ethnology was established in Hamburg in 1850; the Peabody Museum of Archaeology and Ethnology at Harvard was founded in 1866; the Royal Anthropological Institute in 1873; the Bureau of American Ethnology in 1879. Tylor was made Reader in Anthropology at Oxford in 1884. The first American professor was appointed in 1886. But in the nineteenth century there were not a hundred anthropologists in the whole world. The total number of anthropological Ph.D.'s granted in the United States prior to 1920 was only 53. Before 1930 only four American universities gave the doctorate in anthropology [stress added]." Clyde Kluckhohn, 1949, Mirror For Man: The Relation of Anthropology To Modern Life, page 6.

"Ethnology in Britain was primarily associated with the name of the Bristol physican James Cowles Prichard [1746-1848], and one may trace its growth in the development of Prichard's thought from the time of his medical degree in Edinburgh in 1808 to the completion of the third edition of his Researches in 1848 [stress added]." George W. Stocking, Jr., 1987, Victorian Anthropology (NY: The Free Press), page 48.

On Sir Richard Burton (1921-1890): "His anthropological writings, especially when concerned with sexual practices, had sometimes been suppressed, even when he had decently cloaked them in Latin. His translations of erotica were in part acts of bravado--both a rejection of conventional morality and a way of exposing the true taste and moral value of the reading public [stress added]." John Hayman, 1990, Sir Richard Burton's Travels in Arabia and Africa: Four Lectures from a Huntington Library Manuscript (San marino, CA: Huntington Library), page 2.

"His [Sir Richard Burton, 1921-1890] remark about a 'new religion' referred to his proposal to form a new organisation, similar in style to the R.G.S. [Royal Geograpical Society] but which would publish papers of a more ethnological and anthropological nature. Thus came about The Anthropological Society, which Richard set up with Dr James Hunt [stress added]."Mary S. Lovell, 1998, A Rage To Live: A Biography of Richard & Isabel Burton (NY: W.W. Norton), page 413.

"The new society [The Anthropological Society] was highly successful from the view of membership. In 1867 it had the impressive total of 706 members, in contrast with the Ethnological Society whose greatest members ship was 107 in 1846... [stress added]." Conrad C. Reining, 1962, A Lost Period of Applied Anthropology. The American Anthropologist, Vol. 64: 593-600, page 593.

"General Augustus Lane Fox Pitt-Rivers (1827-1900) enjoyed a successful military career. A soldier of restless interests and an omnivorous collector, Lane Fox studied the development of weaponry. He soon became passionately interested in the evolution of artifacts, deciding that all material culture could be studied by arranging changing objects in an evolutionary order. Lane Fox was one of the founding father of ethnography. He worked closely with pioneer anthropologist Edward Tylor [1832-1917] and demonstrated the great value of ethnography to archaeology [stress added]." Brian M. Fagan [Editor], 1996, Eyewitness to Discovery: First-Person Accounts of More Than Fifty of the World's Greatest Archaeological Discoveries (Oxford University Press), page 392.

"The technological progress in the design of firearms fascinated Pitt Rivers [1827-1900] and he began to collect guns which he placed in sequence to illustrate their development. Over the following years he amassed an extensive collection of ethnographic material. He must have read Darwin's Origin of Species soon after its publication in 1859 for the theory of evolution clearly inspired him to formulate his own theory of the 'Evolution of Culture' which he was to expound in a lecture of that title in 1875. This theory, and his large collection of ethnographic objects which illustrated it, brought him to the notice of the scientific establishment and soon he was regarded as an equal of such men as Thomas Huxley, the champion of Darwinian evolution, Herbert Spencer, the sociologist and Sir John Lubbock, the naturalist and antiquarian. Charles Darwin himself supported Pitt Rivers for Fellowship of the Royal Society in 1876 [stress added]. Marc Bowden, 1984, General Pitt Rivers: The Father of Scientific Archaeology (Salisbury: Salisbury and South Wiltshire Museum), page 2.

"In the history of anthropology, the name Pitt Rivers [1827-1900] is indissolubly linked to a museum, and to the 'evolutionary' principle of its organization--which like the name, was specified in the terms of the bequest. Augustus Henry Lane Fox adopted the name Pitt Rivers in 1880 to fulfil the requirements of the will that made him master of a 25,000 acre estate. Four years later it was stipulated by Deed of Gift that the museum at Oxford University to which he gave that new name (along with his ethnographic and archaeological collection) would retain his system of arrangement during his lifetime and beyond--except for such changes in detail that might be 'necessitated by the advance of knowledge' and di 'not affect the general principle originated by the donor.... Stimulated, apparently by the Great Exhibition of the Works of Art of All Nations [1851], Pitt Rivers began to collect objects of a broadly ethnographic kind around 1851. At the time he was a young military officer, assigned to testing the new rifles then being introduced to replace the older, smoothbore muskets. Struck by the 'continuity observable' in small arms development, he began a collection of weapons to show their 'slow progression' of development over time.... [stress added]." William Ryan Chapman, 1985, Arranging Ethnology: A.H.L.F. Pitt Rivers and the typological Tradition. IN George W. Stocking, Jr. [Editor], 1985, Objects And others: Essays on Museums and Material Culture (University of Wisconsin Press), pages 15-48, pages 15-16.

SOME 1891 WORDS FROM PITT-RIVERS on People who are} "...are ignorant .... The knowledge they lack is the knowledge of history. This lays them open to the designs of demagogues and agitators who strive to make them break the past, and seek ... drastic changes that have not the sanction of experience.... The law that Nature makes no jumps can be taught...is such a way as at least to make men cautious how they listen to scatter-brained revolutionary suggestions [stress added]." Pitt-Rivers, 1891, Typoligical museums. Journal of the Society of Arts, pages 115-116. [Urbanowicz points out that this quotations, with the "..." as indicated, was taken as it appears in Marc Bowden, 1984, General Pitt Rivers: The Father of Scientific Archaeology (Salisbury: Salisbury and South Wiltshire Museum), page 8.

"Imperialist or world-oriented archaeology is associated with a small number of states that enjoy or have exerted political dominance over large areas of the world. ... The first imperialist archaeology developed in the United Kingdom. Scientific archaeology was introduced there from Scandinavia in the 1850s, at a time when the British middle class was fascinated by technological progress [stress added]." Bruce G. Trigger, 2003, Artifacts & Ideas: Essays in Archaeology (Transaction Publishers), page 78.

"Lewis Henry Morgan [1818-1881] was one of the most influential thinkers of the nineteenth century--not just for the future of anthropology, but for the future of capitalism and world politics. ... Morgan's best-known work is Ancienty Society. Since it was first published in 1877, it has never been out of print. ... Three aspects of Morgan's work still live: (1) his discovery of the classificatory system of kinship; (2) his analytical distinction between family and household...and (3) his contributions to broader anthropological theory" [stress added]." Paul Bohannan & Mark Glazer, Editors (1988) High Points in Anthropology, pages 29-31.

"This was the first systematic attempt to collect ethnographic data on a global scale. Morgan eventually published his results on kinship relations in Systems of Consanguinity and Affinity of the Human Family, published in 1870. A few years later, in Ancient Society: Or Researches In The Lines Of Human Progress From Savagery Through Barbarism To Civilization (1877), he refined his kinship data into a whole new theory of social evolution. In Ancient Society, Morgan traced the history of the human family….[stress added]." David Hurst Thomas, 2000, Skull Wars: Kennewick Man, Archaeology, And The Battle For Native American Identity (NY: Basic Books), page 47

"In North America, anthropology among the social sciences has a unique character, owing in large part to the natural-science (rather than social science) background of...." Franz Boas [1858-1942], Frederic Ward Putnam [1839-1915], and John Wesley Powell [1834-1902]. Franz Boas was "educated in physics, was not the first to teach anthropology in the United States, but it was her and his students, with their insistence on scientific rigor, who made such courses a common part of college and university curricula." Frederic Ward Putnam was "a zoologist specializing in the study of birds and fishes and permanent secretary of the American Association for the Advancement of Science, [and he] made a decision in 1875 to devote himself to the promotion of anthropology. Through his efforts many of the great anthropology museums were established." John Wesley Powell "was a geologist and founder of the United States Geological Survey, but he also carried out ethnographic and linguistic research (his classification of Indian languages north of Mexico is still consulted by scholars today). In 1879, he founded the Bureau of American Ethnology (ultimately absorbed by the Smithsonian Institution), thereby establishing anthropology within the United States Government [stress added]." (William A. Haviland, 1999, Cultural Anthropology, 9th edition, page 25.)

"Putnam [1839-1915] was responsible for the development of museums and anthropology programs not only at Harvard but at the Peabody Museum in Salem [Massachusetts], the American Museum of natural history and Columbia University ion New York, the Field Museum of Natural History in Chicago, and the Lowie Museum and the University of California at Berkeley. ... In early 1890, Putnam wrote to the director of the 1893 World's Columbian Exposition in Chicago, proposing that he should help in developing a major anthropological display the the exhibition. Putnam was appointed chief of Department M, Department of Archaeology and Ethnology, for the exposition and spent a major portion of his time between 1891 and 1893 developing and staffing the anthropological displays. Among the individuals he hired to help him were Boas.... [stress added]." Davvid L. Browman, 2002, The Peabody Museum, Frederick W. Putnam, and the rRise of U.S. Anthropology, 1866-1903. The American Anthropologist, Vol. 104, No. 2, June, pages 508-519, pages 513-514.

"Powell's life is also the story of the rising influence of the natural sciences, of rationalism contesting the faith of traditional religion, and of a new nationalism and secularism taking its place. As he was coming of age, science was rising to influence the study of nature and culture and even the making of laws. In his day science meant, above all, geology, evolution, and Darwinism [stress added]." Donald Worster, 2001, A River Running West: The Life of John Wesley Powell (Oxford University Press), page xii.

"The movement toward the frontier was not as helter-skelter as some would believe. By the late nineteenth century, the federal government took a very direct role, creating the U.S. Geological Survey in 1879, which was to explore and map all of Western America, just as the U.S. Bureau of Ethnology was to collect anthropological data on its Indian inhabitants. Both were headed for a long time by a most remarkable man, John Wesley Powell (1834-1902). One of the most widely known and respected scientists of his time, Powell was popular and famous as an intrepid explorer. But he was not only an explorer but also a philosopher, if an antiphilosophical one. ... As a result of his explorations and mappings, Powell advanced great plans for the West that called for larger expenditures of federal money and a greater degree of federal control. ... Powell's advice was ignored, and Congress rejected his General Plan for the arid lands of the West [stress added]." Victor Ferkiss, 1993, Nature, Technology, And Society: Cultural Roots Of The Current Environmental Crisis (NY: NYU Press), page 88.

"In 1894, Franklin Hamilton Cushing [1857-1900], head of the Smithsonian's Bureau of Ethnology, came to Philadelphia. He had come to visit the exhibits of the newly opened anthropological museum at the University of Pennsylvania. A reporter from the Philadelphia Press nipped at his heels as he toured the galleries. Cushing was a minor celebrity in the world of anthropology and ethnology. The Philadelphia Press reporter wrote of him: 'No one has done so much to read the every-day lives of the pre-historic people of America from the remains found and his skill in this direction is almost uncanny [stress added]." Steven Conn, 1998, Museums And American Intellectual Life, 1876-1926, page 3.

"Between 1891 and 1893 Frank Cushing [1857-1900] composed an account of the origins and early months of the Hemenway Southwestern Archaeological Expedition that has survived for over a century, but only as unpublished fragments that were disperesed in several archives across the United States. ... Frank Cushing was heir to a long-standing Euro-American tradition of male exploration and discovery that was characterized by a distinctive set of discursive practices. It was a discourse that combined categories and activities of politics, commerce, and science into a common genre: part scientific observing and collecting, part travelogue, part adventure story, and part investment prospectus [stress added]." Curtis M. Hinsley and David R. Wilcox, 2002, The Lost itinerary of Frank Hamilton Cushing (Tuscon: The University of Arizona Press), pages 3 and 18.

ON The Golden Bough [1890->1915] by James G. Frazer (1854-1941): "It may be said without reasonable fear of contradiction that no other work in the field of anthropology has contributed so much to the mental and artistic climate of our times. Indeed, what Freud [1856-1939] did for the individual, Frazer did for civilization as a whole. For a Freud deepend men's insight into the behavior of individuals by uncovering the ruder world of the subconscious, from which much of it springs, so Frazer enlarged man's understanding of the behavior of societies by laying bare the primitive concepts and modes of thought which underlie and inform so many of their institutions and which persist, as a subliminal element of their culture, in traditional folk customs [stress aded]." Theodor H. Gaster [Editor], 1959, The New Golden Bough: A New Abridgement of the Classic Work by Sir James George Frazer (NY: New American Library), pages xix-xx.

"In 1658, James Ussher [1580-1656] , Archbishop of Armagh and Primate of Ireland, estimated that the Earth was created in the early evening of October 22, 4004 B.C. He based his calculations rather loosely on the family trees found in the Old Testament, and anchored them in historical events that seemed to have corresponding accounts in both the Bible and ancient written histories dating from Greek and Roman times." Christopher Wills and Jeffrey Bada, 2000, The Spark of Life: Darwin and the Primeval Soup (Cambridge, Mass: Perseus Publishing), pages 66-67.

"Having assumed that the world began in the autumn, Ussher [1580-1656] took it for granted that the first complete day of the world would be the first day of the week--a Sunday. Having made all these assumptions, and knowing the year to be 4004 B.C., calculating the date was straightforward: 'I have observed that the Sunday, which in the year [4004 B.C.] aforesaid, came nearest the Autumnal Aequinox, by Astronomical Tables, happened upon the 23rd day of the Julian October.' ... as he made explicit in his introduction, time began at 6 P.M. on the evening of Saturday, October 22, 4004 B.C. [stress added]." Martin Gorst, 2001, Measuring Eternity: The Search For the Beginning Of Time (NY: Broadway Books), pages 38-39.

"John Lloyd Stephens (1805-1850) was a new York lawyer with a taste for politics who started traveling for his health. ... While in London in 1836, Stephens met Frederick Catherwood (1804-1852), a British architect and artist who had just returned from a lengthy sketching trip in the Near East. ... The two men became friends and prominent member's of New York's literary circle, where they heard rumours of unexplored temples in the Central American rain forest. In October 1839, they set out on a journey in search of rumoured jungle civilizations [stress added]." Brian M. Fagan [Editor], 1996, Eyewitness to Discovery: First-Person Accounts of More Than Fifty of the World's Greatest Archaeological Discoveries (Oxford University Press), page 334.

"In 1948, when this magazine [Archaeology] first appeared [and Charles F. Urbanowicz was six years old!], archaeologists believed humanity was little more than a quarter of a million years old. The earliest farmers came from Egypt's Fayum, perhaps 6,000 years ago. The Maya were peaceful, calendar-obsessed astronomers. Stonehenge was effectively undated. The first Native Americans were big-game hunters who roamed the plains. Archaeologists, meanwhile numbered in the hundreds, many of them amateurs or self-trained excavators, and most worked within the narrow confines of Europe, Southwestern Asia, and North America. Five decades later, we gaze out over an archaeological landscape transformed. The human past extends back more than 2.5 million years, farming is at least 10,000 years old, and the Maya are known to have been an aggressive, blood-thirsty people. The hundreds of archaeologists have become thousands, most professionally trained, conducting fieldwork in widely scattered parts of the world. And archaeology is concerned with every facet of the past, from our East African origins to the technological achievements of the Industrial Revolution. Developments in three major areas have redefined research during these years: computers and an awesome array of new scientific methods have allowed us to make discoveries unimaginable at mid-century; the explosive growth in the number of professionals and the rise of nationalism have made archaeology a global discipline; and theoretical advances have transformed the way we approach the business of discovery. Willard Libby's remarkable chronological method, developed in the late 1940s, won him a Nobel Prize [in Chemistry in 1960 ] and changed the course of archaeology. C-14 dating allowed the first relatively precise chronology for the past 40,000 years... People sometime ask me, 'Will archaeology survive in the twenty-first century?' If the dramatic discoveries and scientific achievements of the past 50 years are any guide, the answer must be a resounding yes [stress added]." Brian Fagan, 1998, 50 Years of Discovery: How Archaeology Has Reconfigured The Human past. Archaeology, September/October, Vol. 51, No. 5, pages 33-34.

"Some of what we claim to know about the past is true; the rest is false. The purpose of this book is to describe ways of telling the difference. [page 17] ... The question of science-versus-humanities, or natural sciences versus social science is a lively internal issue among archaeologists. ... Archaeology is like a social science in that the objects of interest are people, human culture, and artifacts created under the influence of ideas and social norms. Evidence in archaeology is often symbolic, meaningful, and intentional, and the archaeologist must be sensitive to this unnatural content. But archaeology is also like a natural science in that its focus is on the material remains of people in the past and on their relations with the natural environment. ... Located at this interface, archaeology is especially prone to disagreements over method. ... [Louis] Binford's model of good archaeological method is at the heart of what is sometimes called new Archaeology.... Objectivity is the methodological goal. [Ian] Hodder, in explicit opposition to this, claims that natural science is an inappropriate model for archaeology in that it is incorrigibly insensitive to ideas [stress added]." Peter Kosso, 2001, Knowing The Past: Philosophical Issues of History and Archaeology (NY: Humanity Books/Promethus Books), pages 59-61.

"Professor V. Gordon Childe [1892-1957], who died in the Blue Mountains of his native Australia in 1957 soon after retiring from the Directorship of the London University Institute of Archaeology, was one of the great prehistorians of the world. More perhaps than any other man he showed how by using the data won by archaeologists and natural scientists it was possible to gain a new view of what constituted human history. Inevitably some of the books in which he summarized, with brilliant mastery of detail, the current situation in different fields of prehistoric archaeology have begun to lost something of their value for modern students [stress added]." Grahame Clarke, 1965, Foreward. What Happened in History by V. Gordon Childe, 1942 [1965 Penguin Books Edition], page 7.

"Feminists and gender archaeologists have already made significant contributions to our understanding of long-term changes and variations in gender roles, hierarchies, and ideologies in many parts of the world. I will touch on a few examples: the role of hunting in human evolution, the origins of women's oppression, ancient goddess worship, and nonbinary gender systems [stress added]." Kelley Hays-Gilpin, 2000, Feminist Scholarship in Archaeology. The Annals of The American Academy of Political and Social Science, Vol. 571 (September 2000), pages 89-106, page 97.

"In the history of the study of human evolution there is a series of associations that have become fixed: Pithecanthropus erectus from Java and his discoverer Eugene Dubois [1858-1940]; Raymond Dart [1893-1988] and Australopithecus africanus from southern Africa; Louis Leakey [1903-1972] with East African Homo habilis. If there is one name associated with the discovery of Peking Man, Sinanthropus pekinensis, it is Davidson Black [1884-1933] [stress added]." Penny van Oosterzee, 2000, Dragon Bones: The Story of Peking Man (Cambridge: Perseus Press), page 42.

"A man [or a woman] who has once looked with the archaeological eye will never see quite normally. He will be wounded by what other men call trifles. It is possible to refine the sense of time until an old shoe in the bunch of grass or a pile of nineteenth-century beer bottles in an abandoned mining town tolls in one's head like a hall clock. This is the price one pays for learning to read time from the surfaces other than an illuminated dial. It is the melancholy secret of the artifact, the humanly touched thing [stress added]." Loren Eiseley, 1971, The Night Country (NY: Charles Scribner's Sons), page 81.

"The discovery of Baby Taung, the first known australopithecine, in 1924 is now the stuff of legends. How Raymond Dart [1893-1989], a 31-year olf anatomist in South Africa, was given two boxes of fossils recovered from a limestone quarry at Taung, and how, after he found a curious fossil in the second box and spent 73 days chipping away rock matrix, a skull belonging to a juvenile was revealed to Dart two days before Christmas. he named the humanoid Australopithecus africanus, the 'southern ape from Africa. [stress added]."Jon Kalb, 2001, Adventures in the Bone Trade: The Race to Discover Human Ancestors in Ethiopia's Afar Depression (Copernicus Books/Springer-Verlag), page 51.

"Humanity's plot thickens. The 'Toumai' skull isn't much to look at: a nearly complete cranium, some jawbones and a few teeth. But scientists are calling him [or her!] the most important discovery since the first fossilized remains of human ancestors were found 75 years ago. Why? Because Toumai pushes back by a million years the date when humanity's family tree is believed to have sprouted. ... Who knows which theories will hold? The only thing Toumai's discovery proves beyond a doubt is that he's a tiny part of a still-mysterious story [stress added]." USAToday "Editorial" on July 12, 2002, Page 8A; and see: http://www.nature.com/nature/ancestor/ 

"Paleoanthropologists have no idea how many Neanderthals existed (crude estimates are in the many thousands), but archaeologists have found more fossils from Neanderthals than from any extinct species. The first Neanderthal fossil was uncovered in Belgium in 1830, though nobody accurately identified t for more than a century. In 1848, the Forbes Quarry in Gibraltar yielded one of the most complete Neanderthal skulls ever found, but it, too, went unidentified, for 15 years. The name Neanderthal arose after quarryman in Germany's neander valley found a cranium and several long bones in 1856; they gave the specimens to a local naturalist, Johnann Karl Fuhlrott, who soon recognized them as the legacy of a previously unknown type of human. Over the year, France, the Iberian Peninsula, southern Italy and the Levant have yielded abundances of Neanderthal remains, and those finds are being supplemented by newly opened excavations in Ukraine and Georgia. 'It seems that everywhere we look, we're finding Neanderthal remains,' say Loyola's Smith. 'It's an exciting time to be studying Neanderthals' [stress added]." Joe Alper, 2002, Rethinking Neanderthals. Smithsonian, June 2003, pages 82-87, page 85.

"Human evolution is the most passionate aspect of the evolution-creation debate [stress added]." Larry A. Whitham, 2002, Where Darwin Meets the Bible: Creationists And Evolutionists In America (Oxford University Press), page 242.

Interesting (And Somewhat Appropriate) Web Sites Are:

http://www.friesian.com/creation.htm [Creationism & Darwnism, Politics & Economics} Taoist Darwinism]
http://aleph0.clarku.edu/huxley/ [The Huxley File]
http://www.ucmp.berkeley.edu/history/owen.html [Richard Owen} 1804-1892]
http://www.nhm.ac.uk/ [The Natural History Museum] London]
http://www.mugu.com/galton/ [Sir Francis Galton} 1822-1911]
http://elvers.stjoe.udayton.edu/history/people/Galton.html [Francis Galton Links]
http://catal.arch.cam.ac.uk/catal/catal.html [Ian Hodder's Çatalhöyük site]
http://www.ncl.ac.uk/~nktg/wintro/ [Archaeology: An Introduction by Kevin Greene]
http://www.culture.fr/gvpda.htm [20,000 year old cave paintings]
http://www.scanet.org/ [Society for California Archaeology]
http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/cccpwebsite/ [Chico Campus Culture Project]


WEEK 5. September 22 & 24, 2003: Mon & Wed} DISCUSSION OF WRITING ASSIGNMENT #1 (5%) Approximately 1/2 class either Monday 9/22/2003 or Wednesday 9/24/2003.

PLEASE NOTE} Let us also discuss some of your "quotations" or a phrases that struck YOU in some way to date: either from this Guidebook or Langness or Davies & Piero.

NOTE: No new required Reading in Langness; no new required Reading in Urbanowicz; no new required readings in Davies & Piero.

CONSIDER THE IMPLICATIONS OF THE FOLLOWING WORDS:

FROM: USA Today, January 4, 1999: "The idea was simple. Sit around and pick the 1,000 most important people of the millenium. ... [#1] Johannes Gutenberg (1394?-1468) Inventor of printing.... [#5] William Shakespeare (1564-1616) 'Mirror of the millennium's soul'.... [#6] Isaac Newton (1642-1727) Laws of motion helped propel the Age of Reason.... [#7] Charles Darwin (1809-1882) Theory of Evolution [stress added]." From the book by Barbara and Brent Bowers & Agnes Hooper Gottlieb and Henry Gottlieb, 1998, 1,000 People: Ranking The Men And Women Who Shaped The Millennium.

"In the complex history of modern biology, only Darwin's theory of evolution has so shocked the mind as to raise serious questions about man's place in the universe. Darwin forced men to consider that they are animals, and that the designs of creation are played out on a much wider stage than was imagined. From the point of view of the theory of evolution, mankind is only one species among thousands which have their place within the field of organic life on earth. The fact that people took the theory of evolution as an enemy of religion only shows how rigidly they understood the idea of God [stress added]." Jacob Needleman, 1975, A Sense of the Cosmos: The Encounter of Modern Science and Ancient Truth (NY: Doubleday & Co., Inc.), page 64.

"Biologists do not accept the truth of evolution on the basis of Darwin's authority but on the basis of the evidence. Evolutionary theory has been out of Darwin's hands from the moment The Origin of Species appeared in 1859. Once Darwin published his evolutionary hypotheses and the evidence upon which they were based, these entered the public domain of knowledge, and others took the ball and ran with it. Scientific knowledge is not 'owned' by any individual so no individual, even the discoverer, can 'take back' a theory [stress added]. Robert T. Pennock, 1999, Tower of Babel: The Evidence Against the New Creationism (MIT Press), page 71.

"The boldest theories of the period [in the late 19th century] came from England's evolutionary biologist Charles Darwin and historical geologist Charles Lyell, and [John Wesley] Powell did not hesitate to make those theories his own. He took from them the view that the natural world is the product of observable forces operating in the here and now, and that those forces have been operating all the way back, as far as the mind can travel. Nineteenth century scientists called this perspective 'uniformitarianism,' for it looked on nature as the outcome of slow, steady, unvarying processes. Given enough time, a small stream could move a mountain or carve a canyon; a mere five or six inches of erosiion per thousand years could eventually produce a Grand Canyon. Similarly, minute variations among organisms could accumulate until they produced the full diversity of species on the earth [stress added]." Donald Worster, 2001, A River Running West: The Life of John Wesley Powell (Oxford University Press), page 313.

"Charles Darwin 1809-1882. His theory of evolution was met initially by detractors but proved to be a major springboard for modern science. Darwin knew he would be labeled a heretic for his assertions about the origin of man. The significance of his findings far outweighs the criticism he endured [stress added]." The Chico Enterprise-Record, December 26, 1997, page 7C.

"The great value of Darwinism, it seems to me, was that it jolted modern men into questioning various sentimental beliefs about nature and man's place in it. In this, Darwin's influence closely parallels that of Galileo [1564-1642]. Just as the first modern astronomers and physicists destroyed a naive geocentrism, so Darwin and his successorsoverwhelmingly displaced what may be called homocentrism, the belief that nature exists for the sake of man [stress added]." Jacob Needleman, 1975, A Sense of the Cosmos: The Encounter of Modern Science and Ancient Truth (NY: Doubleday & Co., Inc.), page 72.

"In the late nineteenth century the popular understanding of evolution became permeated by social Darwinism, a philosopher most closely identified with Herbert Spencer [1820-1903], who was energetically adapting Darwin's theories to fit his own political views. Spencer thought females never had been inherently equal to males and could never be; subordination of women was not only natural but, in his view, desirable. [FN #31 for the author reads, in part: "For a review of the relevant literature, see especially Richard Hofstadter, Social Darwinism in American Thought (Boston: Beacon Press, 1955). Social Darwinism continues to be an important force in popular thinking...."]. Social Darwinism has, almost indelibly, tainted most people's understanding of evolutionary theory--certainly as it applies to human beings. Yet social Darwinism differs from Darwinism-without-adjectives in one all important way, and ignoring this distinction has been one of the most unfortunate and long-lived mistakes of science journalism. Darwinism proper is devoted to analyzing all the diverse forms of life according to the theory of natural selection. Darwinists describe competition between unequal individuals, but they place no value judgement on either the competition or its outcomes. Natural-selection theory provides a powerful way to understand the subordination of one individual, or a group of individual, by another, but it in no way attempts to condone (or condemn) subordination. By contrast, social Darwinists attempt to justify social inequality. Social Darwinism explicitly assumes that competetion leads to 'improvement' of a species; the mechanism of improvement is the unequal survival of individuals and their offspring. Applying this theory to to the human condition, social Darwinists hold that those individuals who win the competetion, who survive and thrive, must necessarily be the 'best.' Social inequalities between the sexes, or between classes or races, represent the operation of natural selection and therefore should not be tampered with, since such tampering would impede the progress of the species. It is this latter brand of Darwinism that became popularly associated with evolutionary biology. The association is incorrect, but it helps to explain why feminists have steadfastly resisted biological perspectives [stress added]." Sarah Blaffer Hrdy, 1981, 1999, The Woman That Never Evolved: With A New Preface and Bibliographical Updates (Harvard University Press), pages 12-13.

"Science evolves over historical time. Concepts come into being and may pass away; some 'survive' and others do not; and there can be competition between ideas. Some win; others lose; still others gte transformed (evolve) into new forms. Is this evolution of science illuminated by natural selection theory? [stress added]." Holmes Rolston, III, 1999, Genes, Genesis and God: Values and Their Origins in Natural and Human History (Cambridge University Press), page 168.
"Reading is seeing by proxy."
Herbert Spencer [1820-1903]


WEEK 6. September 29 & October 1, 2003: Mon & Wed} 19th / 20th Century Reaction(s) & REVIEW on October 1, 2003 (including François Péron, Franz Boas, Alfred Louis Kroeber, and others!).

Required Reading in: Langness: Repeat Chapter 2 (pp. 50-73) and please read Urbanowicz on "Comments on Tasmanian publications...." which may be viewed by clicking here: ESSAY #12 at the end of this printed Guidebook.

NOTE: A "sample" self-paced exam should be available at: http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ANTH296FA2003TESTONE.htm by Monday September 29, 2003, to assist you as a Review for EXAM I on Monday October 6, 2003. (Incidentally, I am well aware that "older" versions of my ANTH 296 Exams exist "out there" - I return them so you might learn from any mistakes; by all means, if you have access to "old" exams, do look at them; but r.e.m.e.m.b.e.r to read and study for EXAM I (and eventually EXAM II) as if you might be faced with BRAND NEW EXAMINATION QUESTIONS - which could well be the case!)!

PLEASE read any one of the following items from the selections on RESERVE:

Any appropriate selection in U. Gacs et al.
Bidney: Ch 8 (pp. 215-249).
Darnell: #20 (pp. 260-273).
Geertz (1988): Ch. 1 (pp. 1-24).
Harris: Ch 9 + 10 (pp. 250-300) or Harris Ch. 18 (pp. 464-513).
Hays: Ch 23-29 (pp. 227-305).
Honigman: Ch 15 (pp. 637-716).
Kardiner & Preble: pp. 95-116 or pp. 117-139 and pp. 163-177.
Kuper: Ch 7 (pp. 204-226).
Mead & Bunzel: pp.477-484 and pp. 617-628 or pp. 458-507.
Moore: pp. 113-139.
Montagu: #18 (pp. 315-319) or Montagu #20 (pp. 344-391).
Silverman: Ch. 2 (pp. 35-65) or Ch. 4 (pp. 101-139).
Voget: Ch 13 (pp. 480-538).

YOU should have finished reading Merryl Wyn Davies and Piero, 2002, Introducing Anthropology, pp. 1-59.

CONSIDER THE IMPLICATIONS OF THE FOLLOWING WORDS:

"The appointment of Daniel Garrison Brinton [1837-1899] as Professor of Archaeology and Linguistics at the University of Pennsylvania in 1886 was technically the first professorship of Anthropology in America, although he received no salary and attracted no students .... Indeed, Brinton's appointment resulted not from the need for anthropological teaching, but from Provost William Pepper's concern to establish 'a great ethnological museum'.... [stress added]." Regna Darnell, 1998, And Along Came Boas: Continuity And Revolution In Americanist Anthropology (Philadelphia: John Benjamins Publishing Co.), page 105.

"In the United States anthropology began in the 19th century when a number of dedicated amateurs went into the field to gain a better understanding of what many European Americans still regarded a 'primitive people.' Exemplifying their emphasis on firsthand observation is Frank Hamilton Cushing [1857-1900], who lived among the Zuni Indians for 4 years.... Among these founders of North American anthropology were a number of women whose work was highly influential among those who spoke out in the 19th century in favor of women's rights. One of these pioneering anthropologists was Matilda Cox Stevenson [1849-1915], who also did fieldwork among the Zuni. in 1885, she founded the Women's Anthropological Society, the first professional association for women scientists. Three years later, the Bureau of American Ethnology hired her, making her one of the first women in the United States to receive a full-time position in science [stress added]." William A. Haviland, 1999, Cultural Anthropology, 9th edition, page 7.

"In at least one respect, the American West--the vast expanse of land running from the 98th meridian bisecting the Dakotas, Nebraska, Kansas, Oklahoma, and Texas to the Pacific Ocean--was all a big mistake. ... One of the few people urging restraint as settlers rushed across the continent was a man by the name of John Wesley Powell [1834-1902]. A Civil War [1861-1865] veteran who lost his right arm in the battle of Shiloh, Powell went on in 1860 to successfully navigate the Colorado River. But his greatest contribution to American society stemmed not from his explorations but from his deep understanding of the hard reality that unfolded across the 98th meridian. The West might seem wet and inviting at the moment, Powell argues in the 1870s, but aridity--a fundamental inability to support agriculture without an artificial infusion of water--defined its true character [stress added]." Ted Steinberg, 2002, Down To Earth: Nature's Role in American History (NY: Oxford University Press), page 116.

"The Boas legacy is complex and must be viewed quite broadly. ... In the final analysis, he was concerned with the human condition. He championed the causes of individuals in trouble, often placing his own reputation in jeopardy. 'In all his work, whatever the approach, he continuously stressed the innate worth of the human being, the dignity of all human culture [stress added]." Marshall Hyatt, Franz Boas--Social Activist: The Dynamics of Ethnicity, 1990: 156 & 157.

"Franz Boas [1858-1942] hated authority. Authority, whether it was that of tradition or that of a university administrator, was to be resisted and defied. His students were exhorted to practise indepedence of thought and action, and woe to those who did not. He fought authority all of his life, even his own authority; for when any of his ideas were threatened with systematization he went off on another tack, leaving his followers without a flag. He is the greatest hero in American anthropology, but there is no Boas 'school' [stress added]." A. Kardiner & E. Preble (1961), They Studied Man (NY: Mentor Books), page121.

"Alice C. Fletcher [1838-1923] began her long and distinguished career in anthropology during the late 1870s at the age of forty, studying archaeology at Harvard's Peabody Museum under the direct supervision of the eminent Professor Frederick Ward Putnam [1839-1915]. She got off to a remarkable start at Harvard's Peabody, digging in the shell mounds of Maine and nearly single-handedly saving Ohio's famous Serpent Mound from destruction [stress added]." David Hurst Thomas, 2000, Skull Wars: Kennewick Man, Archaeology, And The Battle For Native American Identity (NY: Basic Books), page 65.

Lewis Henry Morgan (1818-1881) was once termed the "dean of American anthropology" and as L.A. White (1900-1975) has written: "Morgan fell into disrepute in the United States when Franz Boas and his students rose to ascendency in anthropological science. As an American he was looked down upon, ignored by the European-born members of the Boas school. The reaction against cultural evolutionism, which became vigorous in the United States under Boas, and in Europe under the leadership of Fritz Graebner [1877-1934] and later of Schmidt [1868-1954] and Koppers [1886-1961], took Morgan as its prime target. He was in turn ignored, belittled, and ridiculed. The fact that Ancient Society [1877] had become a Marxist classic unquestionably contributed to the hostility to and rejection of Morgan's work, but it is difficult to gauge the magnitude of this factor [stress added]." Leslie A. White, 1968, Lewis H. Morgan. International Encyclopedia of the Social Sciences, 1968, Vol. 10, pages 496-498, pages 497-498.

Edward S. Curtis [1868-1952]: "Curtis ended up working for 30 years on his self-assigned assignment [which was to culminate in his multivolume work entitled The North American Indian] in which he regarded himself as both an artist and a scientist. He visited 80 tribes, exposed a total of approximately 40,000 negatives, conducted countless interviews on manners and customs, wrote down the tribal histories that had been handed down orally, and concerned himself with stories, legends, and myths. He conducted linguistic studies, and with the help of an assistant used an early Edison wax cylinder recording instrument to record music, songs and chants, which were later transcribed into musical notation. The entire material was then prepared for publication. As an example, the basis concepts of 75 languages and dialects were preserved in this manner, and more than 10,000 songs recorded. But that wasn't all: Curtis was also the first person to make motion pictures of the Indians, filming among other things....[stress added!]." Hans Christian Adam, 1997, Introduction. In The North American Indian: The Complete Portfolios by Edward S. Curtis (Köln: Taschen), pages 6-30, pages 17-18.

"Although there were many American anthropologists before Franz Boas, it was he who founded the first University Department in America (at Clark University [located in Worcester, Massachusetts-founded in 1887] in 1888), and he was himself a sort of funnel through which all [!] American anthropology passed between its nineteenth-century juniority and its twentieth-century maturity [stress added]." Paul Bohannan & Mark Glazer, Editors (1988) High Points in Anthropology (NY: A.A. Knopf) page 81.

"In 1897, Franz Boas [1858-1942], curator of ethnography at the American Museum of natural History [New York, New York], wrote a letter to the Kwakiutl community of Fort Rupert, British Columbia [Canada]. Boas' friend and colleague George Hunt translated the letter into Kwakwala, the language spoken by the Kwakiutl people, and read it alound to the group. Friends: I am Mr. Boas who is speaking to you....It is two winters sinze I have been with you, but I have thought of you often...the ways of the Indian were made differently from the ways of the white man at the beginning of the world, and it is good that we remember the old ways. ... Your laws will not be forgotten. Your children and the white man will understand that the old ways of the Indians were good...." As Boas knew from his first visit to the Kwakiutl in 1886, the most important ceremony of these Native people was the potlatch. ... Canadian officials and missionaries both frowned on the potlatch, criticizing the vast expenditures of wealth necessary for proper validation of chiefly status. So abhorrent did the white Canadians find the potlatch that the government declared it illegal in 1884 [stress added]." from: Chiefly Feasts: The Enduring Kwakiutl Potlatch (n.d., The American Museum of Natural History).

"The Boasian method consisted of examining cultures in depth, establishing their history through language, art, myth, and ritual and studying the influences that shaped them in their distinctive environments and in contacts with neighboring cultures. .... For Boas, cultures could not be explained in terms of the native endowments of particular races. His work led inevitably to cultural relativism; he argued that anthropologists needed to bring to their work the fearless vision of the outsider and the capacity to see another culture unblinkered by one's own. Under his influence anthropology became the study of culture, not race, moving away from its biological determinist roots toward a more genuinely historical understanding of the relationship between ethnicity, culture, and society [stress added]." Hilary Lapsley, 1999, Margaret Mead And Ruth Benedict: The Kinship of Women (Amherst: U Mass Press), pages 56-57.

ON BOAS: "Clark University [Worcester, Massachusetts] renewed his docentship in 1890, and again in 1891. During this time Boas achieved a milestone in the History of American Anthropology. In 1892 the university conferred on Alexander Chamberlain a doctorate in anthropology. It was the first such academic honor bestowed in America, and Boas took pride in having directed Chamberlain's study." Marshall Hyatt, 1990, Franz Boas--Social Activist: The Dynamics of Ethnicity, page 27.

"Clark [University] attained the distinction of granting the first American Ph.D. in anthropology to Alexander Francis Chamberlain (1865-1914) in 1892. Chamberlain was a Canadian, who had obtained an M.A. in modern languages from the University of Toronto... [stress added]." Regna Darnell, 1998, And Along Came Boas: Continuity And Revolution In Americanist Anthropology (Philadelphia: John Benjamins Publishing Co.), page 108.

F. Boas in 1904: "I have been asked to speak on the history of anthropology. ... Before I enter into my subject I will say that the speculative anthropology of the 18th and early part of the 19th century is distinct in its scope and method from the science which is called anthropology at the present time and is not included in our discussion." (The History of Anthropology. Science, 21 October 1904, Vol. 20; reprinted in R. Darnell, Editor, Readings in the History of Anthropology, 1974: 260-273, page 260)

"Major changes in American graduate education were necessary at the end of the 19th century in order for a university to become a plausible institutional framework for anthropology. ... The European, particularly German, model for graduate education was readily available at precisely the right moment.... The German model was crucial on a number of fronts: First, Franz Boas [1858-1942] was trained in Germany and many of his early students, from example, Alfred kroeber [1876-1960] and Robert Lowie [1883-1957], were German in background. Second, the scope and organization of Lowie (1937) [History of Ethnological Theory] confirms that much of the intellectual foundation of Americanist anthropology was adapted directly from the German anthropological heritage: Johann Bachofen (1815-1887), Adolph Bastian (1826-1905), Friedrich Ratzel (1844-1887), Wilhelm Wundt (1832-1920). The German anthropological tradition of volksgeist studies...brought the ideas of Johann Gottfried Herder (1744-1803), Wilhelm von Humboldt (1767-1835), and Hermann Steinthal (1823-1899) into the Americanist tradition. Third, late 19th-century German scholarship was organized around academic professional training at the graduate level. This was the model upon which Boas and his first generation of students would differentiate professional anthropologists from their amateur contemporaries [stress added]." Regna Darnell, 1998, And Along Came Boas: Continuity And Revolution In Americanist Anthropology (Philadelphia: John Benjamins Publishing Co.), page 101.

Frederick Starr (1858-1933): "…as professor and collector and Franz Boas as curator and professor were leading figures in anthropology at the turn of the century. Starr was the great popularizer of anthropology and Boas the great professionalizer. Boas was to become the most influential figure in American Anthropology during the first half of the twentieth century. Starr's influence was to fade until, by the second half of the twentieth century, his work was seldom acknowledged [stress added]." D. McVicker, 1989, Parallels and Rivalries: Encounters Between Boas and Starr. Curator [American Museum of Natural History], pages 212-228, page 212.

[Supposedly] "Virtually the only anthropologist in the United States [in the late 19th century] who rejected such ethnocentric thinking was the shock-haired immigrant Franz Boas, who arrived in the United States in 1887 at the age of twenty-nine. Born into a liberal Jewish-German family, he immigrated to America, where he soon made contact with [John Wesley] Powell. Whether he was a victim of discrimination or simply a hard person to get along with, Boas did not find jobs easy to obtain or hold onto. Powell proved to be willing to fund his summer travels to study pacific Northwest tribes and, in 1895, offered to make him editor of the bureau's publications. By that point Boas had secured a position at the American Museum of Natural History in New York [City], which led eventuallyy to a faculty appointment at Columbia [University], and he refused the offer. He may have been grateful, but he was thoroughly opposed to Powell's evolutionary anthropology [stress added]." Donald Worster, 2001, A River Running West: The Life of John Wesley Powell (Oxford University Press), page 457.

NOTE SOME articles that Boas wrote for the American Anthropologist and the year published: "Anthropometry of Shoshonean Tribes (1899), Changes in the Bodily Form of Descendants of Immigrants (1912), Changes in Bodily Form of Descendants of Immigrants (1940), Evolution and Diffusion? (1924) , Heredity in Anthropometric Traits (1907), Heredity in Head Form (1903), In Memoriam: Herman Karl Haeberlin (1919), Northern Elements in the Mythology of the Navaho (1897), Notes On the Chatino Language (1913), Notes on the Chemakum Language (1892), Notes on the Chinook Language (1893), On Alternating Sounds (1889), On the Variety of Lines of Descent Represented in a Population (1916), Physical Characteristics of the Indians of the North Pacific Coast (1891), Property Marks of Alaskan Eskimo (1899), Report on the Academic Teaching of Anthropology (1919), Sketch of the Kwakiutl Language (1900), Some Recent Criticisms of Physical Anthropology (1899), The Cephalic Index (1899), The Classification Of American Languages (1920), The Correlation of Anatomical or Physiological Measurements (1894), The Head-forms of the Italians as Influenced by Heredity and Environment (with Helene Boas) (1913), The Methods Of Ethnology (1920), The Origin of Totemism (1916), The Social Organization of the Kwakiutl (1920), The Social Organization of the Tribes of the North Pacific Coast (1924), The Vocabulary of the Chinook Language (1904), Waldemar Bogoras (1937)...." You can find out more about these at: http://www.publicanthropology.org/Archive/AnthJournalsProject.htm [Public Anthropology}Anthropology Journal Archive Project]

"The [20th Century] Boasians were clearly rejecting racial explanations but also were against nineteenth-centuiry cultural evolution for its demeaning treatment of native peoples.... Modern students of anthropology do not seem to realize how strong a hold biological determinism and racial explanations had on the scholarly community in the interbellum [World War I and World War II] era [stress added]." Walter Goldschmidt, 2000, Historical Essay: A Perspective on Anthropology. American Anthropologist, Vol. 102, No. 4, December 2000, pages 789-807, page 791.

"It isn't necessary to wear oneself out repeating that racism is either a monstrous error or a shameless lie. The Nazis themselves have recently had to appreciate the accuracy of the facts that I have brought together on the European immigrants of America." Franz Boas (1858-1942). Jonathan Green 1997, Famous Last Words (London: Kyle Cathie Limited), page 79.

"Ales Hrdlicka (1869-1943), the leading American physical anthropologist during these early years (1910-30), was the first curator in physical anthropology at the Bureau of American Ethnology in the U.S. National Museum of the Smithsoninan Institution. Hrdlicka, a medical doctor who received training in anthropology at the École d'Anthropologie de Paris and the Laboratoire d'Anthropologie ('Broca's Institute,' as Hrdlicka referred to it....[Hrdlicka] firmly believed in the innate superiority of academicians...men...and 'native' or 'old American' whites [stress added]." Lesley M. Rankin-Hill and Michael L. Blakey, 1999, W. Montague Cobb: Physical Anthropologist, Anatomist, and Activist. IN Ira E. Harrison & Faye V. Harrison [Editors], 1999, African-American Pioneers in Anthropology (University of Illinois Press), pages 101-136, page 1-5.

Anténor Firmin [1850-1911] = "A Boasian before Boas. ... This year [2000] marks the publication of The Equality of the Human Races, Positivist Anthropology (New York: Garland Press) by Haitian scholar Anténor Firmin, probably the first anthropologist of African descent. ... Originally published in Paris in 1885 as De l'elegalité des Races Humaines (Anthropologie Positive), the book has been translated by Asselin Charles and reintroduced to scholars as a pioneering work of 19th century anthropology. [stress added]. Carolyn Fluer-Lobban, 2000, Anthropology News (Washington D.C.), page 16. And see the American Anthropologist, Vol. 102, No. 3, September 2000: Anténor Firmin: Haitian Pioneer of Anthropology. Carolyn Fluer-Lobban, pages 449-466.

"Gradually there arose a need for regional studies, undertaken not incidentally to a naturalist's or missionary's main interests, but as complete investigations of particular peoples by professional anthropologists. In 1884, the British Association for the Advancement of Science appointed a committee, of which [Edward Burnett] Tylor was a prominent member, for investigating the Northwest tribes of Canada; and from 1888 until 1898, Franz Boas was connected with the relevant reports. These investigations doubtless stimulated the Jessup North Pacific Expedition (1898-1902), organized by Boas for determining Siberian-American connections. Comparable in intensiveness and roughly contemporary was the Cambridge Expedition to Torres Straits, led by Dr. A.C. Haddon [1855-1940], assisted, among others, By Dr. W.H.R.Rivers [1864-1922], and Charles Gabriel Seligman [1873-1940] [stress added]." Robert H. Lowie [1883-1957], 1937, The History of Ethnological Theory (page 89).

"In December 1895 Auguste and Louis Lumière presented their newly patented cinematographe to a public audience for the first time. ... cinema was born. Some three years later after the first Lumière screening, Alfred Cort Haddon [1855-1940] organised a fieldwork expedition to the Torres Straits islands from Cambridge. He gathered together a group of six scientists and they set out to study the native peoples of a small group of islands lying to the north of Australia. The Torres Straits expedition of 1898 marks the symbolic birth of modern anthropology. ... and he was quick to include a cinematographe among the team's advanced instruments. By 1900 he was urging his Australian colleague, Baldwin Spencer, to take a camera with him as an integral part of the fieldwork equipment he planned to use in the northern territories of Australia [stress added]." Anna Grimshaw, 2001, The Ethnographer's Eye: Ways of Seeing in Anthropology (Cambridge University Press), pages 15-16.

"The Department [of Anthropology at the University of California, Berkeley] was founded in 1901 on the initiative of Frederic Ward Putnam [1839-1915]. Putnam had developed the first teaching program in the United States at Harvard University and was trying to get other centers of research and teaching in anthropology established. He had already organized an anthropology program at the Field Museum in Chicago on the occasion of the World's Columbian Exposition and after that, one at the American Museum of Natural History in New York where he got Franz Boas appointed Curator. Boas was soon invited to teach at Columbia as well, and he built up the second American teaching program in anthropology there. Putnam went on to persuade Mrs. Phoebe Apperson Hearst to finance a Department of Anthropology at the University of California, of which she was a Regent. In the first report on the Department, published in 1905, Putnam explained: The Department of Anthropology was constituted by the Regents of the University of California September 10, 1901 [stress added]." From: http://sunsite.berkeley.edu/Anthro/rowe/rolib.html [John H. Rowe} 1995 item on UCB] and see: http://sunsite.berkeley.edu/Anthro/rowe/interview.htm [October 13, 1998 interview] The first Ph.D. (1908) awarded by the Department of Anthropology at what is now known as the University of California, Berkeley, was to Samuel A. Barrett.

"Alfred Louis Kroeber [born June 11, 1876], when he died in October 1960, at the age of eighty-four, was the dean of American anthropologists and still one of the hardest workers in the social sciences. ... After receiving his Ph.D. in 1901 Kroeber went to California as Curator of Anthropology for the California Academy of Sciences to organize an anthropological study of the state. He was affiliated with the University of California in this project and later became instructor, assistant professor, associate professor, and finally full professor and curator and director of the Anthropological Museum at that institution. ... Kroeber's work falls into two main categories: his ethnographical field work, and his theories on cultural progress and the philosophy of history. In ethnography his work is of undisputed excellence. His theories on culture and cultural history are controversial [stress added]." A. Kardiner & E. Preble, 1961, Alfred Louis Kroeber: Man, Whales, and Bees. They Studied Man (NY: Mentor), by, pages 163-177.

"The reputation of Franz Boas as a scientist declined in the decades after his death in 1942, but his reputation as a champion of human rights and an opponent of racism remained intact. More recently, however, some writers have questioned the sincerity, the results, and the political implications of his anthropology and his work against racism and ethnocentrism. Others have been critical of his relations with colleagues and students such as Ella Deloria [1888-1971] and Zora Neale Hurston [1891-1960]. In this essay I discuss some of these claims and present a more positive view. Franz Boas was passionately and consistently concerned about human rights and individual liberty, freedom of inquiry, and speech, equality of opportunity, and the defeat of prejudice and chauvinism. He struggled for a lifetime to advance a science that would serve humanity, and he was as much of a humanitarian in private as he was in public [stress added]." Herbert S. Lewis, 2001, The Passion of Franz Boas. American Anthropologist, Vol. 103, No. 2 (June), pages 447-467, page 447. 

"In an interview taped for a PBS [Public Broadcasting System] special of Boas in 1979, [William S.] Willis [1921-1983] Willis ... propose[d] that race was Boas's fundamental concern in anthropology. According to Willis, Boas's contribution to the study of race was unique for four reasons: he introduced a new way of looking at race as a determinant of human behavior; he tried to shift the main focus of anthropological research from Native Americans to others, especially to black people in the United States; he tried to establish a 'black presence' in anthropology by drawing black students into Ph.D. programs; and he tried to establish a close cooperation between anthropology as a discipline and black scholars and political leaders interested in studying black people in the United States and elsewhere [stress added]." Peggy Reeves Sanday, Skeletons in the Anthropological Closet: The Life and Work of William S. Willis Jr. IN Ira E. Harrison & Faye V. Harrison [Editors], 1999, African-American Pioneers in Anthropology (University of Illinois Press), pages 243-264, page 260.

CONSIDER THE WORDS OF LESLIE A. WHITE [1900-1975] ON FRANZ BOAS [1858-1942]: "Boas is like the Bible, you can find anything you want to in his writings. He was not a scientist. Scientists make their arguments with an explicit logical framework. Boas was muddle-headed. Better to read clerical literature, at least the priests know why they hold their opinions! [stress added]." Lewis R. Binford, 1972, An Archaeological Perspective (NY: Seminar Press), pages 7-8.

CONSIDER THE WORDS OF ROBERT CARNEIRO (1927->) ON LESLIE A. WHITE (1900-1975): "Leslie White was, without question, one of the intellectual leaders of contemporary anthropology. But he was more than this. He was one of the major instruments by means of which anthropology became a full-fledged science. When he entered it, anthropology was dominated by a negative and critical particularism. When he left it, it had become a positive, expanding, and generalizing discipline. And this transformation was due in no small part to White's own efforts. He gave anthropology powerful concepts and invigorating theories. In a word, he gave it propulsion [stress added]." Robert l. Carneiro, Leslie White. In Sydel Silverman [editor], 1981, Totems and Teachers: Perspectives on the History of Anthropology (NY: Columbia University Press), pages 209-252, page 210.

"During the long period of some forty years in which cultural evolutionism was in almost total eclipse, a few anthropologists continued to work within the evolutionary tradition. Perhaps the best known of them are the American anthropologists Leslie A. White [1900-1975] and Julian H. Steward [1902-1972] and in England, the celebrated archaeologist V. Gordon Childe [1892-1957] [stress added]." David Kaplan and Robert A. Manners, 1972, Culture Theory (New Jersecy: Prentice-Hall), page 43.

AND, FINALLY, REMEMBER THESE WORDS FROM THE BEGINNING OF THIS GUIDEBOOK?: "One who makes a close study of almost any branch of science soon discovers the great illusion of the monolith. When he [or she] stood outside as an uninformed layman, he [or she] got a vague impression of unanimity among the professionals. He [or she] tended to think of science as supporting the Establishment with fixed and approved views. All this dissolves as he [or she] works his [or her] way into the living concerns of practicing scientists. He [and she] finds lively personalities who indulge in disagreement, disorder, and disrespect. He [and she] must sort out conflicting opinions and make up his [and her] own mind as to what is correct and who is sound. This applies not only to provinces as vast as biology and to large fields such as evolutionary theory, but even to small and familiar corners such as the species problem. The closer one looks, the more diversity one finds [stress added]." Norman Macbeth, 1971, Darwin Retried: An Appeal To Reason (NY: Dell Publishing Co.), page 18.

Interesting (And Somewhat Appropriate) Web Sites Are:

http://www.andrews.edu/MDLG/german/german-american/famous/B/boas_franz/ [Franz Boas]
http://phoenicia.nmsu.edu/minds/Summaries/boas_109006_URL_Original.html [Jay Ruby on Franz Boas]
http://encyclopedia.com/articles/01602.html [on Franz Boas]
http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/cultural/biography/index.shtml [F. Boas & Others! From A->Z]
http://www.aaanet.org/gad/history/html/childe.htm [V.G. Childe} 1892-1957]
http://www.journals.uchicago.edu/CA/journal/issues/v42n3/013002/013002.text.html [ Herbert S. Lewis, 2001, Boas, Darwin, Science, and Anthropology. Current Anthropology, Vol. 41, No. 3 ]
http://www.publicanthropology.org/Archive/AnthJournalsProject.htm [Public Anthropology}Anthropology Journal Archive Project]


WEEK 7. October 6 & 8, 2003: Mon & Wed} EXAM I [25%] on Monday October 6, 2003 and then into 20th Century Reactions and more of Comte-->Durkheim-->Malinowski+ } Exam I based on selected readings in Davies & Piero (pp. 1-59), Langness (pp. xi-73), selected assigned readings in Anthropology 296 Guidebook and Selected Anthropology Essays by Urbanowicz, lectures/discussions, and the quotations referred to in this Guidebook to date. IMPORTANT NOTE: Specific Readings from Reserve WILL NOT be on the Exam. (AND remember ELECTION DAY OCTOBER 7, 2003!)

If possible, for Wednesday October 8, 2003, can you please read "Comments on Bronislaw Malinowski (1884-1942)," which may be viewed by clicking here: ESSAY #13 at the end of this printed Guidebook.

CONSIDER THE IMPLICATIONS OF THE FOLLOWING WORDS:

"The history of anthropology places us in the presence of an infinitely varied and complex reality, and we are indeed forced to recognize that we shall acquire a knowledge of it only at the price of long, methodical and collective efforts, as in the case of the natural phenomena presented to our senses. As soon as we contemplate societies different from that in which everything seems clear to us because everything is familiar, we meet at every step problems which we are incapable of resolving by common sense, aided only by thought and by current knowledge of 'human nature'. The facts which disconcert us surely obey laws, but what are they? We cannot guess. In one sense, social reality presents more difficulties to scientific research than does the physical world, because, even supposing that static laws are known, the state of society at any given moment is never intelligible except through the prior evolution of which it is the present outcome; and how rare are the cases where the historical knowledge of this past is so complete and so certain that nothing indispensable is missing! [stress added]." Lucien Lévy-Bruhl [1857-1939], 1903, La Morale et la sciences des moeurs [Ethics and Moral Science], in Lucien Lévy-Bruhl (1972) by Jean Cazeneuve, pages 24-25.

"'Positive' methods are so central to Comte's [1798-1857] theme that it is surprising that he gave so little time to making clear what 'positivism' meant. In his famous Cours de philosophie positive (based on lectures that he gave in the 1820s) he observes that 'the fundamental character of all positive philosophy is to regard all phenomena as subject to invariable natural laws, whose precise discovery and reduction to the smallest number of possible is the aim of all our effotr.' [stress added]." Julius Gould, 1969, August Comte, pages 35-42, The Founding Fathers of Social Science (edited by Timothy Raison) [England: Penguin Books], page 36.

"Durkheim [1858-1917] is commonly called the heir of Comte [1798-1857] and a positivist. ... Durkheim held that human and social phenomena must be included within the unity of nature, and as such, are in principle subject to statements of general law. Here, Durkheim believed that Comte and Spencer [1820-1903], among others, were on the right track. ... Durkheim has been called the First of the Moderns in sociology and the Father of Functionalism in anthropology. Both of these titles he has earned by his particular methodology. His idea of applying the methods of the physical sciences to sociological data, although not new, as insisted upon to a remarkable degree. ... Another important idea which Durkheim inherited was the French idea of progress. The history of this idea in France can be hastily drawn from Turgot (1727-1781) through Condorcet (1743-1794) and the French Revolution, and Comte [stress added]." A. Kardiner & E. Preble (1961), They Studied Man (NY: Mentor Books), pages 98-99 and page 115.

"On a clear spring afternooon in 1915, in the no-man's-land between te trenches at Marcheville, France, thousands were destroyed by machine-gun fire, among them Robert Hertz [1881-1915]. Hertz, age thirty-three, was a second lieutenant in the French infantry, a husband, and the father of an infant son. He was also foremost among the pupils of Emile Durkheim [1858-1917]--considered, in fact, most likely to succeed Durkheim as the reigning figure in French sociology. ... Of the several important papers that Hertz had published by his early thirties, one was to prove of lasting influence: 'La Prééminence de la main droite: Etude sur la polarité religieuse' (The preeminence of the Right Hand: A Study in Religious Polarity). This essay was a reasoned yet impassioned look into the cross-cultural symbolism of right an left, symbolism that had imparted a near-universal and, in Hertz's view, illegitimate auro of superiority to the right hand and everything connected with it, however arbitrarily. ... Hertz showed that not only that right versus left was one of the main dualities in many cultures but also that it was consistently associated with more abstract polarities [stress added]." Melvin Konner, 1990, Why The Reckless Survive...And Other Secrets of Human Nature (NY: Viking), pages 29-30.

"Durkheim [1857-1917] provided Lévi-Strauss [born 1908 -> ] with a model of society built up of like or unlike segments, which must be integraated to create mechanical or organic solidarity. From Mauss [1872-1950] he learned that this solidarity may be best achieved by setting up a structure of reciprocity; a system of exchanges binding the segments in alliances. Exchanges may involve one of three media: goods and services, languages and synmbols, and the super-gift, women. Underlying any system of exchange is the rule of reciprocity, the rule that every gift demands a return. The return may be direct, in which case one has a system of restricted exchangve; or it may be indirect, in which case one has a system of generalized exchange. Lévi-Strauss argued that the principle of reciprocity was the key to understanding kinship systems, for a kinship system was a mode of organizing the exchange of women in marriage [stress added]." Adam Kuper, 1973, Anthropologists and Anthropology: The British School 1922-1972 (London: Allen Lane), page 207.

PLEASE NOTE the 1891 words of R.H. Codrington [1830-1922]: "It has been my purpose to set forth as much as possible what native say about themselves, not what Europeans say about them. ... No one can be more sensible than myself of the incompleteness and insufficiency of what I venture to publish; I know that I must have made many mistakes and missed much that I might have learnt. I have felt the truth of what Mr. Fison [1832-1907], late missionary in Fiji, to whom I am indebted for much instruction, has written: 'When a European has been living for two or three years among savages he is sure to be fully convinced that he knows all about them; when he has been ten years or so amongst them, if he be an observant man, he finds that he knows very little about them, and so begins to learn.' My own time of learning has been far too short. I have endeavoured as far as possible to give the natives' account of themselves by giving what I took down from their lips and translating what they wrote themselves [stress added]." R.H. Codrington, 1891, The Melanesians: Studies In Their Anthropology And Folk-Lore (The Clarendon Press, Oxford), page vii.

"The ethnographic method has long been associated with Malinowski, who repeatedly claimed credit for its invention. But while Malinowski--through his many students--was clearly responsible for establishing local, village-based research as the anthropological norm in Britain, claims that he single-handedly developed the ethnographic method during his fieldwork in the Trobriands are exaggerated. As Stocking (1983 [Observers And Observed: Essays on Anthropological Fieldwork, pages 70-120] has shown, Malinowski was at best only one of a number of fieldworkers who had been experimenting with systematic village-based research for several years; he was certainly not the first. But as a prolific and talented writer, who was equally adept at self-promotion, he transformed the discipline in Britain in a single generation [stress added]." Robert L. Welsch, 1998, An American Anthropologist in Melanesia: A.B. Lewis and the Joseph N. Field South Pacific Expedition 1909-1913, pages 558-559.

"The ability to understand very different kinds of people is often related to an innate lack of set values and standards. It is no accident that a great novelist like Balzac [1799-1850], who could penetrate and portray with impartial accuracy the character of bankers, prostitutes, and artists, was a relativist of psychopathic proportions. It is also no accident that the most successful field worker in the history of anthropology, Bronislaw Malinowski [1884-1942], was the most eccentric and controversial figure ever to enter the field of anthropology [stress added]" Abraham Kardiner and Edward Preble, 1961, They Studied Man (NY: Mentor Book), page 140.

"Bronislaw Malinowski [1884-1942], my father, was strongly influenced by women all his life: by his Polish mother, his two British wives, his women pupils; by women not his pupils with whom he had intellectual friendships; and by the women of various nationalities whom he loved. He also had three daughters, of whom I am the youngest [stress added]." Helena Wayne (Malinowska), 1985, Bronislaw Malinowski: The Influence of Various Women on His Life and Works. American Ethnologist, Vol. 12, No. 3, pages 529-540, page 529.

"Malinowski [1884-1942] has a strong claim to being the founder of the profession of social anthropology in Britain, for he established its distinctive apprenticeship--intensive fieldwork in an exotic community. For the fifteen years [1923-1938] which he spent at the London School of Economics after his return from the Trobriand islands he was the only master ethnographer in the country, and virtually everyone who wished to do fieldwork in the modern fashion went to work with him [stress added]." Adam Kuper, 1973, Anthropologists and Anthropology: The British School 1922-1972 (London: Allen Lane), page 13.

"In England Bronislaw Malinowski [1884-1942] had just begun to publish the results of his field research on the Trobriand Islands. Yet in the 1920s American anthropology was far from being in the mainstream of scholarship. It was most certainly not a career which could promise security or many rewards to an ambitious scholar. There was a jocose saying among anthropologists in the late '20s that 'You don't have to be crazy to become an anthropologist, but it sure helps.' Another comment, credited to Malinowski, was 'Anthropology is the study of man, embracing woman.' However one felt about the validity of these observations, it was true that one needed a high degree of determination and dedication, as well as a natural curiosity and a sense of the romantics, to select anthropology as a career in those early days [stress added]." Adelin Linton and Charles Wagley, 1971, Ralph Linton (Columbia University Press), page 5.

"An anthropologist on a South Sea Island! How romantic! But the reality entails a kind of squalid loneliness which might otherwise be encountered only by a victim of political torture in solirtary confinement. The anthropologists's position is highly anomalous. He [or she!] wants to understand the values of the society which he observes around him, yet his ultimate purpose is to translate those values into his own. He must not be totally absorbed--he must not be brainwashed. So the more deeply he comes to know his tribal families the more desperately he clutches at any tenuous straw which may help him to remember that he is still, in his own right, a member of modern civilisation. Letters from home become treasures... The private diaries of fieldwork anthropologists record.... Bronislaw Malinowski, the originator of modern anthropological field method, kept such diaries in New Guinea and Melanesia in 1914-15 and 1917-18, and it is to the discredit of all concerned that they have been committed to print. ...The context of the diary adds nothing at all to our understanding of Malinowski's work as an anthropologist. ... Malinowski's widow, who holds the copyright, justifies the publication by claiming that these documents give 'direct insight into the author's inner personality'. They do nothing of the sort, but both Malinowski and his loved ones survive their sacrifice to Mammon remarkably well [stress added]." Edmund Leach, 1967, An Anthropologist's Trivia [originally published in The Guardian on 11 August 1967 as a review of A Diary in the Strictest Sense of the Term]. Stephen Hugh-Jones and James Laidlaw [editors], 2000, The Essential Edmund Leach Volume I: Anthropology and Society (Yale University Press), pages 61-62.

"A great deal has been written about the publication of this book [A Diary In The Strict Sense of the Term, 1967]. I myself don't think it was well edited and presented, but I have read other early diaries and diary fragments of my father's and can see what a difficult task it is to translate and edit such jottings. All the more, I feel the diaries should not have been published as they were but kept, together with his correspondence of that time, as raw material for a biographer, or perhaps published in a different form. I know many anthropologists do not agree with my point of view. They have mined the diaries for insights (often distorted insights) into Malinowski's character and into what day-to-day life in the field can mean, and have found these insights most valuable [stress added]." Helena Wayne (Malinowska), 1985, Bronislaw Malinowski: The Influence of Various Women on His Life and Works. American Ethnologist, Vol. 12, No. 3, pages 529-540, page 540.

BRONISLAW MALINOWSKI} "Anthropology is the science of the sense of humour. It can be thus definied without too much pretentiousness or facetiousness. For to see ourselves as others see is is but the reverse and the counterpart of the gift to see others as they really are and as they want to be: And this is the metier of the anthropologist. He [and she!] has to break down the barriers of race and cultural diversity; he has to find the human being in the savage; he has to discover the primitive in the highly sophisticated Westerner of to-day, and, perhaps, to see that the animal, and the divine as well, are to be found everywhere in man [stress added]." Bronislaw Malinowski, 1937, Introduction. Julius E. Lips, 1937, The Savage Strikes Back (Hyde Park, NY: University Books), pages vii-ix, page vii.

ON BRONISLAW MALINOWSKI (1884-1942): "Nineteen twenty-two saw the publication of The Waste Land [by T.S. Elliot] and Ulysses [by James Joyce], as well as Argonauts of the Western Pacific and A.R. Radcliffe-Brown's first monograph, The Andaman Islanders, all of which effectively remapped the discourse of their fields. As George Stocking notes, 1922 also saw the death of the prominent British anthropologist W.H.R. Rivers [born 1864], more than symbolically marking Malinowski's victory as the leading light in British cultural anthropology. ... For his publication of this book Malinowski has been credited with creating, virtually overnight, the seminal twentieth-century anthropological discourse known as the monograph.... [stress added]." Marc Manganaro, 2002, Culture, 1922: The Emergence of a Concept (Princeton University Press), pages 7-8 and page 56.

ON BRONISLAW MALINOWSKI (1884-1942): "Bronislaw Malinowski is perhaps the first recognized ethnographer. He spent more than two years doing fieldwork in a foreign land and set forth the the first scientific caveats of doing good ethnography. He believed it possible to conduct a scientific study of human behavior in the naturalistic surroundings of cultures, far from a laboratory. Set in the emiricism of the day, Malinowski's method strained to stay rigorous in application while bowing to the unpredictability of both the fieldworker and those being studied. Malinowski launched the modern ethnographic method, which soon became a staple method of an entire discipline, the later, the adopted method of many other disciplines [stress added]." Robert Sands, 2002, Sport Ethnography (Champaign, Ill: Sport Kinetics), page 9.

1938 WORDS OF BRONISLAW MALINOWSKI: "For, to quote William James [1842-1910] , 'Progress is a terrible thing.' It is terrible to those of us who half a century ago were born into a world of peace and order; who cherished legitimate hopes of stability and gradual development; and who now have to live through the dishonesty and immorality of the very historical happenings. I refer to the events of the last few years which seem to demonstrate once more than Might is Right; that bluff, impudence and aggression succeed where a decent readiness to co-operate has failed [stress added]." From the "Introduction" to Jomo Kenyatta, 1938, Facing Mount Kenya: The Tribal Life of the Gikuyu (NY: 1962 Vintage Books edition], page ix.

COMMENT ON BRONISLAW MALINOWSKI [1884-1942]} "'That man had no aesthetic sense. If as if he was color-blind,'[Giancarlo] Scoditti said. 'Reading Malinowski, when he talks of the canoe prow boards or the dance [in the Trobriand Islands], one sees a world of absolute grayness. I was overwhelmed by the colors and vivacity of everything." Alexander Stille, 2002, The Future of the Past (NY: Farrar, Strauss and Giroux), page 161.

NOTE A.R.Radcliffe-Brown [1881-1955] from a 1940 paper: "I hope you will pardon me if I begin with a note of personal explanation. I have been described on more than one occasion as belonging to something called the 'Functional School of Social Anthropology' and even as being its leader, or one of its leaders. This Functional School does not really exist; it is a myth invented by Professor Malinowski [1884-1942]. He has explained how, to quote his own words, 'the magnificent title of the Functional School of Anthropology has been bestowed by myself, in a way on myself, and to a large extent out of my own sense of irresponsibility.' Professor Malinowski's irresponsibility has had unfortunate results, since it has spread over anthropology a dense fog of discussion about 'functionalism.' Professor Lowie [1883-1957] has announced that the leading, though not the only, exponent of functionalism in the nineteenth century was Professor Boas [1858-1942]. I do not think that there is any special sense, other than the purely chronological one, in which I can said to be either the follower of Professor Boas or the predecessor of Professor Malinowski. The statement that I am a 'functionalist,' or equally the statement that I am not, would seem to me to convey no definite meaning. There is no place in natural science for 'schools' in this sense, and I regard social anthropology as a branch of natural science. Each scientist starts from the work of his [of her!] predecessors, finds problems which he believes to be significant, and by observation and reasoning endeavours to make some contribution to a growing body of theory. Co-operation among scientists results from the fact that they are working on the same or related problems. Such co-operation does not result in the formation of schools, in the sense in which there are schools of philosophy or of painting. There is no place for orthodoxies and heterodoxies in science. Nothing is more pernicious in science than attempts to establish adherence to doctrines. All that a teacher can do is assist the student in learning to understand and use the scientific method. It is not his business to make disciples. I conceive of social anthropology as the theoretical natural science of human society, that is, the investigation of social ,phenomena by methods essentially similar to those used in the physical and biological sciences. I am quite willing to call the subject 'comparative sociology,' if anyone so wishes [stress added]." On Social Structure. The Journal of the Royal Anthropological Institute of Great Britain and Ireland, Vol. 70, 1940, pages 1-12, pages 1 + 2.

Interesting (And Somewhat Appropriate) Web Sites Are:

http://www.change.freeuk.com/learning/socthink/malinowski.html [Bronislaw Malinowski]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/klmno/malinowski_bronislaw.html [Bronislaw Malinowski]


WEEK 8. October 13 & 15, 2003: Mon & Wed} Comte-->Durkheim/Van Gennep-->Mauss-->Lévi-Strauss and British Social Anthropology, American Cultural Anthropology, as well as French anthropologie; and please remember: Preliminary Term Paper Topic DUE (WA#2) on Monday October 20, 2003.

Required Reading in: Langness Ch 3 & 4 (pp. 74-138); please read Urbanowicz on "Lévi-Strauss" which may be viewed by clicking here: ESSAY #14 at the end of this printed Guidebook;

PLEASE read any one of the following items from the selections on RESERVE:

Darnell: #31 (pp. 426-439).
Hayes & Hayes: Any Chapter.
Hinsley: pp. 262-292.
Kardiner & Preble: pp. 140-162 and pp. 178-186.
Kuper: Ch. 1 (pp. 13-50) or Ch. 2 (pp. 51-88).
Malefijt: Ch 10 (pp. 181-214).
Montagu Selection #30: pp. 467-486.
Naroll & Naroll: Ch 6 (pp. 185-215).
Powdermaker: Ch 2 (pp. 33-45).
Silverman: Ch. 5 (pp. 141-168).
Stocking: Ch. 6 (pp. 232-297).

BY EXAM II (Monday November 18, 2003) you should have finished reading the rest of Merryl Wyn Davies and Piero, 2002, Introducing Anthropology, pp. 60-171.

CONSIDER THE IMPLICATIONS OF THE FOLLOWING WORDS:

"Borrowing from contemporary scientific models, thinkers in the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries such as the Marquis de Condorcet [1743-1794] and August Comte [1798-1857] believed that human history was bound by laws. If these could be understood and the fruits of this research judiciusly applied, time would bring progress. Instead of the Christian emphasis on the salvation of the individual, thinkers prophesied that all humankind could partake of this new prosperity and knowledge. This shift in historical imagination can also be traced to the eighteenth and nineteenth centuries, when the agricultural and industrial revolutions made prosperity possible for the multitude instead of the select few. Applied technology revolutionized old economic traditions wherein an elite minority thrived on the labor of serfs and slaves [stress added]." Choi Chatterjee et al., 2002, The 20th Century: A Retrospective (Cambridge: Westview Press), pages 3-4.

"From Montesquieu [1689-1755] through Comte [1798-1857] to Durkheim [1858-1917] and his school, the dominant philosophical themes in French social thought were thus Progressivism and natural law. After World War II, however, Lévi-Strauss initiated the first major change of direction of French anthropological thought, retaining the belief in natural law but at least partially ignoring the Progressivism of his predecessors. His structuralism is in theory a universailist doctrine, which seeks to identify what is common to the thinking of all people everywhere [stress added]." William Y. Adams, 1998, The Philosophical Roots of Anthropology, page 375.

"The Baron de Montesquieu's [1689-1755] Persian Letters...[1721] chronicles the adventures of two fictional Persian travellers who make critical remarks on French society. That book foreshadows not only the genre of ethnography, but also reflexivity.... More importantly though, Montesquieu's Spirit of the Laws... [1748] explores the forms of government, the temperament of peoples, and the influence of climate on society, with true ethnographic examples from around the world. Central to his argument is the idea of the 'general spirit' (esprit général), which is the fundamental essence of a given culture.... While Lévi-Strauss [born 1908 -> ] once argued that Rousseau [1712-1778] was the founder of the social sciences, Radcliffe-Brown [1881-1955] gave that honour to Montesquieu; and the styles of the later structuralists and structural-functionalist taditions do owe much to the respective rationalism of Rousseau and the empiricism of Montesquieu. At the dawn of the nineteenth century the comte de Saint-Simon [1760-1825] and subsequently his pupil, August Comte [1796-1857], put forward notions which combined Montesquieu's interest in a science of society with a desire to incorporate it within a framework embracing also physics, chemistry, and biology [stress added]." Alan Barnard, 2000, History and Theory in Anthropology (Cambridge University Press), page 23.

"Durkheim [1858-1917] employed an organic analogy to understand how social groups cohere, and Marx understood control of material conditions of life to be the engine driving human history. Both theorists therefore believed that forces existing outside the individual (psychosocial on the one hand, dialectical on the other) act to condition cultural meaning and structure social relations. In neither formulation is much room left for the creative agency of individuals, and, in fact, both Durkheim and Marx are often criticized for treating the subjects of their theories as homogenous drones, mindlessly obeying the relentless forces that shape and control every facet of their existence. In contrast, and alone of these three great social theorists of the nineteenth and early twentieth centuries, German Max Weber (1864-1920) is credited with viewing active, thinking individuals as central to the creation, maintenance, and innovation of social and cultural forms [stress added]." Paul A. Erickson [with Liam D. Murphy], 1998, A History of Anthropological Theory (Ontario, Canada: Broadview Press), page 108.

Claude Lévi-Strauss (born 1908): "French anthropologist who helped to formulate the principles of structuralism by stressing the interdependence of cultural systems and the way they relate to each other. In his analyses of kinship, myth, and symbolism, Lévi-Strauss argued that, though the superficial appearance of these factors might vary between societies, their underlying structures were universal and could be best understood in terms of binary oppositions: left and right, male and female, nature and culture, the raw and the cooked, and so on" [stress added]. Sarah Jenkins Jones (Editor), 1996, Random House Webster's Dictionary of Scientists, page 299.

"Individual Creativity. Nobody writes in a vacuum. Even the most imaginative scholars have intellectual pedigrees. However, every now and again a man or a woman comes along with a message so novel as to stun the rest of us. Since the Second World War [1941-1945 for USA involvement], two anthropologists have taken the discipline by storm: Lévi-Strauss and Geertz. Their unique--even idiosyncratic--achievements push the borders of anthropology beyond what most of us thought was possible, and where few of us dare, or have the capacity to follow. In this context it may be warranted to evoke the notion of innate creative genius. Some theorizing in the generations ahead, if we are lucky, will carve out the equivalent of the structuralist analysis of myth of thick description [stress added]." Stanley R. Barrett, 1999, Forecasting Theory: Problems And Exemplars In The Twenty-First Century. In E.L. Cerroni-Long, editor, Anthropological Theory in North America, pages 255-281, page 264.

"Victor Turner [1920-1983] lived through exciting times in anthropology, and for much of his life was at its forefront. ... Turner's strategy is to approach society not only as social structure, as Radcliffe-Brown [1881-1955] or Lévi-Strauss do, but as being something more, namely the combination of the structural and the ideological [stress added]." Paul Bohannan & Mark Glazer, Editors (1988) High Points in Anthropology (NY: A.A. Knopf) pages 501-503.

"A sense of estrangement moved with Ruth Benedict [1887-1948] all her life. Although intensely sympathetic and kindly she always gave the impression of standing apart from the world she lived in. ... BENEDICT's instinct for integration and generalization prompted her from the first to take a comprehensive view of culture. ... Benedict was a severe and perceptive critic of our own culture and used, paradoxically, a strict cultural relativism as the chief argument in her criticism [stress added]." Abraham Kardiner and Edward Preble, 1961, Ruth Benedict. They Studied Man (NY: Mentor Books), pages 178-186.

"When Ruth Benedict [1887-1948] wrote about three tribal cultures in her famous book Patterns of Culture (1934), she proposed that each culture could be characterized by a single, consistent pattern and that this pattern could be labeld by a single word (Dionysian, Apollonioan, or paranoid). A decade later, when Benedict studied Japan during World War II [and eventually published, in 1946, The Chrysanthemum and The Sword: Patterns of Japanese Culture], she discovered that things were more complicated and found herself dealing with two quite different patterns: the martial code of the samurai and the aesthetics of the tea ceremony. Cornell University historian Michael Kammen, inspired by Ruth Benedict's approach to Japan, descibed Americnas as the People of Paradox [1972, People of paradox: An Inquiry Concerning the Origins of American Civilization], who founded a country on human slavery while proclaiming in their Declaration of Independence the inalienable rights of life, liberty, and the pursuite of happiness [stress added]." Karl G. Heider, 1997, Seeing Anthropology: Cultural Anthropology Through Film (Allyn and bacon), page 15.

"Visual anthropology developed most fully as an area of specialist interests and techniques within American anthropology; and, as such, it contained many of the theoretical and methodological assumptions of the American discipline more generally. Its emergence in the late 1950s and 1960s was particularly associated with Margaret Mead. ... By the early 1970s Margaret Mead had becomeone of the key figures in the new field of visual anthropology. Other important figures included John Marshall, Tim Asch, Asen Balikci, Robert Gardner and Karl Heider... [stress added]." Anna Grimshaw, 2001, The Ethnographer's Eye: Ways of Seeing in Anthropology (Cambridge University Press), pages 87-88.

"As anthropologists, anthropological filmakers must be methodologically explicit, explain their theoretical assumptions, and seek to make their films contribute to the scholarly dialogues that constitute professional anthropology. As politically and morally sensitive scholars, they must actively seek ways for the people portrayed to have an active voice in the construction of their image. The work must be returned to the people imaged, and an ongoing dialogue must ensue between image maker and those imaged [stress added]." Jay Ruby, 2000, Picturing Culture: Explorations of Film & Anthropology (University of Chicago Press), page 267.

FOR EXAMPLE: "The Yanomami have moved rapidly from the relative isolation of the rain forest to being involved in global battles to save their enrionment. When [ethnographic filmaker Timothy] Asch went back to the people he filmed twenty years ago, 'They looked at the films attentively and said that while they thought the films were quite accurate, it would be the 'kiss of death' for people to think that the Yanomami still live the way they appear to in the films. They suggested that I mkake a film about the way they live today' [stress added]." Jay Ruby, 2000, Picturing Culture: Explorations of Film & Anthropology (University of Chicago Press), page 134.

"We had a lot of explaining to do [writes Walter Goldschmidt], and one of the first was Ruth Benedict's poetic and influential Patterns of Culture (1934) that gave the sense (if not the reality) of 'explaining' cultures with designations like Apollonian, Dionysian, and (more nakedly) paranoid. Of course, Benedict did not explain anything, but she made us feel that we understood something. She made us aware of the subtleties, complexities, and the mysterious wholeness of cultures. Her close associate and friend, Margaret Mead, took the issue to the field, bringing lessons from the children of nature in the idyllic South Seas that would help us get rid of our old-fashioned moral hang-ups about sex and childhood (Mead 1928 [Coming of Age in Samoa: A Psychological Study of Primitive Youth For Western Civilization]). She belonged to the 'flapper' generation that inaugurated the first emancipation from Victorian constraints. Mead's research methods were overblown, but her impact was great both on the public and on the profession [stress added]." Walter Goldschmidt, 2000, Historical Essay: A Perspective on Anthropology. American Anthropologist, Vol. 102, No. 4, December 2000, pages 789-807, page 793.

"MARGARET MEAD. The century's foremost woman anthropologist, Margaret Mead [1901-1978] was an American icon. On dozens of field trips to study the ways of primitive [sic] societies, she found evidence to support her strong belief that cultural conditioning, not genetics, molded human behavior. That theme was struck most forcefully in Mead's 1928 classic, Coming of Age in Samoa. It described an idyllic pre-industrial society, free of sexual restraint and devoid of violence, guilt and anger. Her portrait of free-loving primitives [sic!] shocked contemporaries and inspired generations of college students--especially during the 1960s sexual revolution. But it may have been too good to be true. While few question Mead's brilliance or integrity, subsequent research showed that Samoan society is no more or less uptight than any other. It seems Mead accepted as fact tribal gossip embellished by adolescent Samoan girls happy to tell the visiting scientist what she wanted to hear [stress added]." Leon Jaroff, Time, March 29, 1999, page 183.

"Margaret Mead arrived at the American Museum of Natural History in 1926. Having just completed her first significant ethnographic research in Samoa, she was appointed assistant curator in the Department of Anthropology. ... Over the course of her fifty-two year association with the Museum, Margaret Mead was a scientist, curator, teacher, author, social activist, and media celebrity. The success of her first book, Coming of Age in Samoa, published in 1928, had thrust her into the media spotlight" [stress added]." Nancy C. Lutkehaus, 2001-2002, American Icon. Natural History, 12/01 - 1/02, pages 14 & 15, page 14.

"Any account of Mead's work on Samoa [or perhaps all of her work?] must consider the controversy surrounding its accuracy. In 1983, several years after her death, Derek Freeman published his detailed refutation of her work. More recently, Freeman has continued his attack with attempts to prove that Mead built her description of adolescent sexuality on scanty information gleaned from a hoax perpetrated by her informants. He has also argued that she was young and credulous, that she had a poor grasp of the language, that she did not carry out her investigations properly, that Coming of Age in Samoa [1928] is littered with errors, that she twisted the facts to suit her (and Boas's and Benedict's) preconceptions, and that she was entirely wrong in her portrayal of Samoa [stress added]." Hilary Lapsley, 1999, Margaret Mead And Ruth Benedict: The Kinship of Women (Amherst: U Mass Press), pages 142-143.

PLEASE NOTE FROM Anthropology News May 2000 (Vol. 41, No. 5), by Derek Freeman [1916-2001], Institute of Advanced Studies, Australian National University, Canberra, Australia:

"I write to inform members of the AAA [American Anthropological Association] of the discovery of direct evidence that brings to closure the controversy over Margaret Mead's Samoan fieldwork of 1925-26."

"This evidence is contained in a little known book, All True! The Record of Actual Adventures That Have Happened to Ten Women Today (1931). The adventure by 'Dr. Margaret Mead,' entitled, 'Life as a Samoan Girl.' begins with reference to the 'group of reverend scientists' who in 1925 sent her to study 'the problem of which phenomena of adolescence are culturally and which physiologically determined' among the adolescent girls of Samoa, with 'no very clear idea' of how she was 'to do this.' It ends with an account of her journey to the islands of Ofu and Olosega in March 1926 with the 'two Samoan girls,' as she calls Fa'apua'a and Fofoa. Mead continues, 'In all things I had behaved as a Samoan, for only so, only by losing my identity, as far as possible, had I been able to become acquainted with the Samoan girls, receive their whispered confidences and learn at the same time the answer to the scientists' questions.'"

"This account by Mead herself, is fully confirmed by sworn testimony of Fa'apua'a. It is definitive historical evidence that establishes that martin Orans is in outright error in asserting that it is 'demonstrably false that Mead was taken in by Fa'apua'a and Fofoa.' It is also evidence that establishes that Coming of Age in Samoa [1929], far from being a 'scientific classic' is a work of anthropological fiction."

"In Chapter 13 of Coming of Age in Samoa, Mead concluded unreservedly that the phenomena of adolescence are due not to physiology but to the 'social environment.' This extreme environmentalist conclusion was very much to the liking of Franz Boas [1858-1942]. In 1934, in the Encyclopedia of the Social Sciences, Boas asserted that 'the genetic elements which may determine personality,' are 'altogether irrelevant as sompared with the powerful influence of the cultural environment' (emphasis added). This is a succinct statement of the Boasian culturalism that from the late 1920s became, in the words of George Stocking, 'fundamental to all American Social Science.'"

"In Samoa, Mead had acted as Boas' agent and, having been given Boas' enthusiastic commendation, Coming of Age in Samoa became one of the most influential texts of the 20th century. We now know that the conclusion to which Mead came is based on evidence that is quite unacceptable scientifically. Furthermore, this also applies to Boasian culturalism, which at the beginning of the 21st century has beccome a scientifically unacceptable belief system."

"This liberating change in the Zeitgeist is evident in the fact that the intercollegiate Studies Institute, in listing the 50 worst and best books of the century, has adjudged Mead's Coming of Age in Samoa to be the 'very worst' book of the 20th century."

"Indeed, Margaret Mead has been criticized, most notably by the Australian anthropologist Derek Freeman [1916-2001], for minimizing the biological aspects of childrearing. According to Freeman, Mead was so eager to demonstrate the definitive role of culture in human society that she was insensitive to fundamental human drives and motives, while overly accepting accounts that suggested the singularity of a culture. From today's vantage point, we might conclude that Mead was attempting to demonstrate the importance of cultural factors to a biologically oriented social science community, while Freeman was reacting to a cultural concensis that Mead and her colleagues had succeeded in establishing at mid-century [stress added]." Howard Gardner, 2001, Introduction to the Perrenial Classics Edition. Growing Up in New Guinea, 1930 (by Margaret Mead), page xxi.

"Karl Popper (1902-1994) is recognized around the world as one of the twentieth century's greatest philosophers of science and as one of its most articulate and influential critics of Marxism and closed society. ... Popper used to tell his students that there is no such things as a scientific method other than the method of trial and error. This simple idea has initiated a revolutionary way of thnking in philosophy and science. Popper thought that we are ll in search of a better world. And hge taught that, instead of uncritically accepting our theories and beliefs on authority or trying to justify them with appeals to reason and experience, we should search for problems and inconsistncies in them and try to eliminate them as best we can. Instead of trying to prove that we are right, we should try to find the ways in which we are wrong. He summed up his entire philosophy with the words: 'I may be wrong and you may be right, and by an effort, we may get nearer to the truth' [stress added - italics in original]. Mark Notturno, 2003, from the "Preface" On Popper (Thomson/Wadsworth), n.p.

"When she gave birth to her child [Mary Catherine Bateson in 1939], anthropologist Margaret Mead insisted on having the delivery filmed. ... The child to whom Mead gave birth on film was hard won. The professor started her life hoping to have six children, but had only miscarriages instead, and plenty of them. ... Margaret mead died a grandmother, when cancer took her in November 1978 in New York.... [in Mead's will, for specifics she wrote:] I therefore request them to consult my fried, Dr. Rhoda Metraux, and my daughter.... Rhoda Metraux [born 1914] was more than just a friend. Mead had shared an apartment with her on Manhattan's Central Park West in her final years. They collaborated on the Redbook column, which offered advice, information, and common sense to millions of American women about family life. mead gave away quite a bit of money during her lifetime to establish grants and scholarships in anthropology [stress added]." Stephen M. Silverman, 1991, Where There's A Will: Who Shared What and Why (NY: Harper Collins), pages 116-120.

"If the history of anthropology were to be made into a television miniseries, one of its 'great moments' would surely be set on the Sepik River [New Guinea] early in 1933. Reo Fortune [1903-1979] and his wife, Margaret Mead [1901-1978], 'starved for theoretical relevance' after two long bouts of fieldwork among the Arapesh and the Mundugumor, were just beginning their work among the Tchambuli; Gregory Bateson [1904-1980], Mead's husband-to-be, was 'floundering methodologically' after months among the Iatmul.... 'Cooped up together in the tiny eight-foot-by-eight-foot mosquito room, we moved back and forth between analyzing ourselves and each other, as individuals, and the cultures that we knew as anthropologists'--seeing a 'new formulation of the relationship between sex and temperament' [wrote Mead]....During long hours of intense conversation--in which Bateson and Mead began the dialogue of their 'a,or intellectualis'--they worked out several typologies of temperament.... [stress added]." George W. Stocking, Jr. [Editor], 1986, Malinowski, Rivers, Benedict And Others: Essays on Culture and Personality (University of Wisconsin Press), page 3.

Interesting (And Somewhat Appropriate) Web Sites Are:

http://www.barnard.edu/sfonline/mead/ [Margaret Mead's Legacy: Continuing Controversies]
http://www.mead2001.org [Margaret Mead Web Site]
http://www.wic.org/bio/mmead.htm [Margaret Mead]
http://www.loc.gov/exhibits/mead/ [Margaret Mead Exhibit at the Library of Congress]
http://womenshistory.about.com/library/bio/blbio_margaret_mead.htm [Margaret Mead Site]
http://www.ssc.uwo.ca/sociology/mead/ [Mead/Boas Correspondence} 1925/1926]
http://cpnss.lse.ac.uk/darwin/evo/freeman.htm [Derek Freeman]
http://www.usc.edu/dept/elab/welcome/ [E-Lab} Ethnographics Laboratory, University of Southern California]
http://www.aau.dk/~etnojens/etnogrp/anitaslist.html [A. Cohen-Williams' List Anthro/Arch WWW Sites]
http://eddie.cso.uiuc.edu/Durkheim/ [Durkheim Home Page]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/klmno/levi-strauss_claude.html [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.press.jhu.edu/books/hopkins_guide_to_literary_theory/claude_levi-strauss.html [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.wikipedia.org/wiki/Claude_Levi-Strauss [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://varenne.tc.columbia.edu/bib/auth/levstcld0.html [Selection of Works of Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.anthrobase.com/Dic/eng/pers/levi-strauss_claude.htm [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.change.freeuk.com/learning/socthink/levistrauss.html [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.factmonster.com/ce6/people/A0829580.html [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.encyclopedia.com/html/L/LeviS1tra.asp [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.1upinfo.com/encyclopedia/L/LeviStra.html [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.marxists.org/glossary/people/l/e.htm [Claude Lévi-Strauss and other individuals beginning with "L"]
http://varenne2.tc.columbia.edu/www/Class/bib/levstcld0_bib.html [Lévi-Strauss]


WEEK 9. October 20 & 22, 2003: Mon & Wed} Neo-Evolution, Cultural Ecology, & Modernism; for NEXT WEEK: 1/2 the class to be assigned for Monday October 27, 2003 and 1/2 for Wednesday October 29, 2003, and DISCUSSION OF YOUR INDIVIDUAL RESEARCH TOPICS. [What day you are assigned to will be distributed on October 22, 2003.]

NOTE: No new required Reading in Langness but please read the FINAL Urbanowicz essays on "Evolution of Technological Civilizations...." and "The Galápagos...." which may be viewed by clicking here: ESSAY #15 & ESSAY #16 at the end of this printed Guidebook.

PLEASE read any one of the following items from the selections on RESERVE:

Hinsley: pp. 81-123.
Harris: Ch 22 (pp. 634-653) or Ch. 23 (pp. 654-687).
Honigman: Ch 5 (pp. 179-239).
Marcus & Fischer : Ch 2 (pp. 17-44).
Montagu Selection #35: pp. 539-565.
Naroll & Naroll: Ch 8 (pp. 247-279).
Silverman: Ch. 6 (pp. 171-206) or Ch. 7 (pp. 209-252).
Stocking: pp. 437-441.
Voget: Ch. 17 (pp. 676-696).

CONSIDER THE IMPLICATIONS OF THE FOLLOWING WORDS:

"My working hypothesis is elementary, even obvious: Intellectual paradigms, including anthropological traditions, are culturally mediated, that is, they are contextually situated and relative. The inference I draw is also elementary and obvious: If anthropological activity is culturally mediated, it is in turn subject to ethnographic description and ethnological analysis [stress added]." Bob Scholte, 1972, Toward a Reflexive and Critical Anthropology. IN Dell Hymes [Editor],1972, Reinventing Anthropology, pages 430-457, page 431.

"Since 1969, the place of history of anthropology within the discipline has changed substantially. The postmodernist turn to reflexivity in the humanities and social sciences has made practising anthropologists more conscious of their own standpoint(s) and the groundedness of present practices in past histories. History itself has come to be seen as contingent, relative to a standpoint, interpretation rather than a direct representation of the past [stress added]." Regna Darnell, 1998, And Along Came Boas: Continuity And Revolution In Americanist Anthropology (Philadelphia: John Benjamins Publishing Co.), page xiv.

PLEASE NOTE THE WORDS OF DEREK FREEMAN (1916-2001): "My passion in life is that we will develop a genuine science of the human species; nothing is more important to humans than that we succeed in that task. Now, I have said that the question that Boas [1858-1942] gave Margaret Mead [1901-1978] to answer was a profoundly important anthropological question and I think that now in the late 1980s we have resolved that problem. It is apparent to all knowledgeable behavioral scientists that we must within operate within a framework in which we simultaneously take into account our evolutionary history and our cultures and it is only when these two things are combined within an interactionist paradigm that you have the imperative pre-condition for a genuine science of our species. Well, I have always been a heretic. I think being a heretic is the most beautiful thing because this comes from a Greek root meaning someone who chooses for himself. In other words, a heretic is someone who thinks for himself and doesn't run with the mob and I have always been a heretic and found great joy in it. But what you've got to be in science is a heretic who gets its right. It's no use in being a heretic who gets it wrong because then you are a dog in their eyes. But if you are a heretic who gets it right, you can't do better than that [stress added]." Derek Freeman, 1988, [from the video] Margaret Mead and Samoa (Evanston, Ill: United Learning) [Cinetal productions Ltd. in Association with the Australian Broadcasting Corporation].

"Karl Popper (1902-1994) is recognized around the world as one of the twentieth century's greatest philosophers of science and as one of its most articulate and influential critics of Marxism and closed society. ... Popper used to tell his students that there is no such things as a scientific method other than the method of trial and error. This simple idea has initiated a revolutionary way of thnking in philosophy and science. Popper thought that we are all in search of a better world. And he taught that, instead of uncritically accepting our theories and beliefs on authority or trying to justify them with appeals to reason and experience, we should search for problems and inconsistncies in them and try to eliminate them as best we can. Instead of trying to prove that we are right, we should try to find the ways in which we are wrong. He summed up his entire philosophy with the words: 'I may be wrong and you may be right, and by an effort, we may get nearer to the truth' [stress added - italics in original]. Mark Notturno, 2003, from the "Preface" On Popper (Thomson/Wadsworth), n.p.

"Scientific inquiry is problem solving, and our knowledge grows as we propose theories to explain what we do not understand, and then criticize them in an attempt to eliminate their errors. Our understanding of ourselves and of the world we live in, like life itself, is constantly changing [stress added]." Mark Notturno, 2003, On Popper (Thomson/Wadsworth), page 70.

"...we can learn from our mistakes [stress added]." Karl R. Popper [1902-1994], 1963, Conjectures And Refutations: The Growth of Scientific Knowledge (NY: Harper & Row), page vii.

"In the first decades of the 20th century, nature held sway over nurture in most fields. In the wake of World War I [1914-1918], however, three men recaptured the social sciences for nurture: John B. Watson [1878-1958], who set out to show how the conditioned reflex, discovered by Ivan Pavlov [1849-1936], could explain human learning; Sigmund Freud [1856-1939], who sought to explain the influence of parents and early experiences on young minds,; and Franz Boas [1858-1942], who argued that the origin of ethnic differences lay with history, experiences and circumstance, not physiology and psychology [stress added]." Matt Ridley, 2003, What Makes You Who You Are. Time, June 2, 2003, pages 54-63, pages 58-59.

"The three dominant themes on behavior for a good part of the [20th] century were Freudianism, which said aberrant behavior was produced by the childhood environment; Boasism, which said behavior was produced by the cultural environment; and behaviorism, which said behavior resulted from environmental conditioning and learning. All were united in enthroning the environment as the determinant of human behavior and in relegating biological inheritance to insignificance. This three-pronged environmentalism was the accepted wisdom that was taught in all universities and that informed serious writing on human behavior--social problems, psychological problems, mental illness--or normal child development. Professor [Henry] Higgins may have run amok, but he had also taken over--and remained in control until only recently [stress added]." William Wright, 1998, Born That Way: Genes, Behavior, Personality (NY: Knopf), page 170.

"Ralph Linton, who was born in 1893 and died in 1953, was one of the most distinguished anthropologists of his time. His career in anthropology covered a period during which this discipline underwent a dramatic transition; and Linton contributed fundamentally to its change. It might also be said that it was Linton and several of his contemporaries, Robert Redfield [1897-1958], Melville Herskovits [1895-1963], Lloyd Warner [1898-1970], Ruth Benedict [1887-1948], and Margaret Mead [1901-1978], who brought anthropology in the United States out of the museums and into the mainstream of the social sciences [stress added]." Adelin Linton and Charles Wagley, 1971, Ralph Linton (Columbia University Press), page 1.

"In 1937 Ralph Linton [1893-1953] was invited to Columbia University [New York City] as a visiting Professor of Anthropology.... It was more or less understood that, if mutually agreeable, Ralph Linton would be Senior professor and Department Chairman. Linton's first months at Columbia University were difficult ones. When he went to pay his respects of Boas [1858-1942] the old man's greeting was, 'Of course, you know this was not what I wanted.' ... Ruth Benedict [1887-1948] was then an Assistant Professor without tenure and was that year acting Chairman of the Department. ... Benedict was cool and unreceptive to Linton as a colleague. It was rumored that Benedict was Boas's own choice for successor. Without tenure and as a woman (there were no woman in the graduate faculties at Columbia at that time), she undoubtedly felt challenged by Linton's appointment [stress added]." Adelin Linton and Charles Wagley, 1971, Ralph Linton (Columbia University Press), pages 48-49.

"Geertz's [born 1926 ->] alternative to substantive, middle-range theory is 'thick description,' an elaborate account of the many meanings involved in any specific human activity in any particular time and place. So, for Geertz, there is heuristic theory as a ghuide and thick description, with no substantive theory in between [stress added]." Philip Carl Salzman and Patricia C. Rice, 2004, Thinking Anthropologically: A Practical Guide For Students (NJ: Pearson/Prentice-Hall), page 34.

"Clifford Geertz has a vividly original mind--one can never tell just which wall he will bounce off next. Born in San Francisco in 1926.... It is more difficult to summarize Clifford Geertz's contribution to anthropology theory than it is to summarize that of other authors. Geertz does not provide us with key terms or even with direct ties to other anthropological traditions. Neither does he furnish us with fixed methods of doing ethnography or thinking about anthropology. However, his contributions to anthropological thought are as fundamental as they are subtle. Geertz wants us to understand a culture in its own terms. To do that, we must understand its complexities, subtleties, and nuances. Reading Geertz suggests archaeology: a culture is exposed and explicated layer by layer until a mental image of it appears to the reader. ... Geertz's idea of culture is not an eclectic one: he holds a semiotic view. He believes, with Max Weber and Durkheim, that a human being is suspended in a web of significances that he [and she!] has himself created. Geertz's is a search for meaning, for explication--indeed, literary explanation--and not for laws of experimental science. Interpretation is the name of the tool he uses to accomplish this goal of excavating for meaning [stress added]." Paul Bohannan & Mark Glazer, Editors (1988) High Points in Anthropology (NY: A.A. Knopf) pages 529-530.

IN 2002 CLIFFORD GEERTZ (1926->) wrote the following: "I have arrived, it seems, at that point in my life and my career when what people most want to hear from me is not some new fact or idea, but how I got to this point in my life and career. ... So far as phases, periods, era, and the like are concerned, I shall, for my own convenience, mark out four of them. None of them is internally homogeneous, none of them is sharply bounded; but they can serve as useful place-markers in a lurching, tangled, digressive history. The first, roughly between 1946 and 1960--all dates are moveable--was a period of after-the-war exuberance, when a wave of optimism, ambition, and a sense of improving purpose swept through the human sciences. The second, about 1960 to about the miod-1970s, was dominated, on the one hand, by the divisions of the universal cold war, and, on the other, by the romances and disappointments of Third-Worldism. From 1975 or so to, shall we say, in honor of the fall of The Wall, 1989, there was, first, a proliferation of new, or anyway newfangled, approaches to social and cultural analysis, various sorts of theoretical and methodological 'turns,' Kehre, tournures d'esprit; and then on the heels of these, the rise of radically critical and dispersie 'post-' movements, brought on by increasing uncertainty, self-doubt, and self-examination, both within anthropology and in Western culture generally. Finally, from the 1990s until now, interest has begun to shift toward ethnic conflict, violence, world-disorder, globalization, transnationalism, human rights, and the like, although where that is going, especially after September 11, is far from clear. These again, are not the only cuts that could be made, nor even the best. They are but the reflections, diffuse and refracted, in my own mind of the way of the world and the ways of anthropology within the way of the world [stress added]." Clifford Geertz, 2002, An Inconstant Profession: The Anthropological Life in Interesting Times. Annual Review of Anthropology (edited by William H, Durkham) [Palo Alto, CA: Annual Reviews], Vol. 31, pages 1-19, pages 1-3.

"The ability of anthropologists to get us to take what they say seriously has less to do with either a factual look or an air of conceptual elegance than it has to do with their capacity to convince us what they say is a result of their having actually penetrated (or, if you prefer, been penetrated by) another form of life, one way or another, truly 'being there.' And that, persuading us that this offstage miracle has occurred, is where the writing comes in [stress added]." Clifford Geertz, 1988, Works And Lives: The Anthropologist As Author

"One of the most celebrated pieces of fictitious ethnography ever written is J. G. Frazer's [1854-1951] account of the Priest-King of Nemi awaiting his execution by his as yet unknown successor. It comes in the first chapter of The Golden Bough but its immense verbosity, even in the abridged edition, makes it unquotable. I refer to it now only because the status of Clifford Geertz as Priest-King of American Cultural Anthropology seems to me to be rather similar [stress added]." Edmund Leach, 1989, "Review" of Works And Lives: The Anthropologist As Author (by Clifford Geertz). american ethnologist: The Journal of the American Ethnological Society, Vol. 16, No. 1, pages 137-141, page 137.

"Modernism is a term drawn from the study of literature and art. Applied to anthropology, it broadly refers to the years between the 1920s and the mid-1970s.... Analysts suggest that that some of the attributes of modernist writing in anthropology were detachment, the assumption of a position of scientific neutrality, and rationalism. ... Postmodernists challenge these assertions. They maintain that such claims are distorted or, at best, true in only a very limited sense. They believe that objective, neutral knowledge of another culture (or any aspect of the world) is impossible. The postmodernist challenge has led anthropologists to examine the basis of their discipline and engage in an rancorous debate bteween the two points of view [stress added]." Post-modernism has been one of the most controversial developments in anthropology...." R.J. McGee & R.L. Warms , 2002, Anthropological Theory: An Introductory History (Second Edition) (Mountain View, CA: Mayfield Publishing Co.), page 517.

"Some anthropologists complain that the use of the term modernism is simply a valorization of aesthetics over social science, and in a sense that objection is undeniable. However, so symbiotic has the relationship become between artistic theory and anthropology that a focus upon modernism can no longer be seen as the privileging of literature, say, over social science [stress added]." Marc Manganaro, 1990, Textual Play, Power, and Cultural Critique: An Orientation To Modernist Anthropology. Modernist Anthropology: From Fieldwork to Text, 1990 (edited by Marc Manganaro), page 5.

"If there is one word which summarizes the anthropological recognition of a postmodern mood, it is irony. And the current rediscovery of irony indicates all the differences between the 'free play' which some descriptions of postmodernism hint at and postmodernist 'play,' if it exists, in anthropological writings. Irony involves not a scrambling but a deliberate juxtaposition of contexts, pastiche perhaps but not jumble [stress added]." Marilyn Stratherhn, 1990, Out Of Context: The Persuasive Fictions Of Anthropology. Modernist Anthropology: From Fieldwork to Text, 1990 (edited by Marc Manganaro), page 113.

"What makes Strathern's reading work is what we might call a couble chiasmus, signified by the double juxtaposition Frazer/Malinowski and Malinowski/Frazer. If we were formalists, we might write <F x M> x <M x F>. Or, more hieroglyphically, perhaps...." Stephen A. Tyler and George E. Marcus, 1990, Modernist Anthropology: From Fieldwork to Text, 1990 (edited by Marc Manganaro), page 125.

"I take irony to be the central trope of modernism. But just as modernism is no monolith--as Marc Manganaro properly notes in his Introduction, there are many modernisms to consider--neither is irony; there are many ironies to consider, as well. Among ironic figures, let me name four: antiphrasis or negation, aporia or doubt, oxymoron or paradox, and catachresis or misuse [stress added]." Arnold Krupat, 1990, Irony In Anthropology: The Work Of Franz Boas. Modernist Anthropology: From Fieldwork to Text, 1990 (edited by Marc Manganaro), page 136.

"A recent volume by James Clifford and George Marcus [Writing Culture: The Poetics And Politics Of Ethnography, 1986] highlights cultural anthropology's attempt 'to come to terms with the politics and poetics of cultural representation' (1986, viii). Concerned with the ideology underlying 'transparent' representation and armed with the post-paradigmatic suspicions of imposing a unit on their own texts, Clifford nevertheless remarks that the essays that follow his introduction find a common ground in the Foucaltian position outlined above. They share the 'new space opened up by the disintegration of 'Man' as telos for a whole new discipline,' drawing instead on recent developments in the fields of textual criticism, cultural history, semiotics, hermeneutic philosophy, and psychoanalysis' (1986, 4)." (Robert Sullivan, 1990, Marxism And The 'Subject Of Anthropology. Modernist Anthropology: From Fieldwork to Text, 1990 (edited by Marc Manganaro), page 244.

"Postmodern theory crystalized in anthropology in the mid-1980s with, among other works by Clifford and Marcus (1986) [Writing Culture: The Poetics and Politics of Ethnography] and Clifford (1988), Anthropology as Cultural Critique, subtitled An Experimental Moment in the Human Sciences, by George Marcus and Michael Fischer (1986). The authors draw on influential nonanthropological works on postmodernism, such as Jean-Francois Lyotard's The Postmodern Condition: A Report on Knowledge ([1979] 1984), on Geertz's interpretative anthropology, and on Marxist anthropology, a paradigm based on subjectivist epistemology and moral advocacy (or, as Marcus and Fischer prefer, 'cultural critique')." Philip C. Salzman, 2001, Understanding Culture: An Introduction to Anthropological Theory (Prospect Heights, Illinois: Waveland Press), page 121

"Partly under the influence of Geertz [born 1926 ->] and interpretive anthropology, a more recent heuristic theory, postmodernism (Marcus and Fischer 1986 [Editors, Anthropology and Cultural Critique: An Experimental Moment in the Human Sciences]; Clifford and Marcus 1986 [Editors, Writing Culture: The Poetics and Politics of Ethnography]; Marcus 1998 [Ethnography Through Thick and Thin]), rejects a scientific approach and all empiricism and positivism in anthropology as false and politically suspect, and rejects any 'master narrative' as one sided. Postmodernism stresses the subjectivity of the researcher and the injustice in treating the subjects of research, the people being studied, as objects. Rejecting any formulation of scientific, substantive, middle range theories, postmodernism has stressed giving 'voice' to the subjects of research so that they can tell theor own stories rather than have our theories or interpretations imposed on them. So postmodernism too goes directly from heuristic theory to 'voice,' with no intermediate theoretical forumulation [stress added]." Philip Carl Salzman and Patricia C. Rice, 2004, Thinking Anthropologically: A Practical Guide For Students (NJ: Pearson/Prentice-Hall), page 34.

"Postmodernism (Pomo) is an intellectual movement or orientation that promotes itself as the antithesis of modernism. The term itself was introduced by architects in the late 1940s. Of the many intellectual strands that run through postmodernism, the most prominent and important is the disparagement of Western science and technology." Marvin Harris, 1999, Theories of Culture in Postmodern Times, page 153.

"Postmodernism constitutes a critique of all 'modern' understandings. postmodernists define what is 'modernist' as what is all-encompassing; they reject both grand theory in anthropology and the notion of completeness in ethnographic description [stress added]." Alan Barnard, 2000, History and Theory in Anthropology (Cambridge University Press), page 168.

"The central argument of this book is that throughout their history humans used symbols to create webs that communicated agreed-upon meanings and so, as time went by, sustained cooperations and conflict among larger and larger groups of people [stress adeded]." William H. McNeill, in J.R. McNeill & William H. McNeill, 2003, The Human Web: A Bird's-Eye View of World History (NY: W.W. Norton & Co.), page 323.

"The essence and raison d'être of communication is the creation of redundancy, meaning, pattern, predictability, information, and/or the reduction of the random by 'restraint [stress added].'" Gregory Bateson [1904-1980], 1972, Steps To An Ecology of Mind (NY: Ballantine Books), page 133.

Interesting (And Somewhat Appropriate) Web Sites Are:

http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/fghij/herskovits_melville.html [Melville Herskovits]
http://www.library.northwestern.edu/africana/herskovits.html [Melville Herskovits]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/klmno/linton_ralph.html [Ralph Linton
http://www.si.edu/resource/faq/nmnh/start.htm#anthro[Anthropology "button"]
http://www.wsu.edu:8001/vcwsu/commons/topics/culture/culture-index.html [Culture]
http://ash.lab.r1.fws.gov [Forensic Science]
http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/ABFA/ [Located in the Department of Anthropology at CSU, Chico]
http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/information/biography/pqrst/snow_clyde.html [Clyde Snow} 1928->]
http://www.anthro.ufl.edu/c.a.poundlab/maples.htm [William R. Maples} 1937-1997]
http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/information/biography/fghij/geertz_clifford.html [Clifford Geertz} 1923->]
http://www.iwp.uni-linz.ac.at/lxe/sektktf/GG/HyperGeertz.html [HyperGeertz World Catalogue]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/fghij/geertz_clifford.html [Clifford Geertz]
http://eserver.org/theory/anthropology.html [Paul Smith} Writing, General Knowledge, and Postmodern Anthropology]


WEEK 10. October 27 & 29, 2003: Mon & Wed} DISCUSSION OF YOUR INDIVIDUAL TERM PAPER interests [approximately 1/2-the-class on each day).

NOTE: No new required Reading in Langness and no more required Reading in Urbanowicz.

 

"When you ferret out something for yourself, piecing the clues together unaided, it remains for the rest of your life in some way truer than facts you are merely taught, and freer from onslaughts of doubt." Colin Fletcher, 1968, The Man Who Walked Through Time, p. 109.

"Whatever you cannot understand, you cannot possess." J. W. Von Goethe [1749-1832].

"Keep away from people who belittle your ambitions. Small people always do that, but the really great make you feel that you, too, can become great." (Mark Twain [Samuel Langhorne Clemens, 1835-1910])

"Let every man [or woman!] judge by himself [or herself!!], by what he himself read, not by what others tell him [or her!!!]." Albert Einstein [1879-1955], 1934 statement.

"Contrary to popular belief, messiness is not necessarily a sign of mental disorganization. ... A clue to the nature of messiness may lie in the fact that many messy people are unconcerned or unaware of the seeming chaos of their local environment. Perhaps messiness and neatness are just markers of a person's spatial awareness and orientation [stress added]." Richard Friedman, 2003, Forget Oscar and Felix: Messiness Is no Laughing Matter. The New York Times, April 29, 2003, page D5.

"No matter how much I admire our schools, I know that no university exists that can provide an education; what a university can provide is an outline, to give the learner a direction and guidance. The rest one has to do for oneself." Louis L'Amour, 1989, The Education Of A Wandering Man, page 3.


WEEK 11. November 3 & 5, 2003: Mon & Wed} Symbolism, Modernism, Reflexivity, & Post-Modernism. Term Paper Presentation Order Distributed on November 5, 2003.

Required Reading in: Langness: Ch 5, 6, & 7 (pp. 139-217).

PLEASE read any one of the following items from the selections on RESERVE:

Barrett (1999): In E.L. Cerroni-Long, pp. 255-281 (Conclusions).
Clifford & Marcus (1986): pp. 1-26.
Daniel & Peck (1996): pp. 1-33.
Darnell: #25 (pp. 322-329).
di Leonardo: pp. 1-48.
Fox (1994): Ch. 17 (pp. 341-349) and Ch. 20 (pp. 363-380).
Fox (1997): pp. 13-15 and pp. 161-199.
Geertz (1995): Ch. 5 (pp. 96-135).
Hakken (1999): Ch. 7 (pp. 179-211)
Harris (1968): Ch. 20: pp. 568-604.
Harris (1999): Ch. 1 [pp. 19-29] and Ch. 153-160.
Honigman: Ch 6 (pp. 241-288) or Ch. 13 (pp. 579-612).
Hays: Ch 36, 37, and 38 (pp. 390-427).
Kuper: Ch 7 (pp. 204-226).
Malefijt: Ch 14 (pp. 325-347).
Marcus: Ch. 2 (pp. 57-78) or Ch. 10 (pp. 231-253).
Moore: pp. 228-247.
Naroll & Naroll: Ch 7 (pp. 217-245).
Voget: Ch 20 (pp. 786-805). 

CONSIDER THE IMPLICATIONS OF THE FOLLOWING WORDS:

"At the beginning of the twentieth century, the climate of social opinion in British anthropology began to change. Emblematic of this change was the rise of the 'diffusionist' school, whose most prominent members were G. Elliot Smith [1871-1937], W.J. Perry [1889-1949], W.H.R. Rivers [1864-1922], and A.M. Hocart [1884-1939], whose theoretical loyalties lay with the diffusionists more than with any other school. The conspicuously lunatice aspects of diffusionism, and the disrepute into which it fell in the 1930s, should not blind us to the school's earlier importance [stress added]." Henrika Kuklick, Tribal Exemplars: images of Political Authority in British Anthropology, 1885-1945. In} Functionalism Historicized: Essays on British Social Anthropology [Edited by George W. Stocking, Jr.] (University of Wisconsin Press), pages 59-82, page 66.

"The study of human social life has come along way since Walter Baldwin Spencer [1860-1929] searched for the origins of his own society among the Australian aborigines. Anthropology nowadays doesn't waste time on speculative theories about how societies evolved but following Spencer's example it does it does at least at least go out into the field for its own facts. Franz Boas [1858-1942] in America emphasized that good anthropology depended on systematically collecting every aspect of a culture and understanding it through its own language. However, anthropology hasn't become the science that William Rivers [1864-1922] anticipated but because of his attention to method it took a more scientific approach to analyzing cultural life in the field. With Bronislaw Malinowski [1884-1942] fieldwork became a process of total saturation, immersion in the culture being studied and produced masterpieces of anthropological description. Margaret Mead [1901-1978] recognized that the topics anthropologists investigated had great popular appeal and her writings gave it a relevance for a much wider public. By turning anthropology away from the search for universal laws of human behavior, Edward Evans-Pritchard [1902-1973] changed its direction. He emphasized that the anthropologist must was to be seen as an interpreter rather than a scientist and the task was the translation of culture. One of the main ambitions of this series [and the ANTH 296 course!] has been to show how our understanding of other societies, and incidentally of our own, has improved over the past hundred or so years. This deeper insight has obviously not been reached by people just sitting around and exchanging ideas; rather it's been gained by anthropologists going to live in remote societies, often in extreme hardships, but coming back with a special kind of evidence; facts which they gathered firsthand for themselves [stress added]." Bruce Dakowski, 1985, [from the video]Stranger Abroad: Edward Evans-Evans Pritchard (1902-1973).

"Like many social anthropologists of my generation, I was from an early stage given to understand that psychology was taboo. Between 1940 and 1970, a firmly anti-psychological approach characterised mainstream British anthropology. This was the more remarkable because from the 1920s cultural anthropology in the USA had moved in the opposite direction, embracing a developmental psychology of Freudian inspiration. The British, however, would have nothing to do with the 'culture and personality' school associated with Mead [1901-1978], Benedict [1887-1948], Kardiner [1891-1981], Linton [1893-1953] and the Whitings [John} 1908-1999] & Beatrice - died in 2003]. Nor were they interested in the alternatives on offer, As Evans-Pritchard [1902-1973] explained, with lordly certainly: 'Psychology and social anthropology study different kinds of phenomena and what the one studies cannot therefore be understood in terms of conclusions reached by the other. Psychology is the study of individual life. Social anthropology is the study of social life. Psychology studies psychical systems. Social anthropology studies social systems. The psychologist and social anthropologist may observe the same acts of raw behavior but they study them at different levels of abstraction' [stress added]." A. Kuper, 1999, Among the Anthropologists, page 79.

"But while I think that different social anthropologists who studied the same people would record much the same facts in their notebooks, I believe they would write different kinds of books. Within the limits imposed by their discipline and the culture under investigation anthropologists are guided in choice of theme, in selection and arrangement of facts to illustrate them, and in judgement of what is and what is not significant, by their different interests, reflecting differences of personality, of education, of social status, of political views, of religious convictions, and so forth. One can only interpret what one sees in terms of what one is, and anthropologists, while they have a body of knowledge in common, differ in other respects as widely as other people in their backgrounds of experience and in themselves. The personality of an anthropologist cannot be eliminated from his [or her!] work any more than the personality of an historian can be eliminated from his. Fundamentally, in his account of a primitive people the anthropologist is not only describing their social life as accurately as he can but is expressing himself also. In this sense his account must express moral judgement, especially where it touches matters on which he feels strongly; and what comes out of a study will to this extent at least depend on what the individual brings to it [stress added]." Sir Edward Evans-Pritchard [1902-1973], Fieldwork and the empirical tradition. Social Anthropology and Other Essays (1962), pages 64-85, pages 83-84.

"And so for anthropology, you are studying not just as an observer but also as a participant; you are not just a member of the audience, you are also on the stage. To understand the Nuer, you've got to learn to think as the Nuer, to feel as a Nuer, in a kind of way to be a Nuer. And this can't be done in any kind of scientific technique; and this is why the anthropologist I think is in a very peculiar position because he's trying to interpret what he sees not just with the head but with his own personality, with his heart as well." Sir Edward Evans-Pritchard [1902-1973].

"[Edmund] Leach [1910-1989] did not dispute with Evans-Pritchard [1902-1973], and they seem to have kept their distance. Though there was a similarity of class origins, there were matters that separated them. Their life-styles were different: Evans-Pritchard had converted to Catholcism and sought solace in the Church, while Leach was not enamoured of particvipating in institutionalized Christianity. But even more importantly Evans-Pritchard, who had earlier been a member of Malinowski's [1884-1942] seminar, in time became estranged from him and critical of his work, and joined up with Radcliffe-Brown [1881-1955] at Oxford. Jack Goody [1919 ->] in his [1995] Expansive Moment [the rise of social anthropology in Britain and Africa, 1918-1970] conveys the problematic dimensions of Evans-Pritchard's persona in his negative attitudes not only to those loyal to Malinowski, but also towards most of his peers as well. These attitudes were conveyed in his personal letters.... [stress added]." Stanley J. Tambiah, 2002, Edmund Leach: An Anthropological Life (Cambridge), page 73.

AND SEE: http://www.alanmacfarlane.com/ancestors/ [Anthropological and Other Ancestors} Quick-Time Video on the WWW]

One Never Knows Where Information Can Come From: "Julia Child became a household name when she entered the lives of millions of Americans through our hearts and kitchens. Yet few know the richly varied private life that lies behind this icon whose statuesque height and warmly enthused warble have become synonymous with the art of cooking. In this biograph, we meet the earthly and outrageous Julia, who at age eighty-five, remains a complex rols model. Fitch, who had access to all of Julia's private letters and diaries, takes us through her life from her exuberant youth as a high-spirited California girl to he years at Smith College, where Julia was at the center of every prank and party. When most of her girlfriends married, Julia volunteered with the OSS in India and China during World War II, and was an integral part of this elite corps. There she met her future husband, the cosmopolitan Paul Chil, who introduced her to the glories of art, fine French cuisine, and love. Theirs was a deeply passionate romance and a modern marriage of equals." [no page #] ... On the one side is her close relationship with many gays, including Cora DuBois [1903-1969]...[stress added]." Noël Riley Fitch, 1997, Appetite For life: The Biography of Julia Child (NY: Doubleday), page 472.

"Just as in dress, any attempt to make oneself conspicuous by adopting some peculiar and unusual fashion is the sign of a small mind, so in language, the quest for new-fangled phrases and little-known words springs from a puerile and pedantic pretension [stress added]." Michel Eyquem de Montaigne [1533-1592] French philosopher/essayist, Essays, translated by J.M. Cohen, 1958, page 80.

"Anthropologies of late modernity (also called postmodernity, postindustrial society, knowledge society, or information society) provide challenges for all levels of social, cultural, and psychological theory, as well as for ethnographic field methods and genres of writing. There are three key overlapping arenas of attention. 1. The continuing transformation of modernities by science and technology.... 2. The reconfiguration of perception and understanding, of the human and social sensorium.... 3. The reconstruction of society in the wake of social trauma caused by world war and civil and ethnic wars.... [stress added]." Michael M.J. Fischer, 1999, Emergent Forms of LIFE: Anthropologies of Late or Postmodernities. Annual Review of Anthropology, Vol. 28, pages 455-478, page 457.

"Modern cultural anthropology, or ethnology as I will usually be calling it, is the major area of inhabited-world making (especially other-world making), at least in terms of its explicitness of focus and of its historical consequentiality. From within the borders of the culture of science it articulates entire and distinct webs of possibility for human relations, actions, imagination, meanings. Anthropology in its large sense considers these cultural webs in pursuit of a more general and unified description of the human, per se. The ethnographies underpinning anthropological knowledge of cultures are subject to the limitations of human vision, especially the vision of novelty, and human language (inevitably culture-bound as even the technical lexicons of the sciences are). The magnetism of the ethnographer's own cultural assumptions curves her [or his!] descriptions of other cultures into globes that tend to function as versions--better, worse, or merely wondrous in their difference--of the home globe" [stress added]." Mary Baine Campbell, 1999, Wonder & Science: Imagining Worlds in Early Modern Europe (Cornell University Press), pages 10-11.

"Perhaps the lesson about social theorizing won with the greatest recent effort is that intellectual practises cannot escape being affected by the concepts with and through which thought proceeds. Consequently, describers must be reflective, trying to be as clear about the work they intend their concepts to accomplish as they are about the picture they wish to paint." David Hakken, 1999, Cyborgs@Cyberspace? An Ethnographer Looks to the Future, page 3.

"Science does not have appropriate tools for the dissection of the spirit." Jane Goodall [with Phillip Berman], 1999, Reason For Hope: A Spiritual Journey (NY: Warner Books), page 165.

"Good heavens! For more than forty years I have been speaking prose without knowing it [stress added]!" (Molière, pseudonym for Jean Baptiste Poquelin [1622-1673]).

"Seven specific hurdles and four epistemological issues with particular salience to anthropological cyberspace ethnography have been listed. Yet the stories anthropologists are able to tell have always depended on
  • The Problems we choose,
  • The points at which we enter the field,
  • The ways we draw intellectual and social boundaries,
  • The levels of our units of study,
  • Our practises in the field, and
  • The terms we employ to describe those experiences.

Hurdles and issues like these were problematic in the Malinowskian era as well; we just weren't aware of it. Thus, cyberspace ethnography is no more (and no less) at risk of collapse under the critique of ethnography than is any other ethnographic practise." David Hakken, 1999, Cyborgs@Cyberspace? An Ethnographer Looks to the Future, page 67.

"Post-moderninsm is dead, assuming there ever was such a thing." The Character V.T. Newbury in Robert K. Tanenbaum, 1994, Justice Denied (NY: Signet Books), page 258.

Interesting (And Somewhat Appropriate) Web Sites Are:

http://www.math.unl.edu/~jfisher/femanthro/overview.html [Feminist Anthropology Theory Matrix]
http://www.csus.edu/anth/html/seasian.html [Digital Ethnography Project from CSU, Sacramento]
http://www.sscnet.ucla.edu/anthro/gessler/ [Culture and Computational Anthropology]
http://classes.yale.edu/anth500a/viewing_notes/VN_E-P.htm [viewing notes} Edward Evans-Pritchard]
http://www.bodley.ox.ac.uk/isca/history.html [History of Anthropology in Oxford]
http://www.alanmacfarlane.com/ancestors/ [Anthropological and Other Ancestors} Quick-Time Video on the WWW]


WEEK 12. November 10 & 12, 2003: Mon & Wed} Winding down and general discussions and review for EXAM II (25%) on Monday November 17, 2003. This will be based on selected readings in Davies & Piero (2002), Langness (pp. 74-217), selected assigned readings in Fall 2003 Anthropology 296 Guidebook and Selected Anthropology Essays by Urbanowicz, lectures/discussions, and the quotations referred to in this Guidebook to date. Specific Readings from Reserve WILL NOT BE on the Exam.

Please Finish The Required Reading in: Langness: Ch 5, 6, & 7 (pp. 139-217).

NOTE: A "sample" self-paced exam should be available at: http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ANTH296FA2003TESTTwo.htm by Monday November 10, 2003, to assist you as a Review for EXAM II. (Again, I am well aware that "older" versions of my ANTH 296 Exams exist "out there" - I return them so you might learn from any mistakes; by all means, if you have access to "old" exams, do look at them; but r.e.m.e.m.b.e.r to read and study for EXAM II as if you might be faced with BRAND NEW EXAMINATION QUESTIONS - which could well be the case!)!

JANE GOODALL, born 1934} "The greatest danger to our future is apathy. We cannot expect those living in poverty and ignorance to worry about saving the world. For those of us able to read this magazine, it is different. We can do something to preserve our planet. You may be overcome, however, by feelings of helplessness. You are just one person in a world of 6 billion. How can your actions make a difference? Best, you say, to leave it to decision makers. And so you do nothing. Can we overcome apathy? Yes, but only if we have hope. One reason for hope lies in the extraordinary nature of human intellectual accomplishment." [http://www.time.com/time/2002/greencentury/engoodall.html] [See: http://www.time.com/time/magazine/0,9263,1101020826,00.html [Special Report in Time magazine, August 26, 2002: "How To Save the Earth"]

"When Goodall [born 1934 -> ] came to Gombe in the 1960s, about 150 chimpanzees inhaibted the area. Today about a hundred survive in the dwindling forest. 'When the first satellite images were taken of Gombe in 1972, there was little difference between what was inside the parl and what was outside,' says conservation biologist Lilian Pintea of the University of Minnesota .... Today Gombe, only eight miles wide, is surrounded by farms and people, including thousands of refugees fleeing violence in nearby countries [stress added]." In an article by] Jane Goodall, 2003, Update Lessons From Gombe, Tanzania. The National Geographic, April 2003, pages 76-89, pages 80-81.

"My reasons for hope are fourfold: (1) the human brain; (2) the resilience of nature; (3) the energy and enthusiasm that is found or can be found or can be kindled among young people worldwide; and (4) the indomitable human spirit [stress added]." Jane Goodall [with Phillip Berman], 1999, Reason For Hope: A Spiritual Journey (NY: Warner Books), page 233.

"Robben Island was used at various times between the 17th and the 20th century as a prison, a hospital for socially unacceptable groups, and a military base. Its buildings, and in particular those of the late 20th century, such as the maximum security prison for political prisoners, bear witness to the triumph of democracy and freedom over oppression and racialism."http://whc.unesco.org/sites/916.htm [Robben Island, South Africa} 1999]

On the hatchery at Adobe Creek, California: "The hatchery was dedicated on April 25, 1993, as students unfurled their banner: 'Together we will change the world' [from the United Anglers of Casa Grande high School, Petaluma, CA.] [stress added]." SEE: Malcolm McConnel, 1999, Miracle at Adobe Creek. The Reader's Digest, Vol. 154, No. 924, pages 78-84, page 84.

"...I have been lucky to work with some fine scientists and have had the opportunity to discover prized relics of our evolutionary history. Many people experience a deep, almost primordial urge to understand our beginnings as a species, and the search for such relics in ancient sediments brings one into direct contact with our species' history. Those of us who are in this line of work are truly privileged" [stress added]." Richard Leakey & Roger Lewin, 1995, The Sixth Extinction: Patterns of Life and the Future of Humankind (NY: Anchor Books), page 4.

SOME QUESTIONS asked of Richard Leakey [born December 19, 1944]: "What do you think is the biggest problem facing the world today? Global warming. ... Which historical figure would you most like to invite to a dinner party? Charles Darwin, so that I could tell him of what we now know and re-assure him that he has made some of the most significant contributions ever in terms of placing us within context on this planet [streess added]." (Discover, May 1999, pages 18-19).

"The chasm between what scientists do and what the public understands about science widens daily. A new Web site, produced by a group of top paleontologists, aims to provide a bridge across that chasm to the confusing world of human origins and offer a clear view of how science develops its notions about our beginnings [stress added]. ... http://www.becominghuman.org...." Tim Friend, 2001, Site digs at the roots of the human family tree. USAToday, April 16, 2001, page 6D.

"You may not believe in evolution, and that is all right. How we humans came to be the way we are is far less important than how we should act now to get out of the mess we have made for ourselves. How should the mind that can contemplate God relate to our fellow beings, the other life-forms of the world? What is our human responsibility? And what, ultimately, is our human destiny? [stress added]." Jane Goodall [with Phillip Berman], 1999, Reason For Hope: A Spiritual Journey (NY: Warner Books), page 2.

FINALLY, Urbanowicz likes and appreciates the words of Thomas Jefferson [1743-1826] as provided by Silvio A. Bedini, 2002, Jefferson And Science (Monticello: Thomas Jefferson Foundation), page 107, from an 1818 letter of Jefferson:

"When I contemplate the immense advances in science and discoveries in the arts which have been made within the period of my life, I look forward with confidence to equal advances by the present generation, and have no doubt they will consequently be as much wiser that we have been as we than our fathers were and they than the burners of witches [stress added]." Silvio A. Bedini, 2002, Jefferson And Science (Monticello: Thomas Jefferson Foundation), page 107.

http://www.janegoodall.org/ [Jane Goodall]
http://www.uacg.org/ [United Anglers of Casa Grande, Petaluma, CA]
http://www.talkorigins.org/faqs/homs/rleakey.html [Biographies: Richard Leakey]
http://www.leakeyfoundation.org/foundation/f1_4.jsp [The Leakey Foundation]


WEEK 13. November 17 & 19, 2003: EXAM I [25%] on MONDAY November 17 and then into Term Paper Presentations beginning on Wednesday November 19, 2003. NOTE: the 2003 American Anthropological Association 102nd Annual Meeting will be held in Chicago, November 19-23, 2003.

WEEK 14. THANKSGIVING BREAK!

WEEK 15. December 1 & 3, 2003: Mon & Wed} Term Paper Presentations/Discussions Continue. [Please Remember: Class participation, including Term paper presentation, represents 15% of your total grade.]

WEEK 16. December 8 & 10, 2003: Mon & Wed} Term Paper Presentations/Discussions Continue. [Please Remember: Class participation, including Term paper presentation, represents 15% of your total grade.]

WEEK 17.December 15, 2003 (Monday] FINALS WEEK} Term Paper Discussions CONCLUDE (if needed) and FINAL MEETING SCHEDULED ON Monday December 15, 2003 from 6->7:50pm and your TERM PAPER is DUE (25%) on that date.

AND THE FINAL URBANOWICZ QUOTE for FALL 2003:

"The most important word in the English language is attitude. Love and hate, work and play, hope and fear, our attitudinal response to all these situations, impresses me as being the guide." Harlen Adams (1904-1997)
and finally

"The Moving Finger writes; and, having writ,
Moves on: nor all your Piety nor Wit
Shall lure it back to cancel half a Line,
Nor all your Tears wash out a Word of it."
From the 1859 publication of The Rubáiyát of Omar Khayyám [1048-1131] by
Edward Fitzgerald [1809-1883]

"I am an optimist. It does not seem too much use being anything else." Sir Winston Churchill [1874-1965].

"A teacher affects eternity;
he [or she!] can never tell
where his [or her] influence stops."
Henry Brooks Adams [1838-1918],
The Education of Henry Adams, chapter 20

"What we cannot speak about we must pass over in silence."
Ludwig Wittgenstgein (1889-1951) Proposition #7 from Tractatus Logico-Philosophicus.
IN Prototractatus: An Early Version of Tractatus Logico-Philosophicus by Ludwig Wittgenstein
Edited by B.F. McGuiness et. al (Cornell University Press), page 237.


Some THOUGHTS To Consider and Discuss in Fall 2003 (some of which you have already read above):

"My intention is not, however, to [simply] impart information, but to throw the burden of study upon you. If I succeed in teaching you to observe, my aim will be attained [stress added]." Louis Aggasiz [1807-1873], Swiss-American Scientist.

"I say my philosophy, not as claiming authorship of ideas which are widely diffused in modern thought, but because the ultimate selection and synthesis must be a personal responsibility." Sir Arthur Eddington [1882-1944], The Philosophy of Physical Science, 1949: viii.

"I love quotations. Maybe it's a symptom of a short-attention-span, instant-gratification age, but I'm a sucker for a well-stated tidbit of brevity and wit. For me, quotes do with precision what reading does in general: they confirm the astuteness of my perceptions, they open the way to ideas, and they console me with the knowledge that I'm not alone [stress added]." John Winkonur, 1990 [editor], W.O.W. Writers on Writing (Philadelphia: Running Press), page 1.

"Science does not have appropriate tools for the dissection of the spirit." Jane Goodall [with Phillip Berman], 1999, Reason For Hope: A Spiritual Journey (NY: Warner Books), page 165.

"The palest ink is better than the best memory." (Chinese proverb)

"Any education is the process of learning how little you know." Eichard Corliss, 2003, Hook, Line And Thinker. Time, May 26, 2003, pages 60-63, page 63.

"Learning can be seen as the acquisition of information, but before it can take place, there must be interest; interest permeates all endeavors and precedes learning. In order to acquire and remember new knowledge, it must stimulate your curiosity in some way." Richard Saul Wurman, Information Anxiety, 1989: 138.

"A quotation is a polished prefabricated unit of thought or discourse which has many connotations and associations built in to it. It is thus like the text for a sermon, serving as a point of departure for many lines of thought." Alan L. Mackay, 1977 Statement.

"When you ferret out something for yourself, piecing the clues together unaided, it remains for the rest of your life in some way truer than facts you are merely taught, and freer from onslaughts of doubt." Colin Fletcher, 1968, The Man Who Walked Through Time, p. 109.

"In the field of observation, chance only favors those who are prepared." Louis Pasteur [1822-1895].

"The unit of survival [or adaptation] is organism plus environment. We are learning by bitter experience that the organism which destroys its environment destroys itself. If, now, we correct the Darwinian unit of survival to include the environment and the interaction between organism and environment, a very strange and surprising identity emerges: the unit of survival turns out to be identical with the unit of mind" [italics in original; stress added]." Gregory Bateson [1904-1980], 1972, Steps To An Ecology of Mind (NY: Ballantine Books), page 483.

"....descriptions vary with the conceptual or theoretical framework within which they are couched. To evaluate a description properly one must know something about the theoretical framework that brought it into being." D. Kaplan and R. Manners, Culture Theory, 1972: 22.

"Let every man [or woman!] judge by himself [or herself!!], by what he himself read, not by what others tell him [or her!!!]." Albert Einstein [1879-1955], 1934 statement.

"From an institutional perspective, the significance of ethnography can be attributed to three roles it has played in the professional careers of anthropologists. First, the reading and teaching of exemplary ethnographic texts have been the major means of conveying to students what anthropologists do and what they know. Rather than becoming dated as in other fields, classic works in anthropology, remain vitally relevant, and their materials are a perennial source for the raising of new conceptual and theoretical problems. ... Second, ethnography is a very personal and imaginative vehicle by which anthropologists are expected to make contributions to theoretical and intellectual discussions, both within their discipline and beyond. ... Third, and most importantly ethnography has been the initiatory activity which has launched careers and established reputations" [stress added]. George E. Marcus and Michael M.J. Fischer, 1999, Anthropology As Cultural Critique: An Experimental Moment In The Human Sciences, 2nd Edition (University of Chicago Press), page 21.
"What we know is a drop. What we don't know is an ocean." Sir Isaac Newton [1642-1727] The Wall Street Journal, November 1, 1991.

"How often do the involuntary movements of our features reveal what we are secretly thinking and betray us to those about us!" Michel Eyquem de Montaigne [1533-1592] French philosopher/essayist) in Essays, translated by J.M. Cohen, 1958, page 189.

"The farther backward you can look, the farther forward you are likely to see." Sir Winston Churchill [1874-1965], 1953 Nobel Prize Winner in Literature.
"This great world, which some still reckon to be but one example of a whole genus, is the mirror into which we must look if we are to behold ourselves from the proper standpoint." Michel Eyquem de Montaigne [1533-1592] French philosopher/essayist), Essays, translated by J.M. Cohen, 1958, page 64.

"My view is that knowledge is a rearrangement of experience, in which we put together those experiences that seem to us to belong together, and put them apart from those that do not." Jacob Bronowski [1908-1984], The Identity of Man, 1966: 26.

"Scientific explanation consists not in moving from the complex to the simple but in the replacement of a less intelligible complexity by one which is more so." Claude Lévi-Strauss, 1962, The Savage Mind, 1968 edition, page 248.

"Facts are not pure unsullied bits of information; culture also influences what we see and how we see it. Theories, moreover, are not inexorable inductions from facts. The most creative theories are often imaginative visions imposed upon facts; the source of imagination is also cultural." Stephen Jay Gould, American Biologist/Author.

"Facts are the air of science. Without them a man [or a woman!] of science can never rise. Without them your theories are vain surmises. But while you are studying, observing, experimenting, do not remain content with the surface of things. Do not become a mere recorder of facts, but try to penetrate the mystery of their origin. Seek obstinately for the laws that govern them." Ivan Pavlov, Russian Physiologist [1849-1936].

"The cutting edge of knowledge is not in the known but in the unknown, not in knowing but in questioning. Facts, concepts, generalizations, and theories are dull instruments unless they are honed to a sharp edge by persistent inquiry about the unknown." Ralph H. Thompson [1911-1987] American Educator.

"I say, therefore, that we think with or through ideas and what we call thinking is generally the application of preexisting ideas to a given situation or set of facts. ...When a thing is intelligible you have a sense of participation; when a thing is unintelligible you have a sense of estrangement." F. Schumacher, 1973, Small is Beautiful: Economics as if People Mattered, page 84.

"Interest is a sense of being involved in some process, actual or potential. ...Interest is not the same as attention. Attention is a simple response to a stimulus--either to a loud bang or (much more powerful) to a feeling of interest. Interest is selective, an expenditure of energy by the interested party. ... Memory is an internally edited record of interests (not of attention, much less of 'events')." Henry Hay, 1972, The Amateur Magician's Handbook, pp. 2-3.

"In many crucial ways, the Earth is becoming as small as it appears to orbiting astronauts and cosmonauts. Global communications, universal trends, and common aspirations are making us more alike than we are different. Despite our rich cultural diversity, we gradually are becoming nearly one world. ... We share history. World War II tore us apart. ... We share technology. Communication satellites make it possible for millions to share the information and entertainment that's on television. Satellites have also revolutionized telephone and telefax communication. We sent reporters all over the world, but rarely were they out of reach of a telephone. We share high-speed transportation. Today, it takes less than twenty-four hours to travel between virtually any two points in the world." A. Neurath with Kelley & Walte, 1989, Nearly One World, pages 4-6.

"One of the greatest lessons that can be learned from the history of science is one of humility. Science may indeed be steadily learning more about the structure of the world, but surely what is known is exceedingly small in relation to what is unknown. There is no scientific theory today, not even a law, that may not be modified or discarded tomorrow [stress added]." Martin Gardner, 1990, The New Ambidextrous Universe: Symmetry and Asymmetry From Mirror Reflections to Superstrings, 3rd edition, page 335.

"No matter how much I admire our schools, I know that no university exists that can provide an education; what a university can provide is an outline, to give the learner a direction and guidance. The rest one has to do for oneself." Louis L'Amour, 1989, The Education Of A Wandering Man, page 3.

"We were getting close to the answer and I was beginning to fly. I could feel my brain cells doing a little tap dance of delight. I was half-skipping, excitement bubbling out of me as we crossed the street. 'I love information. I love information. Isn't this great? God, it's fun...'" The character Kinsey Milhone, in Sue Grafton, 1990, "G" Is For Gumshoe, page 277.

August Comte (1798-1857) and St. Simon (1760-1825) are the founders of sociology. In 1839, in Volume IV of Cours de Philosophie Positive (or System of Positive Polity), Comte coined the term sociologie to serve as an equivalent to "social physics" (which came from Comte and St. Simon). Comte's schema was: Mathematics, Astronomy, Physics, Chemistry, Biology, and Sociology. Anthropologie was the 7th science for Comte for in 1852 he wrote:

"Elle n'était point apprécable avant que ma fondation de la sociologie eut terminé la préparation encyclopédique qu'exigeait l'avénement systématique de la véritable anthropologie, à laquelle il faut conserver son nom sacré de morals. Cette condition finale étant désormais remplie, et m'ayant déjà conduit à construire subjectivement la saine théorie cérébrale, le septieme et dernier degré de la grand hiérarchie abstraite devient aussi caractérise que tous les autres."

A translation from 1875:

"The consequences could not be seen, until, by founding Sociology, I was able to add the last group to the Encyclopedic series of the sciences, When this was affected, it was possible to have a systematic basis for an Anthropology, or true science of Man, though this science ought ever to retain its sacred name of morals. Now that this last condition has been fulfilled, and now that it has already enabled me to construct on subjective methods a sound Cerebral Theory, the seventh and last gradation in the Grand Hierarchy of Abstract Science is a distinctively defined as any of the others [ALL STRESS ADDED]" (1874 translation of System of Positive Polity, Vol. II, pages 356-347).

Elsewhere Comte had written:

"Leaving Sociology, it only remains for me to describe the third term of the grand progressive series, which gives us the true encyclopedic inventory: I mean the study of Moral Laws, the necessary goal of all healthy speculation. The field of Morals [NOTE: ANTHROPOLOGY] is at once more special, more complex, and more noble than that of Sociology strictly so called, the exact rank of which has been determined....Morals is the most eminent of the sciences, both because of the superior dignity of its object, Man, from which we get our type of true nobleness, and because, as I am about to explain, of its theoretic plentitudes [ALL STRESS ADDED]."

From Thomas Alva Edison (1847-1931): The individual "...who doesn't make up his [or her!] mind to cultivate the habit of thinking misses the greatest pleasures in life...My business is thinking."

"The highest stage in moral culture at which we can arrive, is when we recognise that we ought to control our thoughts...." Charles R. Darwin (1809-1882), The Descent of Man And Selection in Relation to Sex, 1871 [1981 Princeton University Press edition, with Introduction by John T. Bonner and Robert M. May], Chapter 3, page 101).

"My reasons for hope are fourfold: (1) the human brain; (2) the resilience of nature; (3) the energy and enthusiasm that is found or can be found or can be kindled among young people worldwide; and (4) the indomitable human spirit [stress added]." Jane Goodall [with Phillip Berman], 1999, Reason For Hope: A Spiritual Journey (NY: Warner Books), page 233.

"Any teacher who can be replaced by a computer deserves to be! [stress added!]" David Smith; as cited by Mike Cooley, 1999, Human-Centered Design. In Information Design (1999), edited by Robert Jacobson (MIT Press), pages 59-81, page 73.

"After dedicating their careers to studying exotic cultures in faraway lands, a few anthropologists are coming home. They're taking research techniques they once used in African shantytowns and Himalayan villages to Knights of Columbus halls, corporate office buildings and suburban shopping centers.... [The Anthropologists] study American families the way they would Polynesian cargo cults or Mongolian nomads--by inserting themselves into the daily lives of their subjects" [stress added]." Matt Crenson, 2000, Anthropologists Among Us. The Modesto Bee, July 17, 2000, pages D1 and D2.

"There is, nevertheless, a certain respect, and a general duty of humanity, that ties us, not only to beasts that have life and sense, but even to trees and plants." (Michel Eyquem de Montaigne [1533-1592] French philosopher/essayist) or in another translation: "...there is a certain consideration, and a general duty of humanity, that binds us not only to the animals, which have life and feeling, but even to the trees and plants." Essays, translated by J.M. Cohen, 1958, page 189)

"Finally, I wish to emphasize once more that what has been said here in a somewhat categorical form does not claim to mean more than the personal opinion of a man, which is founded on nothing but his own personal experience, which he has gathered as a student and as a teacher." Albert Einstein [1879-1955]

"Still, a book is less important for what it says than for what it makes you think." Louis L'Amour, 1989, Education of A Wandering Man, page 101.

Urbanowicz adds again: "I quote others only the better to express myself." (Michel Eyquem de Montaigne [1533-1592] French philosopher/essayist); or, in another translation: "I only quote others to make myself more explicit." (Essays, translated by J.M. Cohen, 1958, page 52).

"What we cannot speak about we must pass over in silence."
Ludwig Wittgenstgein (1889-1951) Proposition #7 from Tractatus Logico-Philosophicus.
IN Prototractatus: An Early Version of Tractatus Logico-Philosophicus by Ludwig Wittgenstein
Edited by B.F. McGuiness et. al (Cornell University Press), page 237.


PARTICIPATION / PAPER PRESENTATION

Class participation counts for 15% of your final grade: this includes class attendance throughout the semester, your classroom presentation, and thoughtful comments on other student presentations. The following information should be of value to you when it comes to your term paper presentation beginning WEEK 13:

Some selections from "Preparing and presenting a speech" by Shirley Shields (in The Great American Bathroom Book I, 1992, edited by Steven W. Anderson). [The information as it appeared in GABB I was actually an edited summary of the Shields 1989 publication entitled Change Your Voice, Change Your Image (Chapter 7)].

"Consider these ten key steps when preparing a talk:

1. Choose your subject with care....
2. Analyze the audience....
3. Ascertain your purpose: Are you spewaking chiefly to persuade, entertain, or inform?
4. Gather materials....
5. Organize the material....The introduction...The body of your talk....The conclusions...
6. Select words carefully....
7. Use quotations correctly....
8. Employ (on a limited basis) personal references....
9. Make your speech your own....
10. Time your speech: Nothing kills a good speech [or classroom presentation!] than going overtime [stress added]."


CONSIDER, If you will, the following:

"With verbal reports, much of the data gets lost in translation. Most people aren't trained to listen. Given the complexity of our mental processes, the recipient tunes out, blocks, forgets, or misinterprets eighty percent of what's been said. Take any fifteen minutes' worth of conversation and try to reconstruct it later and you'll see what I mean. If the communication has any emotional content whatever, the quality of the information retained degrades even further [stress added]." Sue Grafton, 1998, N Is For Noose (NY: Henry Holt and Company), page 23.


Some selections from "How To Get Your Point Across in 30 Seconds--or Less" by Milo O. Frank (in The Great American Bathroom Book II, 1993, edited by Steven W. Anderson), pages 455-456.

"The three principles of effective communication: The first component of an effective 30-second message--the passive, pre-planned part of your communication--consists of the three principles necessary for effective communication: know your objective, know your listener, and know your approach. ... The three techniques of effective communication: The second part of your 30-second message is the actual message itself. The effectiveness of your message pivots on the three techniques of effective communication--the three K's of your message. Your 'hook' is designed to 'Katch' your listener; the 'subject' will 'Keep'em interested; and the 'closing' will 'Konvince'em' to work with you. Adding Impact: The finishing touches of a 30-second message include a number of measures you can take to add impact. ... Imagery - Make sure your listener sees as well as hears what you are saying....Clarity - Choose words and images appropriate to your listeners level of understanding. ... Personalizing - Use personal stores or examples to illustrate key points.... Emotional Appeal - The most effective messages are those that reach the listener's heart [stress added]."


CRITERIA OF WRITING PROFICIENCY:

For the purpose of this class (ANTH 296 / ANTH 296H), the minimal definition of "Writing Proficiency" encompasses all three of the levels described below. It is expected that anyone who receives a grade of "C-" or better in this class has achieved these levels of writing proficiency.

Level #1: Minimally, writing proficiency begins with the ability to construct meaningful sentences that follow the conventional rules of grammar, punctuation, and spelling; exhibit appropriate choice of words; and utilize sentence structures that clearly, efficiently, and precisely convey the writer's ideas and relevant information to readers who observe the same conventions of writing.

Level #2: At the next level, writing proficiency entails the constructing and arranging of sentences into paragraphs that:

a. Develop arguments logically.
b. Present a body of information systematically.
c. Express an idea effectively.
d. Provide a coherent answer to a question.
e. Describe a given phenomenon effectively.
f. Summarize a larger body of information or abstract its essence accurately.
g. And/or otherwise achieve a specific objective efficiently and effectively.

Level #3: Writing proficiency at the third level requires the construction and arrangement of paragraphs in a such a manner that the reader is led successively through the intent or the objective of the paper, the implementation of the objective, and the conclusion which summarizes and meaningfully relates the body of the paper to its objective; please note this level also includes the use of "section headings" to break up the flow of the paper (beginning with INTRODUCTION and ending with CONCLUSIONS).

NOTE: For additional suggestions about "Writing" please see http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/syllabi/SYL_13-FA2003.html and "click" on WRITING ASSIGNMENT for that ANTH 13 (Human Cultural Diversity) class. Also see: http://www.as.ua.edu/ant/libguidt.htm [Writing Tools for Anthropology Students]

Note the following:

"Vigorous writing is concise. A sentence should contain no unnecessary words, a paragraph no unnecessary sentences, for the same reason that a drawing should have no unnecessary lines and a machine no unnecessary parts. This requires not that the writer make all his [or her!] sentences short, or that he [or she] avoid all detail and treat his [and her] subjects only in outline, but that every word tell."

"There you have a short, valuable essay on the nature and beauty of brevity--fifty-nine words [not counting those in the brackets added by Urbanowicz] that could change the world." E.B. White, commenting on the original words of William Strunk Jr. in The Elements of Style, 4th edition, 2000, pages xv-xvi.


 PLEASE NOTE: This is in no way intended to be a "definitive" listing (or categorization) and some individuals could (obviously) be placed in one or more "boxes" below! Also please note: Not everyone in the world would necessarily agree with my definition of "assumption(s)" nor my placement of "some individuals" below!

IDEAS
ASSUMPTION(s)
ONLY "SOME" INDIVIDUALS
#1
Acculturation: also called, by some, Cultural Dynamics.
Change(s) through time.

Melville J. Herskovits (1895-1963), H.G. Barnett (1906-1985); Nancy O. Lurie (1924->).

#2
(American) Cultural Anthropology: also called, by some, Historical Empiricism.

Ethnographic "facts" are obtained through fieldwork.

Franz Boas (1858-1942); Alexander Chamberlain (1865-1914); Alfred Kroeber (1876-1960); Elsie Parsons (1874-1941); Robert H. Lowie (1883-1957) ; Paul Radin (1883-1959); Ella Cara Deloria (1888-1971); Esther Goldfrank (1896-); Erna Gunther (1896-1982); Robert Redfield (1897-1958); Ruth Bunzel (1898-1990); Julian Steward (1902-1972); Gene Weltfish (1902-1980); Zora Neale Hurston (1903-1960); Ruth Landes (1908->1991); Ernestine Friedl (1920->); Eric Wolf (1923-1998); William S. Willis Jr. [1921-1983] Morton Klass (1927-2000).

#3
(British) Social Anthropology.

 

The "social" aspect (and "social organization") is crucial for an understanding of people.

Robert H. Codrington (1830-1922); Alfred C. Haddon (1855-1940); W.H.R.Rivers (1864-1922); Charles G. Seligman (1873-1940); A.R. Radcliffe-Brown (1881-1955); Beatrice M. Blackwood (1889-1975); Hortence Powdermaker (1896-1970); Camilla Wedgwood (1901-1955); Raymond Firth (1901-2002); Edward Evans-Pritchard (1902-1973); Sigfried Nadel (1903-1954); Monica Wilson (1908-1982); Edmund Leach (1910-1989); Max Gluckman (1911-1975); Ann K. Fischer (1919-1971); Victor Turner (1920-1983); Mary Douglas (1921->); F.G. Bailey (1924->).

#4
Cross-Cultural Research.
Statistical analyses based on previous research.

Edward Burnett Tyor (1832-1917); George P. Murdock (1897-1985).

#5
Diffusionism (Kulturkreise and Heliolithic).
Change as a result of diffusion (borrowing).

Friedrich Ratzel (1844-1904); Wilhelm Schmidt (1868-1954); Grafton Elliot Smith (1871-1937); Leo Frobenius (1873-1938); Fritz Graebner (1877-1934); Wilhelm Koppers (1886-1961); William J. Perry (1889-1949); V. G. Childe (1892-1957).

#6
Evolutionary ideas (various).
Change(s) over time.

Charles R. Darwin (1809-1882); Johann Jacob Bachofen (1815-1887); Edward B. Tylor (1832-1917); Lewis H. Morgan (1818-1881); Herbert Spencer (1820-1903); Karl Marx (1818-1883); Henry Maine (1822-1888); Pierre Paul Broca (1824-1880]; Thomas H. Huxley (1825-1895); John McLennan (1827-1881); Augustus Pitt-Rivers (1827-1900); Paul Topinard (1830-1911); John Lubbock (1834-1914); Max Weber (1864-1920); Pierre Teilhard de Chardin (1881-1955); Leslie White (1900-1975); Robert Carneiro (1927->); Marshall Sahlins (1930->)

#7
French Sociologie / Structuralism.
Culture (and Society) shaped by pre-programmed codes (of the human brain).

Émile Durkheim (1858-1917); Marcel Mauss (1872-1950); Arnold van Gennep (1873-1957); Claude Lévi-Strauss (1908->)

#8
Functionalism.
Discovering how parts of a culture function (not concerned with "origins" or "history").

Bronislaw Malinowski (1884-1942); Audrey I. Richards (1899-1984)

#9
Modernism / Postmodernism.
Thinking about what we are thinking about (and more!)

Eleanor B. Leacock (1922-1987), Clifford Geertz (1926-); Renato Rosaldo (1941->); Sherry Ortner (1941->); George Marcus (1943->).

#10
Neoevolutionism: also called, by some, Cultural Ecology.
Cultures develop in relation to their capacity for harnessing energy.

Julian Steward (1902-1972); Roy Rappaport (1926-1997); Marvin Harris (1927-2001]

#11
Positivism.
Use of the Scientific Method and natural "laws" can be discovered.

Charles de Montesquieu (1689-1775); Marquis de Condorcet (1743-1794), August Comte (1798-1857); Gregory Bateson (1904-1980); Derek Freeman (1916-2001).

#12
Pre [Non]-Boasian American Cultural Anthropology.
Somewhat Self-Explanatory.

Joseph François Lafitau (1670-1746) ; Henry Schoolcraft (1793-1864); John Wesley Powell (1834-1902); Erminnie Smith (1836-1886); Alice Fletcher (1838-1923); Frederick Putnam (1839-1915); Matilda Stevenson (1849-1915); Anténor Firmin (1850-1911); Franklin Cushing (1857-1900); Zelia Nuttall (1857-1933); Frederick Starr (1858-1933); Edward S. Curtis (1868-1952).

#13
 

"Primitive" Mentality.

Somewhat Self-Explanatory.

Theodore Waitz (1821-1864); Adolph Bastian (1826-1905); Lucien Levy-Bruhl (1857-1939).

#14
Psychological Anthropology: also called, by some, Culture & Personality.
Dealing with the relationship between culture and psychology.

Sigmund Freud (1856-1939); Edward Sapir (1884-1939); Ruth Benedict (1887-1948); Margaret Mead (1901-1978); Abram Kardiner (1891-1981); Ralph Linton (1893-1953); Cora DuBois (1903->); John Whiting [1908-1990] & Beatrice Whiting [died in 2003]; Horace Miner (1912-1993); Rhoda Metraux (1914->).

#15
Scholasticism.
Research / writing based on previously published and unpublished information.

James George Frazer (1854-1941); Charles F. Urbanowicz (1942->)

According to Leslie A. White & Beth Dillingham, "The whole history of ethnological theory is embraced [below] by this simple diagram" Leslie A. White (1900-1975) and Beth Dillingham, The Concept of Culture, 1973, page 38.

TEMPORAL
NON-TEMPORAL
PARTICULARIZING
History
Ethnography
GENERALIZING
Evolution
Functionalist-Structuralist


NOTE: Although this is not a web-based course, if you have access to the WWW (and you should), you might find some of the following sites of value (and many of these have been already referred to above):

In addition to the Department of Anthropology "Home Page" at CSU, Chico (http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/), some Interesting (and specific CSU, Chico) web sites include the following:

http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/EthnoLab/index.htm [Department of Anthropology} Ethnographic Laboratory]
http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/EthnoLab/archives/archives.htm [Anthropological Archives at Chico State]
http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/cccpwebsite/ [Chico Campus Culture Project]
http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/Museum/ [Museum of Anthropology]

http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/04_archeaology.html [Greg White} CSU, Chico: Steward of the Past And Future. Inside Chico State, May 15, 2003.]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/00_12_07/00.upfront.html [Museum of Anthropology Presents International Drumming Exhibit. Inside Chico State, December 7, 2000].
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/Vol44issue9/dimensions/d.3.museumcurator.html [Museum displays make her days. The Orion. March 24, 2000]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/vol40issue1/e.museum.html [Atari, records, bicycles on display in museum. The Orion, January 28, 1998]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/vol39issue04/e.timelesswonders.html [Museum exhibit looks at America. The Orion, September 17, 1997]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/Volume37Issue6/Entertainment/Phfefagafa.html [Photos feature fashion fads, faux-paus. The Orion, October 2 1996]

http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/PAHIL/ [Forensic Anthropology at CSU, Chico]
http://www.orion-online.net./vnews/display.v/ART/2002/04/03/3caa95354a7ab?in_archive=1 [Bones, death, stench: just another day in class. The Orion, May 21, 2002.]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/02_05_02/forensic.html [Murad & Willey} Forensic Anthropology Cuts Straight to the Bone. Inside Chico State, May 2, 2002].
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/02_02_14/cave.html [P. Willey} America's Earliest Cave Explorers Were the Best in the World. Inside Chico State, February 14, 2002]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/Vol46issue5/news/n.1.dead.html [Bringing out the dead. The Orion, February 21, 2001]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/99_09_30/s3.battlebones.html [P. Willey} Battle Bones Tell Dead Men's Tales. Inside Chico State, September 30, 2000]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/00_03_02/6.donnerbones.html [P. Willey}Forensic Anthropology Lectures: Notes from the Dead. Inside Chico State, March 3, 2000]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/Vol44issue5/news/n.5.crimexpert.html [Inside the minds of crime scene experts. The Orion, February 23, 2000]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/Vol44issue4/news/n.9.anthrograds.html [Anthro grad students lure some of nation's best: Forensic experts to visit campus next week for conference The Orion, February 16, 2000]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/98_03_05/klaas.html [Turhon Murad Surveys the Physical Evidence in the Polly Klaas Case. Inside Chico State, March 5, 1998]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/Volume33Issue13/Dimensions/Tlbcttabon.html [Murad} The leg bone's connected to... the ankle bone. The Orion, Nov. 30, 1994] 

http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/cs/fall_01/bio_dream.html [Zooarchaeology. Chico Statements, Fall 2001]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/00_09_07/02.eaglelake.html [Zooarchaeology. Inside Chico State, September 7, 2000]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/00_09_07/02.eaglelake.html [Bones in Context: Zooarchaeology/Field Ecology Summer School at Eagle Lake. Inside Chico State, September 7, 2000].
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/cs/spring_00/features/f.3.undertherockshelf.html [Greg White} On the "Rock Shelf." Chico Statements, Spring 2000].
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/cs/spring_99/departments/campus-collage/ [Chris O'Brien}These Teeth Aren't Flossed. Chico Statements, Spring 1999]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/98_02_12/young.html [Zooarchaeology. Inside Chico State, February 12, 1998]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/97_11_06/top_story2.html [Zooarchaeology. Inside Chico State, November 6, 1997]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/vol39issue08/n.race.html [Chico State talks trash. The Orion. October 15, 1997]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/97_10_23/top_story1.html Archaeological Research at CSU, Chico: The Archaeometric Lab. Inside Chico State, October 23, 1997]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/Volume35Issue12/News/ColumOne.html [Traveling across the country with Chico State University professor Frank Bayham can be a smelly experience. The Orion, November 15, 1995]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/02_11_21/01_bidwell.html [Without Shovel or Trowel: Archaeologists Investigate Bidwell Mansion Underground Without Turning Soil. Inside Chico State, November 21, 2002]

http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/vol40issue2/n.darwin.html [Urbanowicz}Darwin's insight evolves to CD-ROM. The Orion, February 4, 1998]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/97_10_23/enthusiasm.html [Urbanowicz} The Enthusiasm of Teaching. Inside Chico State, October 23, 1997]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/97_09_25/tech.html [Urbanowicz} Camping Is Great but Nothing Beats Home: Across the USA in Pursuit of Educational Technology. Inside Chico State, September 25, 1997].
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/99_02_04/top_story2.html [Loker} Anthropologist Bill Loker: Eye Witness to Hurricane Mitch. Inside Chico State, February 4, 1999]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/02_01_30/beyond.html [Reinschmidt} Beyond Words: Local voices resonate with a national crisis. Inside Chico State, January 31, 2002.]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/01_11_06/rituals.html [Farrer] Students Invent Modern Rituals in Experimental Honors Class. Inside Chico State, November 6, 2001]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/01_11_06/upfront.html [Farrer} Anthropologist Receives Distinguished Visiting Professorship. Inside Chico State, November 6, 2001].
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/99_04_15/top_story2.html [Farrer} Master Teachers Selected for 1999-2001. Inside Chico State, April 15, 1999.]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/cs/fall_99/departments/d.eb.openbook.html [Heinz} Open Book. Chico Statements, Fall 1999].
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/vol42issue2/dimensions/d.6.computercrash.html [Heinz}Computer crash? Take a class. The Orion. February 3, 1999]
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/cs/fall_99/departments/d.expandedbookshelf.html [Heinz} Asian Cultural Traditions. Chico Statements, Fall 1999].
http://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/99_02_11/top_story2.html [Heinz} A Hindu Cremation in Nepal. Inside Chico State, February 11, 1999]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/vol43issue5/news/n.7.witchcraft.html [Lehmann} 'Witchcraft' instructor dies. The Orion, September 22, 1999]
http://orion.csuchico.edu/Pages/Volume35Issue13/Dimensions/AtoAecaedu.html [Lehmann} Anthropologist tells of African experience, career as educator. The Orion, November 29, 1995]
ttp://www.csuchico.edu/pub/inside/archive/98_05_14/doing.html [Anthropology's Valene Smith Retires: "Learn by Doing; Teach by Being." Inside Chico State, May 14, 1998]

SOME ADDITIONAL WEB SITES INCLUDE THE FOLLOWING:

http://www.uncwil.edu/stuaff/career/anthropology.htm [Anthropology jobs]
http://www.unipv.it/webbio/dfantrop.htm [A Massive Anthropology site!]
http://www.csuchico.edu/lbib/anthropology/anthropology.html [Check out CSU Chico]
http://www.csuchico.edu/lref/guides/rbs/anthro.htm [Anthropology Resources beginning with CSU, Chico]
http://www.tamu.edu/anthropology/news.html [Anthropology in The News]
http://www.nmnh.si.edu/departments/anthro.html/ [Department of Anthropology, Smithsonian Institution]
http://www.sjsu.edu/depts/anthropology/svcp/ [The Silicon Valley Cultures Project]
http://www.indiana.edu/~wanthro/theory.htm [Anthropology Theory from Indiana University]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/index.shtml [CHECK Out Anthropology Biographies from Minnesota State University, Mankato and their Emuseum]
http://archaeology.about.com/cs/biographies/ [Biographies of Archaeologists]
http://people.bu.edu/pwood/Timelines.htm [A Timeline for Anthropologists by Peter W. Wood]
http://projects.prm.ox.ac.uk/kent/misc/histcov.html [History of Anthropology]
http://www.anthrobase.com/Dic/eng/index.html [Online Dictionary of Anthropology]
http://www.as.ua.edu/ant/Faculty/murphy/anthros.htm [Anthropological Theories: A Guide prepared for Students by Students]]

http://www.aaanet.org/press/an/0203Hinsley.htm [Founding the AAA 100 years ago} by Curtis Hinsley]
http://www.alanmacfarlane.com/ancestors/ [Anthropological and Other Ancestors} Quick-Time Video on the WWW]

http://www.csuchico.edu/lins/chicorio/ [ChicoRio - Research Instruction On-Line]

http://www.janegoodall.org/ [Jane Goodall]
http://www.newscientist.co.uk/ns/19991211/inhumanfut.html [About Sarah Blaffer Hrdry]
http://www.mtholyoke.edu/proj/cel/fossey.htm [Dian Fossey}1932-1985]
http://www.sciam.com/explorations/121696explorations.html [Mary Leakey: 1913-1996]
http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/information/biography/klmno/leakey_mary.html [Mary Leakey} 1913-1996]
http://www.kirjasto.sci.fi/leakey.htm [Louis S.B. Leakey} 1903-1972]
http://www.pathfinder.com/time/magazine/articles/0,3266,21822,00.html [Donald Johanson on the Leakey Family!]
http://www.becominghuman.org
http://www.scanet.org/ [Society for California Archaeology]
http://www.webcom.com/shownet/medea/bulfinch [Bullfinch's Mythology]
http://www.tiac.net/users/cri/piltdown.html [Piltdown Man site]

http://darwin.ws/day/ [Darwin Day Home Page]
http://www.galapagos.org/cdf.htm [Charles Darwin Foundation, Inc.]
http://www.gruts.demon.co.uk/darwin/index.htm [The Friends of Charles Darwin Home Page]
http://www.ilkley.org/darwin/ [The Ilkley Pages: Darwin Gardens]
http://www.darwinawards.com/ [Official Darwin Awards} "...showing us just how uncommon common sense can be." Wendy Northcutt, 2000, The Darwin Awards: Evolution in Action (Dutton)
http://www-cgi.cs.cmu.edu/cgi-bin/book/maketitlepage [Books on Line]
http://www.powneysbookshop.demon.co.uk/darevo.html [Darwin/Evolution+ "Jumping Off" point!]
http://www.shef.ac.uk/~psysc/darwin/dar.html [On Darwin]
http://abcnews.go.com/sections/scitech/DailyNews/evolution020401.html [Design vs. Darwin} April 1, 2002]
http://www.pbs.org/wgbh/evolution/darwin/index.html [Darwin} From WGBH/PBS "Evolution" Show]
http://www.reptiland.com/onlinecourse/session2/resources.html [Evolution: Online Course for Teachers]
http://cwx.prenhall.com/bookbind/pubbooks/stiling4/chapter1/essay13/deluxe-content.html [Interactive Case study on Galápagos Finches]

http://www.bbc.co.uk/education/darwin/index.shtml [BBC Education: Evolution Homepage]
http://www.darwinday.org/ [Darwin Day Program]
http://www.literature.org/authors/darwin-charles/the-origin-of-the-species/ [C. Darwin} Origin of Species]
http://mobydicks.com/lecture/CharlesDarwinhall/wwwboard.html [Interesting Darwin "lecture hall"]
http://www.ucmp.berkeley.edu/history/owen.html [Richard Owen} 1804-1892]
http://www.dimensional.com/~randl/scopes.htm [The Scopes "Monkey Trial," or "A 1925 Media Circus"]
http://xroads.virginia.edu/~UG97/inherit/1925home.html [Inherit/1925]
http://www.uib.no/zoo/classics/new_species.txt [Alfred Russell Wallace 1855 paper]
http://www.uib.no/zoo/classics/varieties.html [Alfred Russell Wallace 1858 paper]
http://www.ucmp.berkeley.edu/history/thuxley.html [Thomas Henry Huxley: 1824-1895]
http://www.human-nature.com/darwin/huxley/contents.html [Thomas Henry Huxley: 1824-1895]
http://aleph0.clarku.edu/huxley/ [The Huxley File]
http://www.friesian.com/creation.htm [Creationism & Darwnism, Politics & Economics} Taoist Darwinism]
http://www.mugu.com/galton/ [Sir Francis Galton} 1822-1911]
http://www.ucmp.berkeley.edu/history/agassiz.html [Louis Agasiz} 1807-1873]
http://perso.club-internet.fr/vincent.athias/botanist_douglas.htm [David Douglas} 1799-1835]
http://www.over-land.com/david_douglas.html [David Douglas]
http://elvers.stjoe.udayton.edu/history/people/Galton.html [Francis Galton Links]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/klmno/lyell_charles.html [Sir Charles Lyell} 1795-1875]
http://www.gkbenterprises.fsnet.co.uk/wrs.htm [William Robertson Smith} 1846-1893]
http://www.nhm.ac.uk/ [The Natural History Museum] London]
http://www.natcenscied.org [The National Center for Science Education]
http://www.darwinawards.com/ [Official Darwin Awards} "...showing us just how uncommon common sense can be." Wendy Northcutt, 2000, The Darwin Awards: Evolution in Action (Dutton).

http://kroeber.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/bio/tylor.htm [Edward Burnett Tylor]
http://www.lib.cam.ac.uk/MSS/Haddon.html [Alfred Cort Haddon: 1855-1940]
http://www.human-nature.com/science-as-culture/whittle.html [W.H.Rivers Rivers]
http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/information/biography/klmno/lowie_robert.html [Robert H. Lowie} 1883-1957]
http://www.nau.edu/glimpse-cgi-bin/mfs/06/hotlist/zora.html [Zora Neale Hurston: 1891-1960]
http://www.cs.ucf.edu/~zora/ [Zora Neal Hurston: 1891-1960]
http://www.si.edu/resource/faq/nmnh/start.htm#anthro[Anthropology "button"]
http://www.comma2000.com/max-gluckman/ [Max Gluckman]
http://www.wsu.edu:8001/vcwsu/commons/topics/culture/culture-index.html [Culture]
http://www.peabody.harvard.edu/maria/fletcher.html [Alice Fletcher: 1838-1923]
http://www.truman.edu/academics/ss/faculty/tamakoshil/index.html [Anthropology Field Study]
http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/information/biography/pqrst/taylor_herbert.html [Herbert C. Taylor, Jr.: 1924-1991]
http://nmnhwww.si.edu/naa/guide/_b1.htm [Makes reference to H.G. Barnett: 1906-1985]
http://nmnhwww.si.edu/naa/guide/_b1.htm [Makes reference to Ralph L. Beals: 1901-1985]

http://www.barnard.edu/sfonline/mead/ [Margaret Mead's Legacy: Continuing Controversies]
http://www.mead2001.org [Margaret Mead Web Site]
http://www.wic.org/bio/mmead.htm [Margaret Mead]
http://www.loc.gov/exhibits/mead/ [Margaret Mead Exhibit at the Library of Congress]
http://womenshistory.about.com/library/bio/blbio_margaret_mead.htm [Margaret Mead Site]
http://www.mead2001.org [Margaret Mead Web Site]
http://www.barnard.edu/sfonline/mead/ [Margaret Mead's Legacy: Continuing Controversies]
http://www.wic.org/bio/mmead.htm [Margaret Mead]
http://www.loc.gov/exhibits/mead/ [Margaret Mead Exhibit at the Library of Congress]
http://womenshistory.about.com/library/bio/blbio_margaret_mead.htm [Margaret Mead Site]
http://www.andrews.edu/MDLG/german/german-american/famous/B/boas_franz/ [Franz Boas: 1858-1942]
http://phoenicia.nmsu.edu/minds/Summaries/boas_109006_URL_Original.html [Jay Ruby on Franz Boas]
http://encyclopedia.com/articles/01602.html [on Franz Boas]
http://www.germanheritage.com/biographies/atol/boas.html [Franz Boas]
http://www.ssc.uwo.ca/sociology/mead/ [Mead/Boas Correspondence} 1925/1926]
http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/cultural/biography/index.shtml [F. Boas & Others! From A->Z]
http://cpnss.lse.ac.uk/darwin/evo/freeman.htm [Derek Freeman]
http://www.anu.edu.au/reporter/volume/32/10/opinion/heretic.html [Derek Freeman (1916-2001)]
http://www.lawrence.edu/dept/environmental_studies/bateson.html [Gregory Bateson (1904-1980)]
http://professionals.com/~chepc//ct_1095/ctssb1_1095.html [Gregory Bateson as UC Regent]
http://www.thetimes.co.uk/article/0,,60-219476,00.html [Sir Raymond W. Firth (1901-2002) Obituary in London Times Online]
http://www.users.voicenet.com/~nancymc/marvinharris.html [Marvin Harris} 1927-2001]
http://courses.smsu.edu/waw105f/Murdock.htm [George Peter Murdock} 1897-1985]
http://www.encyclopedia.com/html/M/Murdock.asp [George Peter Murdock} 1897-1985]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/fghij/herskovits_melville.html [Melville Herskovits]
http://www.library.northwestern.edu/africana/herskovits.html [Melville Herskovits]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/klmno/linton_ralph.html [Ralph Linton]
http://www.change.freeuk.com/learning/socthink/malinowski.html [Bronislaw Malinowski]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/klmno/malinowski_bronislaw.html [Bronislaw Malinowski]

http://www.museumofhoaxes.com/piltdown.html [Piltdown Hoax]
http://catal.arch.cam.ac.uk/catal/catal.html [Ian Hodder's Çatalhöyük site]
http://www.ncl.ac.uk/~nktg/wintro/ [Archaeology: An Introduction by Kevin Greene]
http://www.dilos.com/region/crete/evans.html [Sir Arthur Evans (1851-1941)]
http://athens.arch.ox.ac.uk/schoolarch/institute/staff/bcunliffe/bcunliffe.html [Barry Cunliffe} European Archaeology]
http://www.utexas.edu/courses/wilson/ant304/biography/arybios98/stephensbio.html [Augustus Lane Fox Pitt-River]
http://www.aaanet.org/gad/history/html/childe.htm [V.G. Childe} 1892-1957]
http://www.utexas.edu/courses/wilson/ant304/archive.html [The Archaeology Archive} University of Texas]
http://www.culture.fr/gvpda.htm [20,000 year old cave paintings]
http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/information/biography/uvwxyz/willey_gordon.html [Gordon Willey} 1913->]
http://www.precolumbian.org/lindaschele.htm [Linda Schele]
http://kroeber.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/bio/schele.htm [Linda Schele]
http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/information/biography/pqrst/taylor_walter_willard.html [W.W.Taylor} 1913-1997]
http://web.sau.edu/psychology/History/outline.htm [Pierre Paul Broca} 1824-1880]
http://cepa.newschool.edu/het/profiles/ferguson.htm [Adam Ferguson} 1723-1815]
http://www.aaanet.org/gad/history/021hoebel.pdf [E.A. Hoebel, 1960} William Robertson: An 18th Century Anthropologist-Historian]

http://eddie.cso.uiuc.edu/Durkheim/ [Durkheim Home Page]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/klmno/levi-strauss_claude.html [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.press.jhu.edu/books/hopkins_guide_to_literary_theory/claude_levi-strauss.html [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.wikipedia.org/wiki/Claude_Levi-Strauss [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://varenne.tc.columbia.edu/bib/auth/levstcld0.html [Selection of Works of Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.anthrobase.com/Dic/eng/pers/levi-strauss_claude.htm [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.change.freeuk.com/learning/socthink/levistrauss.html [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.factmonster.com/ce6/people/A0829580.html [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.encyclopedia.com/html/L/LeviS1tra.asp [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.1upinfo.com/encyclopedia/L/LeviStra.html [Claude Lévi-Strauss]
http://www.marxists.org/glossary/people/l/e.htm [Claude Lévi-Strauss and other individuals beginning with "L"]
http://varenne2.tc.columbia.edu/www/Class/bib/levstcld0_bib.html [Lévi-Strauss]

http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/information/biography/fghij/geertz_clifford.html [Clifford Geertz} 1923->]
http://www.iwp.uni-linz.ac.at/lxe/sektktf/GG/HyperGeertz.html [HyperGeertz World Catalogue]
http://emuseum.mnsu.edu/information/biography/fghij/geertz_clifford.html [Clifford Geertz]
http://eserver.org/theory/anthropology.html [Paul Smith} Writing, General Knowledge, and Postmodern Anthropology] 

http://ash.lab.r1.fws.gov [Forensic Science]
http://www.csuchico.edu/anth/ABFA/ [Located in the Department of Anthropology at CSU, Chico]
http://www.anthro.mankato.msus.edu/information/biography/pqrst/snow_clyde.html [Clyde Snow} 1928->]
http://www.anthro.ufl.edu/c.a.poundlab/maples.htm [William R. Maples} 1937-1997]
http://www.hti.umich.edu/e/ehraf/ [Electronic HRAF! - begin from CSU, Chico]
http://www.oakland.edu/~dow/anthap.htm [The ANTHAP - Applied Anthropology Computer Network]
http://www.usc.edu/dept/elab/welcome/ [E-Lab} Ethnographics Laboratory, University of Southern California]
http://home.worldnet.fr/clist/Anthro/Texts/frame.html [Anthropology Resources on the Internet]
http://www.wcsu.ctstateu.edu/socialsci/antres.html [Anthro Internet Resources} Western Conn. State Uni.]
http://www.aau.dk/~etnojens/etnogrp/anitaslist.html [A. Cohen-Williams' List Anthro/Arch WWW Sites]
http://www.anth.ucsb.edu:80/index.html [UC Santa Barbara Anthropology: Nice "jumping off" location]
http://rsl.ox.ac.uk/isca/marcus.banks.01.html [Interactive Multimedia by Marcus Banks]
http://www.math.unl.edu/~jfisher/femanthro/overview.html [Feminist Anthropology Theory Matrix]
http://www.csus.edu/anth/html/seasian.html [Digital Ethnography Project from CSU, Sacramento]
http://www.sscnet.ucla.edu/anthro/gessler/ [Culture and Computational Anthropology]

http://www.uncwil.edu/stuaff/career/anthropology.htm [Anthropology Careers]
http://www.as.ua.edu/ant/libguidt.htm [Writing Tools for Anthropology Students]
http://ids.csuchico.edu/ [Office of Experiential Education} Internships+]

PLEASE SEE http://www.csuchico.edu/lref/guides/rbn/hraf.html (in The Meriam Library and which states the following: "The eHRAF Collection of Ethnography, available on the web, is a small but growing collection of HRAF full text and graphical materials supplemented, in some cases, with additional research through approximately the 1980's. The eHRAF Collection of Ethnography includes approximately 48 cultures, and regular additions are planned." (And See http://www.hti.umich.edu/e/ehraf/ ).

CONSIDER THE CHANGING CULTURE OF "ANTHROPOLOGICAL FIELD WORK" AS INDICATED BY:

http://www.vacations.tvb.gov.to/ [Tongan Visitors Bureau} Welcome to the Kingdom of Tonga]
http://www.fikco.com/kingdom.htm [Tonga} Includes Audio]
http://www.royaltonganairlines.com/ [Royal Tongan Airlines]
http://www.lonelyplanet.com/destinations/pacific/tonga/index.htm [Lonely Planet World guide} Tonga]
http://gohawaii.about.com/cs/tonga/index.htm [Various Tongan Articles and Links]
http://www.pacificforum.com/links/Countries/Polynesia/Tonga/ [Pacific Islands Web Directory} Tonga]
http://zhenghe.tripod.com/t/tonga/ [Tonga]
http://otto.cmr.fsu.edu/~muh2051/guests/lessons/21/lesson21.html [Tonga]
http://pidp.ewc.hawaii.edu/pireport/[Pacific Islands Report} Up-to-the-date news]
http://coombs.anu.edu.au/WWWVL-PacificStudies.html [Australian National University} A massive Pacific Site]
http://www.cia.gov/cia/publications/factbook/ [CIA World Factbook} 2002]
http://www.govt.nz/ [New Zealand Government On-Line]
http://www.abc.net.au/news/ [ABC News (Australia)]; finally, check out:
http://www.123cam.com/ [Web Cams around the world, including many in Oceania!]

ALSO SEE "Anthropology On The Internet: A Review And Evaluation Of Networked Resources" by Brian Schwimmer, 1996, Current Anthropology, Vol. 37, No. 3, pages 561-568; also see a hypertext version of this paper, with linkable URLs at: http://www.artsci.wustl.edu/~anthro/ca/papers/schwimmer/intro.html

http://www.journals.uchicago.edu/CA/journal/issues/v40n5/995601/995601.html [Interview With Sydel Silverman in Current Anthropology

NOTE: For additional URLs, not listed above, you may go to http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/syllabi/SYL_13-FA2003.html and see numerous other appropriate Web Sites.


BRIEF DISCLAIMER ESSAY for those who make the time to read about the FALL 2003 Web-assisted courses taught by Dr. Charles F. Urbanowicz, Professor of Anthropology, California State University, Chico.

NOTE TO STUDENTS: This is actually a very brief "essay" about web-based instruction (which this course is not) and web pages (which you are reading either "electronically" or in the required Guidebook form. The World Wide Web is an "electronic organism" which has been created by human beings, and as human beings change, the WWW continues to "evolve" over time. Education will radically alter by the time I retire/die and (a) while I try to "keep up" with as much as possible for my students (and myself) I realize that (b) I am behind as soon as I begin! With that in mind, the reader (or viewer) of these pages (either "electronically" or in print") is reminded that this course is not a web-based course but is a "traditional" course, taught on the campus of California State university, Chico, to "traditional" (or perhaps a "semi-traditional" group of) Freshmen, Sophomore, Junior, and Senior students who are sitting in a classroom in for ~sixteen weeks. These web pages contain no frames, no WEB-CT references, no Javascripts, no interactive exams, no streaming video, no Power Point Presentations, and no other "bells-and-whistles" which are current on the WWW but they do contain numerous "live" links which are appropriate for various weeks of the semester-long course. These WWW pages are not meant to be "downloaded" and printed out at home or in a computer laboratory but (a) they are meant to be read in the required printed form and (b) checked on a weekly basis for the updates that will be added throughout the entire semester: it is in updating this Guidebook that the WWW is "alive" (as well as this course and, indeed, all education) and evolving through time. Please note, however, that the pages in this Guidebook do contain numerous "live" links, appropriate for various weeks of the semester-long course (and some links will guide you to sample exams, streaming videos, and Power Point presentations!).

THE READER MAY WELL ASK: Why make these "printed pages" (gasp!) available on the WWW? Why did Urbanowicz go through all-of-the-trouble to place this on the WWW if it is not an interactive course? As The Wall Street Journal on July 20, 1998 pointed out: "It Isn't Entertainment That Makes The Web Shine: It's Dull Data" (Page 1 and page A8). Although I trust that you have not purchased a bound volume of "dull data" but a volume of ideas (with data) I also add that for more than a decade I have been providing my students (in varous lower-and-upper-division courses) with Guidebooks that have "video notes" and "lecture outlines" for the appropriate course that semester. Human beings are "visual creatures" and I use NUMEROUS films, slides, and transparencies (most of which are not included on these web pages) in my classes and since I am comfortable with the Guidebook format, I continue to place the Guidebook on "the web" (with numerous links) for students. I encourage all readers of these pages to "weigh" all of the information very carefully: contrast and compare what you know with what is being presented and please consider the following from The Wall Street Journal, June 25, 1999, page 1 & A11):

"Who invented the telephone? Microsoft Corp's Encarta multimedia encyclopedia on CD-ROM has an answer to that simple question. Rather, two answers. Consult the U.S., U.K., or German editions of Encarta and you find the expected one: Alexander Graham Bell. But look at the Italian version and the story is strikingly different. Credit goes to Antonio Meucci, an impoverished Italian-American candlemaker who, as the Italian-language Encarta tells it, beat Bell to the punch by five years. Who's right? Depends on where you live. ... in the age of the Internet, the issue of adapting products to local markets is raising trickier problems. Technology and globalization are colliding head-on with another powerful force: history. Perhaps nowhere is this conflict more apparent than in information as with Microsoft's Encarta, which has nine different editions, including one in British English and one in American. It's Microsoft's peculiar accomplishment that it has so mastered the adaptation of its products to different markets that they reflect different, sometimes contradictory, understandings of the same historical events. 'You basically have to rewrite all of the content,' says Dominique Lempereur, who, from her Paris office, oversees the expansion of Microsoft's education-related products to foreign markets. 'The translation is almost an accessory.' ... Consistency is clearly not Encarta's goal, and that's something of a controversial strategy. Encyclopedia Britannica, for example, has a policy of investigating contradictions across its editions and deciding on a standard presentation. Where it can establish a fact that is internationally solid, 'we go with that, and present other interpretations as need be,' says Dale Holberg, Britannica's editor in Chicago. His staff has looked into the Meucci question. Their verdict: Bell still gets the credit, world-wide, for inventing and patenting the electric telephone. ... Microsoft, as a technology conglomerate, has an interest in not stirring up controversies that endanger the sale of its other products. But the universaility of the Web also frustrates efforts to localize content. And there remains the possibility that it will bring about pressure for one universally aplicable version of history. Perhaps one day Mr. Meucci will share space with Alexander Graham Bell in all of the Encartas [stress added]." Kevin J. Delaney, 1999, Microsoft's Encarta Has Different Facts For Different Folks. The Wall Street Journal, June 25, 1999, page 1 & A11. 

ALTHOUGH THE ELECTRONIC WORLD is changing very rapidly, and one might question the value of the "printed word" (considering the number of "electronic books" currently on "the web" such as the Bible or Darwin and 1000s of other available from sources such as the INCREDIBLE Books on Line and Project Gutenberg), there will always (I honestly believe as of this writing), a place for the "printed page" that you can hold in your hands, that YOU can read in bed, read outside when the electricity goes off, or read when you can't make an Internet connection to read the Web pages located in cyberspace! In short, while the ephemeral culture of the WWW is extremely important, the tangible culture of a physical object is just as important and I follow some of the thoughts in the Library of Congress: Litera scripta manet, or the written (or physically published) word endures! Incidentally, as with EVERYTHING, double-check the written (printed) word as well.

PLEASE: the reader of this Guidebook is strongly encouraged to process, question, read, search, and think about various issues and ideas throughout the semester and perhaps come to an understanding of how you relate to anthropology and how anthropology relates to you! As Clark Kerr stated: "The university is not engaged in making ideas safe for students. It is engaged in making students safe for ideas [stress added]." The University and the Internet and the World Wide Web and Cyberspace are changing the very environment "we" all interact in and the "web" should point to new sources to provide you with new thoughts. This is how I have personally envisioned this web-related web-related Guidebook (of ~62,492 as of 25 August 2003): NOTE, this does not count the words in the 16 essays in the printed Guidebook); it is a GUIDE to other resources to explore on your own to prepare for your individual futures. Please consider your own age, where you wish to go in the future, and please ponder the following:

"It's a cliche of the digital age: Parents wonder how children so helpless in the real world can navigate the virtual world with such skill. Using computers is second nature to most kids--and with good reason, according to many neurologists. Being exposed to the wired world at early ages is effectively wiring children's brains differently, giving them an ease and comfort with computers that adults may never match. Will the new millennium see the generation gap turn into the digital divide? ... The cognitive gap is likely to continue well into the future, even as today's cyberkids become tomorrow's parents. While kids are growing up with brains well suited to the digital world of today, as adults they are likely to face the difficult task of adapting to a future where technology evolves even more rapidly--and more profoundly--than it does today [stress added]." Yocki J. Dreazen & Rachel Emma Silverman, 2000, Raised In Cyberspace. January 1, 2000, The Wall Street Journal, page R47.

FINALLY, please think about these words and why I may have chosen them:

"If by some fiat I had to restrict all this writing to one sentence, this is the one I would choose: The summit of Mt. Everest is marine limestone." John McPhee, 1998, Annals of the Former World (NY: Farrar, Straus and Giroux), page 124.
"Every individual matters. Every individual has a role to play. Every individual makes a difference."
Jane Goodall, 1999, 40 Years At Gombe, page 103.
 


NOTE FROM URBANOWICZ FOR FALL 2003:

The pages that follow in the printed version of the Fall 2003 Anthropology 296 Guidebook and Selected Anthropology Essays by Urbanowiczcame from various web pages created over the years. (On the web, the essays may be accessed by clicking below.) The essays provide information about me for students for this course, and, hopefully, place some of my ideas and actions into context and perspective. I have been a member of the faculty at CSU, Chico, since August 1973. I received my Ph.D. in Anthropology in 1972 from the University of Oregon, based on 1970-1971 fieldwork in the Polynesian Kingdom of Tonga. In 1972-1973, prior to joining the faculty at CSU, Chico, I taught at the University of Minnesota. As Marshall Sahlins wrote in his collection of essays in 2001:

"Written over the course of thirty years, the texts collected here represent a temporal succession of interests and topics, if not exactly a chronological sequence of publication." Marshall Sahlins, 2001, Introduction. Culture in Practise: Selected Essays (NY: Zone Books), page 9.

The brief WWW essays below do not cover as lengthy a period of time as John W. Bennet did in his 1998 work entitled Classic Anthropology Critical Essays: 1944 - 1996 (New Brunswick & London: Transaction Publishers), but I adhere to his following statement: "I have avoided major rewriting and revising of the older pieces, because I want the reader to view them as more or less" as they appeared at the time (page xv).

For those who make the time to consult my complete résumé on the web, some interesting things have happened to me since graduating from high school in 1960 and I found the following words from a 2001 publication intriguiging:

"Jersey City was a tough place to grow up, except I didn't know any better. I had nothing to compare it to. All I knew was that I was well fed and comfortable in our apartment. The air was filled with industrial smells that meant home [page 10]. ... I made a break for it after high school, escaping to New York University, commuting every day on the PATH train. Greenwich Village was only a few miles away, but it may as well have been in another solar system [stress added]." Helene Stapinski, 2001, Five-Finger Discount: A Crooked Family History (NY: Random House), page 171.

Perhaps being born in Jersey City, New Jersey, in 1942, graduating from high school in 1960, commuting to New York City and New York University for 1960-61, flunking out of NYU in 1961, enlisting in the United States Air Force (1961-1965) and getting married in 1963 and ... is why I became an anthropologist! A lot of everything goes into who, what, and why each of us is what we are today.

# # #  


SIXTEEN ESSAYS BY URBANOWICZ FOR ANTH 296, FALL 2003:

THE FOLLOWING ESSAYS (printed in the bound Guidebook available in the Associated Students Bookstore at CSU, Chico) ARE FOR ANTHROPOLOGY 296 / anthropology 296H FOR FALL 2003:

#1} 2003, THE ANTHROPOLOGY FORUM: 1973->2003! [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/30YearsOfAnthroForums.html]

#2} 1997, THE ENTHUSIASM OF TEACHING. [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/MT1997Essay.html

#3} 1971, TONGAN CULTURE: FROM THE 20TH CENTURY TO THE 19TH CENTURY. [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/1971TonganPaper.html]

#4} 1972, TONGAN SOCIAL STRUCTURE: DATA FROM AN ETHNOGRAPHIC RECONSTRUCTION. [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/1972TonganPaper.html]

#5} 1992, FOUR-FIELD COMMENTARY [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Pub_Papers/4field.html]

#6} 2002 A "STORY" (VISION OR NIGHTMARE?) OF THE REGION IN 2027. [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/aStoryof2027.html]. 

#7} 2002, CALIFORNIA, CANCER, AND 1999 DATA FROM THE WALL STREET JOURNAL. [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/WSJCancerOctober2000.html]

#8} 1993, CHARLES R. DARWIN: HAPPY 116TH ANNIVERSARY [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Darwin116.html 

#9} 2001, REVIEW of: Victorian Sensation: The Extraordinary Publication, Reception, and Secret Authorship of Vestiges of the Natural History of Creation [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/VestigesReview.html]

#10} 2002, REVIEW of: The Tangled Web: Biological Constraints on the Human Spirit (Second Edition, 2002) by Melvin Konner [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/BookReviewKonnerWeb.html].

#11} 1970, MOTHER NATURE, FATHER CULTURE... [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/NatureCulture1970.html]

#12} 1998, COMMENTS ON TASMANIAN PUBLICATIONS OF 1884 AND 1973/74 [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Pacific/Tasmania.html

#13} 1968, COMMENTS ON BRONISLAW MALINOWSKI (1884-1942) [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Malinowski1968.html]

#14} 1969, A SELECTIVE VIEW OF THE INTELLECTUAL ANTECEDENTS OF CLAUDE LÉVI-STRAUSS. {printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/1969Levi-StraussPaper.html]

#15} 1977, EVOLUTION OF TECHNOLOGICAL CIVILIZATIONS: WHAT IS EVOLUTION, TECHNOLOGY, AND CIVILIZATION? [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Unpub_Papers/1977SETIPaper.html]

#16} 2001, THE GALÁPAGOS ISLANDS: EVERY LITTLE BIT HELPS [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/GalapagosIslandsoilspill.htm]

# # #
 

PLEASE NOTE: The following fourteen essays appeared in earlier printed ANTH 296/ANTH 296H Guidebooks (but were eliminated over time as a result of ANTH 296 student input); perhaps you might be interested in them (by going to the web addresses):

A.} 2001, TEACHING AS THEATRE.... [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Darwin2000.html]

B.} 1999 / 2000, MNEMONICS QUOTATIONS, CARTOONS, AND A NOTEBOOK [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/TeachingT.html]

C.} 1998, FOLKLORE CONCERNING CHARLES R. DARWIN [pages 1->4 only] [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Darwin_Folklore.html]

D.} 1976, JOHN THOMAS, TONGANS, AND TONGA! [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Pub_Papers/John_Thomas.html]

E.} 1993, PEOPLES & CULTURES OF THE PACIFIC: OKEANIA EST OMNIS DIVISA IN PARTES TRES [page 1 + 2 only][Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/FSep-30-93.html]

F.} 2000, COMMENTS ON TOURISM IN THE POLYNESIAN KINGDOM OF TONGA...[page 1 only].... [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Fa2000Anth138.html]

G.} 1996, AN ANTHROPOLOGIST LOOKS AT THE GEOGRAPHY OF GAMING [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/public_html/Gaming/geo_of_gaming.html]

H.} 1990, PERSPECTIVES ON SCIENCE FICTION AND SCIENCE FACT [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Forum/March1990.html]

I.} 2001, REVIEW Essay of Annie's Box: Charles Darwin, His Daughter, and Human Evolution, by Randal Keynes (2001). [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/WordsOnAnnie'sBox.html]

J.} 2000, BOOK REVIEW OF: Unto Others: The Evolution And Psychology of Unselfish Behavior [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/BReviewSoberWilson.html]

K.} 2000, ANTHROPOLOGY ACCORDING TO The War Of Dreams: Studies in Ethno Fiction by Marc Augé [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/BookReviewAuge.html]

L.} 2001, REVIEW of Biology, Evolution, and Human Nature [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/qrbjuly2001review.htm]

M.} 1990, A DOSSIER ON DARWIN: LETTER TO THE EDITOR [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/1990DossierOnDarwinLetter.html]

N.} 1970, DISCUSSION WORDS FROM 1970 / 1969 [Printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/1970CurrentDirections.html]

# # #


Throughout the entire Fall 2003 semester, I shall be "updating" these web pages; when you go to the URL for this class http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/syllabi/SYL_296-FA2003.html at the top of the "web page" you will see:

FOR UPDATED INFORMATION ADDED Month & Day, 2003 please click here.

and this will take you to the bottom of the pages.


ADDITIONS TO THIS WEB PAGE SINCE AUGUST 25, 2003 HAVE BEEN THE FOLLOWING:

On December 8, 2003, the FINAL items were added to these pages:

As stated earlier in this Guidebook and mentioned in our class:

"It is our choices that show what we truly are, far more than our abilities."
The character Albus Dumbledore to Harry Potter
in Harry Potter And the Chamber of Secrets, 1998, by Joanne K. Rowling, page 333.

"I am an optimist. It does not seem too much use being anything else." Sir Winston Churchill [1874-1965].

OFFICE HOURS for Finals Week (December 15 - > 19, 2003) of Fall 2003 are:

Monday 12/15/2003 from 8am ->10am & Wednesday 12/17/2003 from 8am ->11am.

Please remember that your finished TERM PAPER (30%) is DUE on Monday, December 15, 2003 by 2pm.

Please consider this, if you will: "If you were to say to a physicist in 1899 that in 1999, a hundred years later, moving images would be transmitted into homes all over the world from satellites; that bombs of unimagineable power would threaten the species; that antibiotics would abolish infectious disease but that disease would fight back; that women would have the vote, and pills to control reproduction; that millions of people would take to the air every hour in aircraft capable of taking off and landing without human touch; that you could cross the Atlantic at two thousand miles an hour; that humankind would travel to the moon, and then lose interest; that microscopes would be able to see individual atoms; that people would carry telephones weighing a few ounces, and speak anywhere in the world without wires; or that most of these miracles depended on devices the size of a postage stamp, which utilized a new theory called quantum mechanics--if you said all this, the physicist would almost certainly pronounce you mad [stress added]." Michael Crichton, 1999, Timeline (Ballantine Books November 2000 Paperback), pages ix-x.

Urbanowicz asks} what will it be like in 2099? How old might you be in 2099? Your children? Your grandchildren? What will your grandchildren or your children think of your Chico State experiences of the year 2003?] Please read, and even think about the following:

"First U.S. web site created 10 years ago. MENLO PARK (AP) - Ten years ago, a Stanford University physicist created the first U.S. web site - three lines of text, with one link to e-mail and another lionk to a huge scientific database. Paul Kunz's basic Web site, which first appeared Dec. 12, 1991, was the first U.S. site on the World Wide Web, which was then just a year old. ... 'I don't think, 10 years ago, anyone foresaw it would grow this fast,' Kunz said. 'There's a whole generation of people growing up who think the Web's always existed.' ... [stress added]." Anon., 2001, The Chico Enterprise-Record, December 4, 2001, page 4B.

WANT more information available from the WWW!? Check out: http://www.google.com/newsalerts [Google News Alerts are sent by email when news articles appear online that match the topics you specify.]

FOR ANSWERS to questions posed on November 21, 2003 (below):

1. A lady read a book.... She was a lighthouse keeper.

2. A young man entered a bar ....He had the hiccups.

3. Imagine you are driving a Mercedes at 100 mph....Stop imagining.

4. 2 + 2 + 5 = 247. ... Put a line on the first "+" from the top lefy, turning it into a "4."

5. Luke had it before. Paul had it behind. ... The letter "L."

6. A man on horseback went on a two day trip. He left on Tuesday and arrived home on Tuesday. ... The horse was named "Tuesday."

And for your cross-cultural information:

http://www.interfaithcalendar.org/ [Interfaith Calendar] "Sacred times are windows into religions"

http://aish.com/holidays/chanukah/songfest.asp [Aish HaTorah - Chanukah Site ]

http://www.officialkwanzaawebsite.org [The Official Kwanzaa Web Site]

TO REPEAT (AND ADD) SOME FINAL URBANOWICZ QUOTES FOR FALL 2003:

"The most important word in the English language is attitude. Love and hate, work and play, hope and fear, our attitudinal response to all these situations, impresses me as being the guide." Harlen Adams (1904-1997)

"My reasons for hope are fourfold: (1) the human brain; (2) the resilience of nature; (3) the energy and enthusiasm that is found or can be found or can be kindled among young people worldwide; and (4) the indomitable human spirit [stress added]." Jane Goodall [with Phillip Berman], 1999, Reason For Hope: A Spiritual Journey (NY: Warner Books), page 233.

"You may not believe in evolution, and that is all right. How we humans came to be the way we are is far less important than how we should act now to get out of the mess we have made for ourselves. How should the mind that can contemplate God relate to our fellow beings, the other life-forms of the world? What is our human responsibility? And what, ultimately, is our human destiny? [stress added]." Jane Goodall [with Phillip Berman], 1999, Reason For Hope: A Spiritual Journey (NY: Warner Books), page 2.

and finally

To place things in some perspective, please consider the words of Charles Schultz (1912-2000): "Don't worry about the world coming to an end today. It's already tomorrow in Australia."

"A pessimist sees the difficulty in every opportunity; an optimist sees the opportunity in every difficulty." Sir Winston Churchill [1874-1965].

"I am an optimist. It does not seem too much use being anything else." Sir Winston Churchill [1874-1965].

"A teacher affects eternity;
he [or she!] can never tell
where his [or her] influence stops."
Henry Brooks Adams [1838-1918],
The Education of Henry Adams, chapter 20


On November 21, 2003, the following items were added to this page:

Please remember that term paper presentations begin on Wednesday December 3, 2003 (Canova, Johnson, and McVey), continue on Monday December 8, 2003 (Earnshaw, Minami, and Carman), and conclude on Wednesday December 10, 2003 (Trask, Clarke, and Vallaire). Your TERM PAPER (30%) is DUE on Monday, December 15, 2003 by 2pm. To possibly be of assistance in this (and other presentations), I have created the following chart (based on various sources); it is not "gospel" but merely a guide for what you present and what you see and hear being presented:

1
2
3
4
5
NON-VERBAL (Eye contact, gestures, body language, etc.)
None.
Minimal.
Limited.
Some.
Consistent and appropriate.
VOICE (tone, volume, etc.)
Difficult to understand.
Erratic.
Fairly easy to understand.
Easy to understand.
Clear voice, enthusiastic, not too slow or fast.
ORGANIZATION (introduction, main points, transitions, and conclusions)
Missing introduction.
Missing Introduction and/or conclusions.
Missing main points.
Getting better.
Clear and easy to follow.
CONTENT
Little or no evidence of research.
Modest evidence of research.
Some evidence of research.
Considerable evidence.
Excellent coverage of concept or idea.
PRESENTATION AIDS (if any)
None.
Messy or inappropriate.
Difficult to see or read.
Clear, easy to see/read.
Presentation aids added greatly to presentation.

AND PLEASE remember the information provided to you on page 67 of the printed Guidebook, repeated here:

Some selections from "Preparing and presenting a speech" by Shirley Shields (in The Great American Bathroom Book I, 1992, edited by Steven W. Anderson). [The information as it appeared in GABB I was actually an edited summary of the Shields 1989 publication entitled Change Your Voice, Change Your Image (Chapter 7)].
"Consider these ten key steps when preparing a talk:

1. Choose your subject with care....
2. Analyze the audience....
3. Ascertain your purpose: Are you speaking chiefly to persuade, entertain, or inform?
4. Gather materials....
5. Organize the material....The introduction...The body of your talk....The conclusions...
6. Select words carefully....
7. Use quotations correctly....
8. Employ (on a limited basis) personal references....
9. Make your speech your own....
10. Time your speech: Nothing kills a good speech [or classroom presentation!] than going overtime [stress added]."

"With verbal reports, much of the data gets lost in translation. Most people aren't trained to listen. Given the complexity of our mental processes, the recipient tunes out, blocks, forgets, or misinterprets eighty percent of what's been said. Take any fifteen minutes' worth of conversation and try to reconstruct it later and you'll see what I mean. If the communication has any emotional content whatever, the quality of the information retained degrades even further [stress added]." Sue Grafton, 1998, N Is For Noose (NY: Henry Holt and Company), page 23.


Some words from "How To Get Your Point Across in 30 Seconds--or Less" by Milo O. Frank (in The Great American Bathroom Book II, 1993, edited by Steven W. Anderson), pages 455-456.

"The three principles of effective communication: The first component of an effective 30-second message--the passive, pre-planned part of your communication--consists of the three principles necessary for effective communication: know your objective, know your listener, and know your approach. ... The three techniques of effective communication: The second part of your 30-second message is the actual message itself. The effectiveness of your message pivots on the three techniques of effective communication--the three K's of your message. Your 'hook' is designed to 'Katch' your listener; the 'subject' will 'Keep'em interested; and the 'closing' will 'Konvince'em' to work with you. Adding Impact: The finishing touches of a 30-second message include a number of measures you can take to add impact. ... Imagery - Make sure your listener sees as well as hears what you are saying....Clarity - Choose words and images appropriate to your listeners level of understanding. ... Personalizing - Use personal stores or examples to illustrate key points.... Emotional Appeal - The most effective messages are those that reach the listener's heart [stress added]."


Just for the "fun" of it, have a look at what has been termed "Thinking Mind Intelligence Test."

1. A lady read a book, turned the light out and went to sleep. In the morning, when she saw in the newspaper that a ship had sunk drowning all on board, she committed suicide. Why?

2. A young man entered a bar and asked for a glass of water. The person behind the bar produced a gun and pointed it at the man. He replied, 'Thank you,' and walked off. Why?

3. Imagine you are driving a Mercedes at 100 moph. The steering locks. The doors lock. The brakes fail. You can't get out. You're heading for a 1,000 foot cliff! What do you do?

4. 2 + 2 + 5 = 247. Add one small line to make the sum correct.

5. Luke had it before. Paul had it behind. Ladies have it at the beginning. Abraham Lincoln had it twice. Doctor Lowell had it twice as bad as he had it before. What is it?

6. A man on horseback went on a two day trip. He left on Tuesday and arrived home on Tuesday. How could this be?

The answers to the above will be provided in the next Guidebook update; just for the fun of it, however, please consider the following (answers, however, will not be provided):

This is the eighth-grade final exam from 1895 Salinas, KS, USA. It was taken from the original document on file at the Smokey Valley Genealogical Society and Library in Salinas, Kansas and reprinted by the Salina Journal.

Grammar (Time, one hour)

1. Give nine rules for the use of Capital Letters.
2. Name the Parts of Speech and define those that have no modifications.
3. Define Verse, Stanza and Paragraph.
4. What are the Principal Parts of a verb? Give Principal Parts of do, lie, lay and run.
5 . Define Case. Illustrate each Case.
6. What is Punctuation? Give rules for principal marks of Punctuation.
7. - 10. Write a composition of about 150 words and show therein that you understand the practical use of the rules of grammar.

Arithmetic (Time, 1.25 hours)

1. Name and define the Fundamental Rules of Arithmetic.
2. A wagon box is 2 ft. deep, 10 ft. long, and 3 ft. wide. How many bushels of wheat will it hold?
3. If a load of wheat weighs 3942 lbs., what is it worth at 50 cts. a bushel, deducting 1050 lbs. for tare?
4. District No. 33 has a valuation of $35,000. What is the necessary levy to carry on a school seven months at $50 per month and have $104 for incidentals?
5. Find the cost of 6720 lbs. coal at $6.00 per ton.
6. Find the interest of $512.60 for 8 months and 18 days at 7 percent.
7. What is the cost of 40 boards, 12 inches wide and 16 feet long at $20 per meter?
8. Find the bank discount on $300 for 90 days (no grace) at 10 percent.
9. What is the cost of a square farm at $15 per acre, the distance around which is 640 rods?
10. Write a Bank Check, a Promissory Note, and a Receipt.

U.S. History (Time, 45 minutes)

1. Give the epochs into which U.S. History is divided.
2. Give an account of the discovery of America by Columbus.
3. Relate the causes and results of the Revolutionary War.
4. Show the territorial growth of the United States.
5. Tell what you can of the history of Kansas.
6. Describe three of the most prominent battles of the Rebellion.
7. Who were the following: Morse, Whitney, Fulton, Bell, Lincoln, Penn, and Howe?
8. Name events connected with the following dates: 1607 1620 1800 1849 1865

Orthography (Time, one hour)

1. What is meant by the following: Alphabet, phonetic, orthography, etymology, syllabication?
2. What are elementary sounds? How are they classified?
3. What are the following and give examples of each: Trigraph, subvocals, dphthong, cognate letters, linguals?
4. Give four substitutes for caret 'u'.
5. Give two rules for spelling words with final'e'. Name two exceptions under each rule.
6. Give two uses of silent letters in spelling. Illustrate each.
7. Define the following prefixes and use inconnection with a word: Bi, dis, mis, pre, semi, post, non, inter, mono, sup
8. Mark diacritically and divide into syllables the following, and name the sign that indicates the sound: Card, ball, mercy, sir, odd, cell, rise, blood, fare, last.
9. Use the following correctly in sentences: cite, site, sight, fane, fain, feign, vane, vain, vein, raze , raise, rays.
10. Write 10 words frequently mispronounced and indicate pronunciation by use of diacritical marks and by syllabication.

Geography (Time, one hour)

1. What is climate? Upon what does climate depend?
2. How do you account for the extremes of climate in Kansas?
3. Of what use are rivers? Of what use is the, ocean?
4. Describe the mountains of North America.
5. Name and describe the following: Monrovia, Odessa, Denver, Manitoba, Hecla, Yukon, St. Helena, Juan Fernandez, Aspinwall and Orinoco.
6. Name and locate the principal trade centers of the U.S.
7. Name all the republics of Europe and give the capital of each.
8. Why is the Atlantic Coast colder than the Pacific in the same latitude?
9. Describe the process by which the water of the ocean returns to the sources of rivers.
10. Describe the movements of the earth. Give inclination of the earth.


On November 7, the following items were added to these pages:

A "sample" self-paced exam is available at http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ANTH296FA2003TESTTwo.htm to assist you as a Review for EXAM I on Monday November 17, 2003. (Incidentally, I am well aware that "older" versions of my ANTH 296 Exams exist "out there" - I return them so you might learn from any mistakes; by all means, if you have access to "old" exams, do look at them; but r.e.m.e.m.b.e.r to read and study for EXAM II as if you might be faced with BRAND NEW EXAMINATION QUESTIONS - which could well be the case!)!

For an essay idea: What do you think will be the most pressing question, the most important question, in Anthropological Thought on Monday the 17th of November 2003?

In order to assist you for your exam on Monday November 17, 2003, you might wish to look at "older" ANTH 296 Self-Paced-Exams at the following locations:

http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ANTH296SP2003TESTTwo.htm [Spring 2003]

http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ANTH296FA2002TESTTwo.htm [Fall 2002]

http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ANTH296SP2002TESTTwo.htm [Spring 2002]

http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ANTH296FA2001TESTTwo.htm [Fall 2001]

"Getting a good night's sleep before a big exam might be better than pulling an all-nighter. A study found that sleep apparently rsotres memories that were lost during a hectic day. It's not just a matter of sleep's recharding the body physically. Research say sleep can rescue memories in a biological process of storing and consolidating them deep in the brain's complex circuitry. The finding is one of several conclusions made in a pair of studies in today's issue of the journal nature that look at how sleep affects memory [stress added]." Rick Callahan, Sleep helps people learn, study finds. The San Francisco Chronicle, October 8, 2003, page A8.

For the fun of it, you might be interested in another Darwin Self-Test: http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ DarwinTestThree.htm [October 2003} Darwin SelfTest #3 (also providing links to the earlier Darwin Self Tests)].

Just as an FYI: IN THE NEWS! October 27,2003} "Should evolution be taught in high school science classes? RICHARD ANDERSON Editor's note: Ted Dickason, a candidate for Modesto City Schools board of trustees, has stated that he believes evolution and creationism should be taught side by side in high school science classes. This position has generated substantial debate in the community, including this article opposing the teaching of creationism in schools and the two letters to the editor to the right supporting creationism and/or Dickason....." [from: http://www.modbee.com/opinion/letters/story/7652165p-8557964c.html]

November 6, 2003} ARLINGTON, Va., Nov. 6 /PRNewswire/ -- The National Science Teachers Association (NSTA), the largest science teacher organization in the world, has published an updated position paper to reaffirm its standpoint on the teaching of evolution. The statement upholds and reinforces the position of the Association hat NSTA "strongly supports the position that evolution is a major unifying concept in science and should be included in the K-12 science education frameworks and curricula....." [from: http://biz.yahoo.com/prnews/031106/dcth026_1.html] and see http://www.nsta.org/159&psid=10.

"The first object of any act of learning, over and beyond the pleasure it may give, is that it should serve us in the future. Learning should not only take us somewhere; it should allow us later to go further more easily. There are two ways in which learning serves the future. One is through its specific applicability to tasks that are highly similar to those we originally learned to perform. ... Having learned how to hammer nails, we are better able later to learn how to hammer tacks or chip wood. Learning in school undoubtedly creates skills of a kind that transfers to activities encountered later, either in school or after. A second way in which earlier learning renders later performance more efficient is through what is called nonspecific transfer or, more accurately, the transfer of principles and attitudes. In essence, it consists of learning initially not a skill but a general idea .... This type of transfer is at the heart of the educational process--the continual broadening and deepening of knowledge in terms of basic and general ideas [stress added]." Jerome Bruner, 1960, The Process of Education (Harvard University press), page 17.

And that Forum presentation of November 6, 2003 is up at: http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/DestinationPolynesia.html


On September 29, 2003, the following items were added to these pages:

A "sample" self-paced exam is available at http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/ANTH296FA2003TESTONE.htm to assist you as a Review for EXAM I on Monday October 6, 2003. (Incidentally, I am well aware that "older" versions of my ANTH 296 Exams exist "out there" - I return them so you might learn from any mistakes; by all means, if you have access to "old" exams, do look at them; but r.e.m.e.m.b.e.r to read and study for EXAM I (and eventually EXAM II) as if you might be faced with BRAND NEW EXAMINATION QUESTIONS - which could well be the case!)!

You might be interested in some "Darwin Self-Tests" at:

http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/DarwinTestOne.htm (Darwin 2000-2001 [Self]Test One).

http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/SelfTesting/DarwinTestTwo.htm (Darwin 2001 Self-Test Two).

Remember} SOME OF THE TRANSPARENCIES USED ON DAY 1 OF CLASS (August 25, 2003) ARE AVAILABLE AT: http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/PowerPoint/ANTH296FA2003

Charles F. Urbanowicz, 1997, Charles Darwin: Reflections - Part one: The Beginning. [ ~Seventeen Minutes: Darwin in England]. [http://rce.csuchico.edu/darwin/RV/darwinreflections.ram]. Produced and Edited by Ms. Donna Crowe: Instructional Media Center, CSU, Chico. Available via the Internet with REAL PLAYER [http://www.real.com/player/index.html]. [THIS IS THE one shown in class on September 15, 2003.].

Charles F. Urbanowicz, 1999, Charles Darwin: - Part One: The Voyage. [ ~Twenty-two Minutes. Darwin sailing from England to South America.] [http://rce.csuchico.edu/darwin/RV/darwinvoyage.ram] Produced and Edited by Ms. Donna Crowe: Instructional Media Center, CSU, Chico. Available via the Internet with REAL PLAYER [http://www.real.com/player/index.html].

Charles F. Urbanowicz, 2001, Charles Darwin: - Part Two: The Voyage. [ ~Twenty-two Minutes. Darwin from South America, through the Galápagos Islands, and back to England.] [http://rce.csuchico.edu/darwin/RV/darwin3.ram] Edited by Ms. Vilma Hernandez and Produced by Ms. Donna Crowe: Instructional Media Center, CSU, Chico. Available via the Internet with REAL PLAYER [http://www.real.com/player/index.html].

http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/DarwinFA2003PHIL137.html [Darwin, Sex, and Love} Urbanowicz PHIL 137 Lecture of 29 September 2003]

http://www.oum.ox.ac.uk/debate.htm [Oxford Natural History Museum} 1860 Huxley-Wilberforce Debate]

 http://www.ifi.unizh.ch/staff/zolli/CAP/Gib2.htm [CAP} Computer Assisted paleoanthropology} Reconstructing a Neanderthal Skull]

"...the Scientific Revolution took place in Europe, not in the Muslim lands, India or China. There were two chief reasons for this, one internal to Europe and one not. During the twelfth and thirteenth centuries, Europe spawned the autonomous university.... which had a corporate legal existence that marked it off as a community where scholars were usually free to dispute as they saw fit. ... [#1] The survival of universities gave European scientists a supportive community not quite paralleled elsewhere in the world. ...[#2] Into this archipelago of intellectual liberty after 1450 came information from all over the world [stress added]." J.R. McNeill & William H. McNeill, 2003, The Human Web: A Bird's-Eye View of World History (NY: W.W. Norton & Co.), page 187. 

"Biology also became historical after the publication in 1859 of Charles Darwin's [1809-1882] theory of evolution by natural selection. He argued that all species were descended from earlier ones, and that all creatures were locked in a struggle for existence which selected for the traits most advantageous for surival at a given time and place. Darwin's ideas were the most revolutionary and powerful scientific propositions of modern times, and posed a direct challenge to religious accounts of the origins of life and humankind. For this reason his views attracted vigorous opposition, especially from those who took the Bible as the literal word of God. ... gradually Darwin's views became--with modifications--universally accepted among the world's scientifically educated [stress added]." J.R. McNeill & William H. McNeill, 2003, The Human Web: A Bird's-Eye View of World History (NY: W.W. Norton & Co.), page 176.
http://www.feedroom.com/ [News available on the WWW]

http://www.onlinenewspapers.com/ [Thousands of Newspapers on the Net]

http://www.projectcensored.org/ [Project Censored]

http://www.mediawhoresonline.com/ [Media WhoresOnline]

http://www.beloit.edu/%7Epubaff/releases/2003/03mindsetlist.html [Beloit College} Class of 2007!]

http://www.ptech.wsj.com/ [Personal Technology from The Wall Street Journal by Walter Mossberg]

http://www.safariwest.com/index.php? [Safari West} Santa Rosa, California]

PS} http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/Sp2003ANTH16.html [April 16, 2003} Urbanowicz Lecture for ANTH 16 dealing with "tourism" and "gaming/gambling" issues.]

"And that's the way they have lived to this very day."
"Hasn't anyone told them?" asked Milo?
"It doesn't do any good," Alec replied, "for they can never see what they're in too much of a hurry to look for."
"Why don't they live in Illusions?" suggested the Humbug. "It's much prettier."
"Many of them do," he answered, walking in the direction of the forest once again, "but it's just as bad to live in a place where what you do see isn't there as it is to live in one where what you don't see is [stress added]." Norton Juster, 1961, The Phantom Tollbooth (Epstein & Carroll Associates), pages 118-119.


On September 3, 2003, the following items were added to these pages:

http://www.csuchico.edu/library/gov/election_ca.html [California Election information]

"Always saddle your own horse." Connie Reeves (1901-2003)

"Seeing is believing, but whether its 9/11 or the Columbia disaster, it can take months to comprehend what takes seconds to witness [stress added]." Russell Seitz, 2003, Too Strong Is Never Wrong. The Wall Street Journal, August 28, 2003, page A10.

"'It's annoying,' says the 19-year-old. 'It limits my Thursday-night partying.' There's something new on the schedule for America's college students this year: a five-day workweek. From Syracuse to Miami of Ohion, schools across the country are bringing back more Friday classes to ease up on a lecture-hall space crunch--and cut down on an extra day of partying, too. ... To no one's surprise, the change isn't going over well with a lot of students. ... Though it may not seem new, the idea of a short college week is actually a relatively recent phenomenon, and as late as the '70s, college like Notre ame were even holding big courses on Saturdays. ... Now its changing, with schools dealing with a host of issues. Budget cuts.... many academic experts think the full week [of classes] is here to stay, if only because so many other societal trends are going conservative, with grade schools reintroducing dress codes and employers scotching casual Fridays. Besides, schools say there's some new academic proof that Friday's are good for students. ... 'The longer the weekend, the more that's lost [stress added].'" Elizabeth Bernstein, 2003, Giving Fridays Some Class: More Colleges Are Pushing A Five-Day Workweek; Next; math at 7:30 a.m. The Wall Street Journal, August 29, 2003, pages W1 + W9C.

"Human evolution is the most passionate aspect of the evolution-creation debate [stress added]." Larry A. Whitham, 2002, Where Darwin Meets the Bible: Creationists And Evolutionists In America (Oxford University Press), page 242.
http://www.becominghuman.org/ [Paleoanthropology, Evolution and Human Origins]

http://www.culture.fr/culture/arcnat/lascaux/en/ [The Cave of Lascaux]

http://www.historyoftheuniverse.com/index.html [History of the Universe]

" Darwinism in Natomas: Snakes and hawks can't go to the dogs. A pack of dogs recently attacked a herd of 34 goats in the Natomas basin (land of Arco, the at-least-somewhat-international airport, rice farms, etc.), killing 11. This may not seem like a typical Natomas animal story, because itdoesn't revolve around the basin's two threatened critters, the giant garter snakes and the Swainson's hawks. Yet the hawks and the snakes seemingly have a stake in every Natomas battle, be it political or predatory. To see why, connect the Darwinian dots.

The goat, it turns out, is by and large an ally of the snake. These goatshad been hired (well, their human owners had been hired) to chew up some grass that was mucking up a new man-made marsh that was designed to be an enticing home for snakes. Just a few days ago, wildlife officials were thrilled to spot the first snake that had managed to slither to the preserve. Time out for a little known fact: On rare occasion, the hawk eats the snake. The hawk usually prefers tastier fare such as voles (small, mouse-like rodents) that scurry about alfalfa fields. (And any hawk eyeing a snake better look for a youngster. The adults can reach 6 feet in length; a Swainson's hawk, which is petite by the standards of the raptor world, would surely have its talons full with a 6-foot snake.) Still, from time to time and in just the right circumstances, the hawk will dine on snake. Viewed in this light, the alfalfa farmer emerges as an ally of the hawk. And that makes rice farming, with all its water canals and flooded fields, an ally of the snake. Now for the dogs. Whose side are they on? By attacking the goats, they deprived the snakes of a swimmable swamp. And the goats, by mowing the adjacent fields mouthful by mouthful, were making any juvenile snakes more visible to any hawks who were flying around unable to find a vole for lunch. The dogs, then, seem to be friends of the hawk.

Any lasting equilibrium will require dogs (and owners) that behave far better than these while hawks, snakes, voles, surburbanites and farmers maintain their rightful places in the basin. Natomas, either in the world of politics or in the animal kingdom, can't degenerate into a survival of the strongest. One way or another, many species and enterprises must find a way to peacefully live side by side, swamp by suburb. There's no denying, though, that sometimes it's a jungle out there [stress added]." Editorial, The Sacramento Bee, August 30, 2003, page B6.  

http://www.sbrowning.com/whowhatwhen/index.php3 [WhoWhatWhen - Interactive Historical Timelines]

http://www.ptech.wsj.com/ [Personal Technology From The Wall Street Journal]

http://www.sciam.com/article.cfm?articleID=00048144-10D2-1C70-84A9809EC588EF21 ["The Semantic Web" by Tim Berners-Lee, James Hendler and Ora Lassila . Scientific American, May 2001]

http://www.playingwithtime.org [Playing With Time]

http://www.ornl.gov/hgmis/project/info.html [Human Genome project Science]

http://www.dnafiles.org/resources/res07.html [The DNA Files} Learn More - Genes And Society]


To go to the home page of Charles F. Urbanowicz.

To go to the home page of the Department of Anthropology.

To go to the home page of California State University, Chico.

© Copyright [All Rights Reserved] Charles F. Urbanowicz / August 25, 2003} This copyrighted Fall 2003 Anthropology 296 Guidebook and Selected Anthropology Essays by Urbanowicz, printed from http://www.csuchico.edu/~curban/syllabi/SYL_296-FA2003.html, is intended for use by students enrolled at California State University, Chico, in the FALL Semester of 2003 and unauthorized use / publication is definitely prohibited.


© Copyright 2003; All Rights Reserved Charles F. Urbanowicz

8 December 2003 by CFU